0000938323 pso:ThreePointTwoFiveUSDollarNotesTwoThousandTwentyThreeMember ifrs-full:GrossCarryingAmountMember 2020-12-31
AS FILED WITH THE SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION ON MARCH 30, 2022
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
Form
20-F
(Mark One)
☐ | REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
or
☒ | ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
for the fiscal year ended December
31
, 2021
or
☐ | TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
for the transition period from to
or
☐ | SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934 |
Date of event requiring this shell company report
Commission file number
1-16055
PEARSON PLC
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)
England and Wales
(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)
80 Strand
London, England WC2R 0RL
(Address of principal executive offices)
Graeme Baldwin
Telephone: +44 20 7010 2000
Fax: +44 20 7010 6060
80 Strand
London, England WC2R 0RL
(Name, Telephone,
E-mail
and/or Facsimile Number and Address of Company Contact Person)Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
Title of Class | Trading Symbol | Name of Each Exchange on Which Registered | ||
*Ordinary Shares, 25p par value | PSO | New York Stock Exchange | ||
American Depositary Shares, each | New York Stock Exchange | |||
Representing One Ordinary Share, 25p per Ordinary Share |
* | Not for trading, but only in connection with the registration of American Depositary Shares, pursuant to the requirements of the SEC. |
Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act:
None
Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act:
None
Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock at the close of the period covered by the annual report:
Ordinary Shares, 25p par value | 756,802,797 |
Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes
☐ No ☒
If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Yes ☐ No ☒
Note — Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports) and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☒ No ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically every Interactive Data File required to be submitted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation
S-T
during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit such files). Yes ☒ No ☐Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a
non-accelerated
filer or an emerging growth company. See definition of “accelerated file”, “large accelerated filer” and “emerging growth company”, in Rule12b-2
of the Exchange Act.☒ Large accelerated filer ☐ Accelerated filer ☐ Non-accelerated filer
☐ Emerging growth companyIf an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with US GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐
Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has filed a report on and attestation to its management’s assessment of the effectiveness of its internal control over financial reporting under Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act (15 U.S.C. 7262(b)) by the registered public accounting firm that prepared or issued its audit report. ☒
Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing
☐ US GAAP | ☒ International financial Reporting Standards as Issued by the International Accounting Standards Board | ☐ Other |
If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the Registrant has elected to follow: Item 17 ☐ Item 18 ☐
If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule
12b-2
of the Exchange Act): Yes ☐ No ☒Auditor Firm Id: | 876 | Auditor Name: | PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP | Auditor Location: | London, United Kingdom |
TABLE OF CONTENTS
1
2
INTRODUCTION
In this Annual Report on Form
20-F
(the “Annual Report”) references to “Pearson”, the “Company” or the “Group” are references to Pearson plc and its consolidated subsidiaries, except as the context otherwise requires. “Ordinary Shares” refer to the ordinary share capital of Pearson of par value 25p each. “ADSs” refer to American Depositary Shares which are Ordinary Shares deposited pursuant to the Second Amended and Restated Deposit Agreement dated August 15, 2014, amended and restated as of August 8, 2000 among Pearson, The Bank of New York Mellon as depositary (the “Depositary”) and owners and holders of ADSs (the “Deposit Agreement”). ADSs are represented by American Depositary Receipts (“ADRs”) delivered by the Depositary under the terms of the Deposit Agreement.The Group has prepared the consolidated financial information contained in this Annual Report in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) and IFRS Interpretations Committee (“IFRS IC”) interpretations as issued by the UK
(“UK-adopted
IFRS”), which was brought into law on 31 December 2020, and adopted by the Group on 1 January 2021. The change constitutes a change in accounting framework, but there was no impact on recognition, measurement or disclosure in the period as a result of the change in framework. The consolidated financial statements have also been prepared in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. The consolidated financial statements have also been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). At the balance sheet date, in respect of accounting standards applied by the Group, there is no difference between theUK-adopted
IFRS and IASB issued IFRS. Unless otherwise indicated, any reference in this Annual Report to consolidated financial statements is to the consolidated financial statements and the related notes, included elsewhere in this Annual Report.The Group publishes its consolidated financial statements in sterling. The Group has included, however, references to other currencies. In this Annual Report:
• | references to “sterling”, “pounds”, “pence” or “£” are to the lawful currency of the United Kingdom, |
• | references to “euro” or “€” are to the lawful currency of the participating Member States in the Third Stage of the European Economic and Monetary Union of the Treaty Establishing the European Commission, and |
• | references to “US dollars”, “dollars”, “cents” or “$” are to the lawful currency of the United States |
• | references to “brl”, “R$” are to the lawful currency of Brazil. |
For convenience and except where specified otherwise, the Group has translated some sterling figures into US dollars at the rate of £1.00 = $1.35, the noon buying rate in The City of New York for cable transfers and foreign currencies as certified by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York for customs purposes on December 31, 2021. The Group does not make any representation that the amounts of sterling have been, could have been or could be converted into dollars at the rates indicated. On February 28, 2022 the noon buying rate for sterling was £1.00 = $1.34.
The Group currently consists of its education business only. In September 2021, the Group acquired the remaining stake in Faethm Holdings Pty Limited to bring its ownership up to 100% of the share capital of the Company. In April 2020, the Group completed the sale of the remaining 25% equity interest in the consumer publishing business Penguin Random House to Bertelsmann, the owner of the 75% interest. See “Item 4. Information on the Company — Overview of operating divisions”. The Pearson plc Consolidated Financial Statements are included in this report on pages
F1-F90.
3
FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS
You should not rely unduly on forward-looking statements in this Annual Report. This Annual Report, including the sections entitled “Item 3. Key Information — Risk Factors”, “Item 4. Information on the Company” and “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects”, contains forward-looking statements that relate to future events or the Group’s future financial performance. In some cases, you can identify forward-looking statements by terms such as “may”, “will”, “should”, “expect”, “intend”, “plan”, “anticipate”, “believe”, “estimate”, “predict”, “potential”, “continue” or the negative of these terms or other comparable terminology. Examples of these forward-looking statements include, but are not limited to, statements regarding the following:
• | operations and prospects, |
• | growth strategy, |
• | funding needs and financing resources, |
• | expected financial position, |
• | market risk, |
• | currency risk, |
• | US federal and state spending patterns, |
• | debt levels, and |
• | general market and economic conditions. |
These forward-looking statements involve known and unknown risks, uncertainties and other factors that may cause the Group’s or its industry’s actual results, levels of activity, performance or achievements to be materially different from any future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements expressed or implied by the forward-looking statements. In evaluating them, you should consider various factors, including the risks outlined under “Item 3. Key Information — Risk Factors”, which may cause actual events or industry results to differ materially from those expressed or implied by any forward-looking statement. Although the Group believes that the expectations reflected in the forward-looking statements are reasonable, it cannot guarantee future results, levels of activity, performance or achievements.
4
PART I
ITEM 1. | IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS |
Not applicable.
ITEM 2. | OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE |
Not applicable.
ITEM 3. | KEY INFORMATION |
Risk Factors
You should carefully consider the risk factors described below, as well as the other information included in the rest of this document. The Group’s business, financial condition or results from operations could be materially adversely affected by any or all of these risks, or by other risks that it presently cannot identify.
Content & Channel Risk
If the Group fails to successfully invest in and deliver the right products and services and to respond to competitive threats, its sales and profits could be adversely impacted.
A common trend facing all the Group’s businesses is the digitization of content and proliferation of distribution channels, either over the internet, or via other electronic means, replacing traditional print formats. The digital migration has led to changes in consumers’ perception of value and the publisher’s position between consumers, retailers, and authors, and has required the Group to make changes in product and content distribution.
Students are seeking cheaper sources of content, e.g. second hand and rental copies, online discounters, file sharing and use of pirated copies. This change in behavior puts downward pressure on textbook prices in major markets, and this could adversely impact the Group’s results.
There are multiple competing demands for educational funds and there is no guarantee that new courseware or testing or training programs will be funded, or that the Group will win or retain this business.
If the Group does not adapt rapidly to these changes, it may lose business to ‘faster’ and more ‘agile’ competitors, who increasingly are
non-traditional
competitors, making their identification all the more difficult. The Group may be required to invest significant resources to further adapt to the changing competitive environment, which requires continued development of both content and the method of delivery to be able to provide differentiated products and services, and can result in competitive disadvantage and missed opportunity for revenue and growth.If the Group does not adequately protect its intellectual property and proprietary rights, its competitive position and results may be adversely affected and its ability to grow restricted.
The Group’s products and services largely comprise intellectual property delivered through a variety of print and digital media, online software applications and platforms. The Group relies on trademark, patent, copyright and other intellectual property laws to establish and protect its proprietary rights in these products and services.
Failure to adequately manage, procure, register or protect intellectual property rights (including trademarks, patents, trade secrets and copyright) in the Group’s brands, content and technology, may (1) prevent the Group from enforcing its rights, and (2) increase the risk that bad actors will infringe the Group’s content rights (print and digital counterfeit, digital piracy), which will reduce sales and/or erode sales.
5
Although the Group’s intellectual property rights (IPR) in brands and content — historically its core assets — are generally well established in key markets, as technology and digital delivery of content have become an increasingly critical component of the Group’s business strategy, the Group has grown its patent portfolio to expand its protection of high value technology in the US and key international markets.
Online copying and security circumvention have become increasingly sophisticated and resistant to available countermeasures. Notably, in recent years “digital counterfeit” web sites have sold or attempted to sell unprotected PDF files of many of Pearson’s titles, at scale, using modern and sophisticated ecommerce methods, with a professional or legitimate appearance. From an IPR perspective, increasing the Group’s digital business continues to expose it to evolving trademark, copyright and patent infringement risks.
The Group’s forward-looking IPR strategy includes efforts to maintain a broad footprint of intellectual property rights in key markets outside the US. However, the Group also conducts business in other countries where its intellectual property protection efforts have been limited or where legal protection for intellectual property may be uncertain and these limitations could affect future growth.
Where the Group has registered or otherwise established its IPR, it cannot guarantee that such rights will provide competitive advantages due to: the challenges and costs of monitoring and enforcement in jurisdictions where competition may be intense; the limited and/or ineffective IPR protection and enforcement mechanisms available to it in many countries; the potential that its IPR may lapse, be invalidated, circumvented, challenged, or abandoned, or that it may otherwise lose the ability to assert its intellectual property rights against others. The loss or diminution in value of these proprietary rights or the Group’s intellectual property could have a material adverse effect on the Group’s business and financial performance.
Risks Related to the Competitive Marketplace
Global economy and cyclical market factors may adversely impact the Group’s financial performance.
With the continued pressure and uncertainty in the worldwide economies, particularly in light of the continuing
COVID-19
pandemic and the efforts to contain it, or the unfolding situation in Ukraine, there is a risk of a weakening in trading conditions, which could adversely impact the Group’s future financial performance. The effect of continued deterioration or lack of recovery in the global economy will vary across different businesses and will depend on the depth, length and severity of any economic downturn. The education market can be affected by cyclical factors which, although they can have a positive impact for many of the Group’s businesses, could for others lead to a reduction in demand for the Group’s products and services.Increased competitive pressure or reduced demand due to changing consumer learning preferences may adversely impact the Group’s financial performance and reduce the expected return on investment.
The Group competes in a highly competitive market that is subject to rapid change. The Group faces competitive threats both from large media players and from smaller businesses, online and mobile portals and operators in the digital arena that provide alternative sources of content. Alternative distribution channels, e.g. digital format, the internet, online retailers, growing delivery platforms (e.g.,
e-readers
or tablets), pose both threats and opportunities to traditional publishing business models, potentially impacting both sales volumes and pricing. In addition, new competitive entrants, increased price competition or shifts in learners away from educational institutions (as seen in reduced Higher Education enrolments) may lead to lower profitability and cash flow performance.A significant deterioration in the Group’s profitability and/or cash flows caused by prolonged economic instability could reduce its liquidity and/or impair its financial ratios and trigger a need to raise additional funds from the capital markets and/or renegotiate its banking covenants.
To the extent that worldwide economic conditions materially deteriorate, as a result of the
COVID-19
pandemic and the efforts to contain it or otherwise, or the unfolding situation in Ukraine, the Group’s sales,6
profitability and cash flows could be significantly reduced as customers could be unable to purchase products and services in the expected quantities and/or pay for them within normal agreed terms.
Disruption in capital markets or potential concerns about the Group’s credit rating, for instance manifested in downgrades or negative outlooks by the credit rating agencies, may mean that this capital may not be available on favorable terms or may not be available at all.
Risks Related to the Group’s Portfolio of Businesses
The Group’s failure to generate anticipated sales growth, synergies and/or cost savings from acquisitions, mergers and other business combinations, could lead to goodwill and intangible asset impairments.
The Group periodically acquires and disposes of businesses to achieve its strategic objectives and will continue to consider both as means to pursue its strategic priorities.
Acquisitions may involve significant risks and uncertainties, including difficulties in integrating acquired businesses in order to realize anticipated sales growth, synergies and/or cost savings; diversion of management attention from other business concerns or resources; use of resources that are needed in other parts of our business. Acquisitions could lead to goodwill and intangible asset impairments. In addition, divestitures involve risks and uncertainties that could adversely affect our business, results of operations and financial condition. These include, among others, the inability to find potential buyers on favorable terms, disruption to our business and/or diversion of management attention from other business concerns, loss of key employees and possible retention of certain liabilities related to the divested business.
The Group’s investment in new markets may deliver returns that are lower than anticipated.
The Group has invested in and has plans to continue to invest in new workforce and direct to learning experiences of which the Group has less experience and faces a variety of competition to be successful. Failure to achieve our planned outcomes may lead to lower than expected sales and profitability.
The Group has businesses in a variety of geographies globally and faces political and regulatory risks, especially in emerging markets.
Political, regulatory, economic and legal systems in emerging markets may be less predictable than in countries with more developed institutional structures. Political, regulatory, economic, currency, reputational and corporate governance and compliance risks (including fraud, sanctions, bribery and corruption) as well as unmanaged expansion are all factors which could limit returns on investments made in these markets or could result in funds being trapped in these countries, limiting the ability of the group to reinvest these or distribute them to shareholders.
Risks Related to the Group’s Responsibility & Reputation
The Group’s business depends on a strong brand, and any failure to maintain, protect and enhance its brand would hurt its ability to retain or expand its business.
Protecting the Pearson brand is critical to expanding the Group’s business and will depend largely on its ability to maintain its customers’ trust in its solutions and in the quality and integrity of its products and services, including how it protects the data and privacy of customers and users. If the Group does not successfully maintain a strong brand, its business could be harmed. Beyond protection, strengthening the Pearson brand will enable the Group to more effectively engage with governments, administrators, teachers, learners and influencers.
7
Failure to prevent or detect a malicious attack on the Group’s systems has in the past and could in future result in a breach of confidentiality, integrity and/or availability of sensitive information. In particular, the Group has experienced, and may continue to experience in the future, an unauthorized disclosure of personal information despite best efforts to prevent it. Such incidents have in the past resulted, and could in future result, in damage to the customer experience and the Group’s reputation and in financial loss.
Information security and cyber risk are continually evolving and comprises many complex external drivers: increasing customer demand to demonstrate a strong security posture, external compliance requirements, ongoing digital revolution, increasing use of the cloud, managing the supply chain risk and increasingly sophisticated attack strategies. Across its businesses, the Group holds large volumes of personal data including that of employees, customers, students and citizens, and other highly sensitive business critical data such as financial data, internal sensitive information, and intellectual property. Despite its implementation of security measures, threat actors of all types, including individuals, criminal organizations and state sponsored operatives, have from time to time gained access, including in 2018 in the events leading to the SEC settlement discussed in “Item 4. Information on the Company —and may in the future gain access to the Group’s data through unauthorized means in order to misappropriate such information for fraudulent or other purposes.
Legal Proceedings”,
Any perceived or actual unauthorized disclosure of personal data or confidential information, whether through a breach of the Group’s network or a third party partner with whom we share data or access to our network by an unauthorized party, employee theft, misuse or error or otherwise, could harm the Group’s reputation, impair its ability to attract and retain its customers, impair business and operations, or subject the Group to regulatory investigations and/or to claims or litigation arising from damages suffered by individuals and customers, and thereby harm its business and operational results. Failure to adequately protect personal data and confidential information has led, in respect of the SEC settlement referred to aboveand could potentially lead to regulatory penalties, as well as, litigation costs and damages, significant remediation costs, reputational damage, cancelation of some existing contracts and difficulty in competing for future business, among other things. In addition, the Group could incur significant costs in complying with the relevant laws and regulations regarding the protection of personal data and confidential information against unauthorized disclosure, payments due to cyber extortion or to responding to regulatory investigations into such matters. Changes to data privacy legislation must also be monitored and acted upon to ensure the Group remains in compliance across different markets.
,
Failure to use the Group’s data effectively to enhance the quality and scope of current products and services in order to improve learning outcomes could adversely affect the Group’s business.
The Group seeks to maximize data to enhance the quality and scope of current products and services in order to improve learning outcomes while managing associated risks. The Group’s ability to continue to do so may be subject to factors beyond the Group’s control. In addition, the unavailability of timely, complete and accurate data limits informed decision-making and increases the risk of
non-compliance
with legal, regulatory and reporting requirements. Business change and transformation success is dependent on migration of a significant number of datasets and our inability to effectively accomplish this could adversely affect the Group’s results.A control breakdown or service failure in the Group’s Assessment & Qualifications businesses could result in financial loss and reputational damage.
The Group’s Assessment & Qualifications businesses involve complex contractual relationships with both government agencies and commercial customers for the provision of various testing services. The Group’s financial results, growth prospects and/or reputation may be adversely affected if these contracts and relationships are poorly managed or face increased competitive pressures.
There are inherent risks associated with the Group’s Assessment & Qualifications businesses, both in the US and the UK. A service failure caused by a breakdown in testing and assessment processes could lead to a
8
mis-grading
of student tests and/or late delivery of test results to students and their schools. In either event the Group may be subject to legal claims, penalty charges under contracts,non-renewal
of contracts and/or the suspension or withdrawal of its accreditation to conduct tests. A late delivery of qualification results could result in a potentially significant regulatory fine in addition to the contractual penalties. It is also possible that such events would result in adverse publicity, which may affect the Group’s ability to retain existing contracts and/or obtain new customers.Operational disruption to its business, including that caused by third party providers, a major disaster and/or external threats, could restrict the Group’s ability to supply products and services to its customers.
Across all its businesses, the Group manages complex operational and logistical arrangements including distribution centers, data centers, and educational and office facilities, as well as relationships with third party print sites. It has also outsourced some support functions, including information technology, warehousing and logistics to third party providers. The failure of third parties to whom it has outsourced business functions could adversely affect its reputation or financial condition. Failure to recover from a major disaster, (e.g. fire, flood, etc.) at a key facility or the disruption of supply from a key third party vendor or partner (e.g. due to bankruptcy) could restrict the Group’s ability to service its customers and meet the terms of its contractual relationships with both government agencies and commercial customers. Penalty clauses and/or the failure to retain these contracts at the end of the contract term could adversely impact future revenues.
Failure to adequately protect learners could result in significant harm to one or more learners.
Incidents have occurred and may in future occur where learners may not have been, or may not be, adequately protected. For example, where the Group has direct learner contact via online learning, or in its direct delivery businesses where it is operating, either directly or in a third- party partnership. These incidents can cause harm to learners, which is something the Group takes extremely seriously, and could also have a negative financial, legal and reputational impact to the business.
Failure to effectively manage risks associated with compliance to global and local anti-bribery and corruption (ABC) legislation could result in costly legal investigations and/or adversely impact the Group’s reputation.
The Group is committed to an effective compliance program in keeping with changing regulatory expectations, and it is also committed to conducting business in a legal and ethical manner in compliance with local and international statutory requirements and standards applicable to its business. Despite those commitments, there is a risk that the Group’s management, employees or representatives may take actions that violate applicable laws and regulations including regarding accurate keeping of books and records or prohibiting the making of improper payments for the purposes of obtaining or keeping business, including laws such as the US Foreign Corrupt Practices Act or the UK Bribery Act. Any regulatory inquiry or investigations, could be costly, require a significant amount of management’s time and attention, adversely impact the Group’s reputation, or lead to litigation and financial impacts.
Failure to comply with antitrust and competition legislation and/or legal or regulatory proceedings could result in substantial financial cost and/or adversely impact the Group’s reputation.
The Group is subject to global and local antitrust and competition law and although it is committed to conducting business in compliance with local and international laws, there is a risk that management, employees or representatives may act in a way that violates applicable antitrust or competition laws. Further, the Group and its subsidiaries are and may be in the future subject to legal and regulatory proceedings in the countries in which the Group operates. These proceedings could result in greater scrutiny of the Group’s operations in other countries for anti-competitive behavior and, in the worst case, incur a substantial financial cost. This would also have an adverse impact on the Group’s reputation.
9
Risks Related to Operations
The accelerated pace and scope of our business transformation initiatives increase our risk to execution timelines and to business adoption of change. The risk is that benefits may not be fully realized, costs may increase, or that the Group’s business as usual activities are adversely impacted.
Business transformation and change initiatives in support of the Group’s strategic goals to accelerate its digital transition and to simplify its business continued throughout 2020 and 2021. A range of transformation initiatives were completed during 2020 and 2021. In 2021, the Group announced a new strategy which has the potential for increased risk as the organisational structure and financial reporting processes are realigned in order to pursue the new strategy. The pace and scope of change potentially increases the risk that not all these changes will deliver within anticipated timeframes, and that the costs of these changes may increase. In addition, as a result of the increased pressure of transformational change, business as usual activities may not perform in line with plans, or the level of customer service may not meet expectations. In parallel with the business transformation, as the Group responds to the transition to digital and virtual learning, it will continue to look at opportunities to develop business models and further refine organization structures. Resistance to change could restrict the organization from making the necessary changes to the business model.
If the Group fails to attract, retain and develop appropriately skilled employees, it may limit its ability to achieve its strategic and operational goals and its business may be harmed.
The Group’s success depends on the skill, experience and engagement of its employees. It has a key dependency on the Chief Executive and certain key employees. If it is unable to attract, retain and develop sufficiently experienced and capable staff, especially in technology, product development, sales and leadership, its business and financial results may suffer. When talented employees leave, the Group may have difficulty replacing those skills, and its business may suffer. There can be no assurance that the Group will be able to successfully attract and retain the skills that it needs.
All the Group’s businesses depend on Information Technology (IT) systems and technological change. Failure to maintain and support customer facing services, systems, and platforms, including addressing quality issues and execution on time of new products and enhancements, could negatively impact the Group’s sales and reputation.
All the Group’s businesses, to a greater or lesser extent, are dependent on IT. It either provides software and/or internet services to its customers or uses complex IT systems and products to support its business activities, including customer-facing systems, back-office processing and infrastructure. The Group faces several technological risks associated with software product development and service delivery, information technology security (including viruses and cyber-attacks),
e-commerce,
enterprise resource planning system implementation and upgrades. Although plans and procedures are in place to reduce such risks, from time to time the Group has experienced verifiable attacks on its systems by unauthorized parties. To date, such attacks have not resulted in any material damage, but the Group’s businesses could be adversely affected if its systems and infrastructure experience a significant failure or interruption.Failure to adequately protect the health, safety and well-being of the Group’s employees, learners and other stakeholders could adversely impact the Group’s reputation, profitability and future growth.
Although the Group has invested in global health and safety procedures and controls to safeguard the health, safety and wellbeing of its employees and other stakeholders, accidents or incidents could still occur due to unforeseen risks, causing injury or harm to individuals and impacting the Group’s business operations. The effects of the
COVID-19
pandemic may exacerbate the risk. This has the potential to lead to criminal and civil litigation, business disruption leading to operational loss, reduction in profitability and impact on the Group’s reputation.10
Failure to ensure security for the Group’s staff, learners, assets and reputation, due to increasing numbers of and variety of local and global threats.
Pearson is a global business with locations in diverse, sometimes high-risk, locations worldwide. Although it has protective measures in place to secure its staff, learners and assets, the Group could still be impacted by external threats, such as localized incidents, terrorist attacks, strikes or extreme weather. Future occurrences could cause harm to individuals and/or disrupt business operations. These have the potential to lead to operational loss, a reduction in profitability and impact on the Group’s global reputation.
Failure to meet our customers’ rapidly changing expectations in our products and services and not being able to anticipate new customer demands could result in reduced market share, profitability and brand erosion.
We continue to adjust our business model to keep a pace with the increasing end user demands. The group may not be able to adapt, change and succeed in a rapidly changing and uncertain environment resulting in competitive disadvantage, higher cost and brand erosion.
With the focus of direct to consumer strategy and the launch of new products we risk that the customer experience expectations are not met with regard to how the products and services are delivered e.g. quality and timeliness, impacting the customer’s brand loyalty and propensity to purchase; resulting in customer complaints, less favorable social media sentiment, bad reviews, low recommendations, and customer attrition.
There is also the risk that our technology and data dependent products and services do not meet accessibility requirements in respect of customers’ and prospective customers’ ability to access the products and services, and this could result in increased costs, restrictions and fines.
The Group’s business, results of operations and financial condition have been and could further be adversely affected by the effects of the global
COVID-19
pandemic and subsequent consumer and enterprise trends.Restrictions on movement of individuals and forced business closures due to the
COVID-19
pandemic and efforts to contain it have had and could continue to have an impact on the Group’s financial results, in particular where test centres are forced to close or high stakes examinations are cancelled.Consumer behaviours have also been changed as a result of
on-off
lockdown restrictions in major markets since March 2020. This has included increased moves to online learning, online testing (proctoring) and shifts away from multi-year formal qualifications. The Group has offerings in areas which benefit from many of these trends but the gains may not be sufficient to offset any losses from erosion of the Group’s traditional markets. In particular, these trends may lead to lower revenue, prices and profitability.Changes in government policy and/or regulations have the potential to affect the Group’s business model and/ or decisions across all markets.
The Group’s educational services and assessment businesses may be adversely affected by changes in government funding resulting from either trends that are beyond the Group’s direct control, such as general economic conditions, changes in government educational funding, programs, policy decisions, legislation and/or changes in the procurement process, or the Group’s failure to successfully deliver previous contracts. These may also include decisions to suspend or permanently cancel high stakes testing impacting our assessments businesses.
The results and growth of the Group’s US educational services and assessment businesses are dependent on the level of federal and state educational funding, which in turn is dependent on the robustness of state finances and the level of funding allocated to educational programs. State, local and municipal education funding pressures remain, competition from low price and disruptive new business models continues and open source is promoted as a way to keep costs down for customers. The current challenging environment could impact the
11
Group’s ability to collect education-related debt. State and local government leadership changes and resultant shifts in education policy can also affect the funding available for educational expenditure, which include the impact of educational reform. Similarly, changes in the government procurement process for textbooks, learning material and student tests, and vocational training programs can also affect the Group’s markets. Political pressure on testing, changes in curricula, delays in the timing of the adoptions and changes in the student testing process can all affect these programs and therefore the size of the market in any given year. Uncertainty remains over the longer term impact of international trading arrangements and general economic conditions in the UK as a result of Brexit, and globally as a result of the
COVID-19
pandemic, among other examples of wider uncertainty and instability in the rest of the world, any of which can affect governments education policy and decisions.Climate Transition — Environmental, social and governance risks may adversely impact the Group’s business.
The Group considers environmental, social and governance (ESG) risks no differently to the way it manages any other business risk. These include ethical business behavior, compliance with UN Global Compact standards, environmental impact, people and editorial standards. A failure to comply with such standards could adversely affect the Group’s reputation and have a negative impact on its relations with employees, vendors and customers.
Supply Chain — A lack of sufficient capital resources could adversely impact the Group’s ability to operate.
If the global economy weakens further and/or the global financial markets collapse, as a result of the
COVID-19
pandemic or otherwise, the Group may not have access to or could lose its bank deposits or suffer a significant increase in customer bad debts. Lack of sufficient capital resources could significantly limit the Group’s ability to take advantage of business and strategic opportunities. If replacement funds are not available, the Group may be required to delay, reduce the scope of, or eliminate material parts of its business strategy, including potential additional acquisitions or development of new products, services and technologies.Inflation — Rising global inflation could increase costs and adversely impact the Group’s profits and financial performance.
Rising global inflation factors could increase the cost of production for Pearson. There is no guarantee that we can increase prices or reduce cost for products and services that can mitigate the effects of inflation, which could lead to reduced earnings and ability to invest in future growth.
Ukraine — the unfolding situation in Ukraine and its regulatory and macroeconomic consequences, including in respect of sanctions, could impact the Group’s cost base and supply chain and have a material adverse impact on the Group’s operations, profits and financial performance.
On 24 February 2022, Russian troops entered Ukraine. This has resulted in sanctions being imposed on Russia and Belarus by numerous countries, including the United Kingdom and the United States. As Pearson’s operations in Russia, Belarus and Ukraine are small, the direct impact of the invasion and related sanctions on Group sales, profits and cash is expected to be immaterial. However, the full impact, particularly in the event of an escalation of the conflict beyond those countries, cannot be determined at this time. The conflict and associated sanctions could also increase the risk associated with other risks such as inflation due to energy and food supply issues or increased risk of cyber attacks, any of which could have a material adverse impact on the Group’s operations, profits and financial performance.
Changes in tax law or perceptions on tax planning strategies may lead to a higher effective tax rate or negative reputational impact.
Changes in corporate tax rates and/or other relevant tax laws in the UK, US or other jurisdictions could have a material impact on the Group’s future reported tax rate and/or its future tax payments. The application of tax
12
legislation can be complex and tax authorities may take a different view to management. The Group has been subject to audit by tax authorities. In particular, the Group is under assessment from the tax authorities in Brazil challenging the deduction for tax purposes of goodwill amortisation for the years 2012 to 2017 (similar assessments may be raised for other years). In addition, the Group has lodged an appeal against the European Commission’s decision that the United Kingdom controlled foreign company group financing partial exemption (FCPE) partially constitutes State Aid. Although the Group believes its tax provision is reasonable, the final determination of its tax liability could be materially different from its historical income tax provisions, which could have a material effect on the Group’s financial position, results of operations or cash flows.
The Group’s tax strategy reflects its business strategy and the locations and financing needs of its operations. In common with many companies, the Group seeks to manage its tax affairs to protect value for its shareholders, in line with its broader fiduciary duties. The Group is committed to complying with all statutory obligations, to undertake full disclosure to tax authorities and to follow agreed policies and procedures with regard to tax planning and strategy.
The Group generates a substantial proportion of its revenue in foreign currencies, particularly the US dollar, and foreign exchange rate fluctuations could adversely affect the Group’s earnings and the strength of its balance sheet.
As with any international business, the Group’s earnings can be materially affected by exchange rate movements. The main exposure is to movements in the US dollar to sterling exchange rate as approximately 69% of the Group’s total revenue is generated in US dollars. The Group also has exposure to a range of other international currencies including emerging market currencies.
The Group’s reported earnings and cash flows may be adversely affected by changes in its pension costs and funding requirements.
The Group operates a number of pension plans throughout the world, the principal ones being in the UK and the US. The major plans are self-administered with the plans’ assets held independently of the Group. Regular valuations, conducted by independent qualified actuaries, are used to determine pension costs and funding requirements. As these assets’ valuations can fluctuate, the plans may require additional funding from the Group, which could have an adverse impact on its results.
It is the Group’s policy to ensure that each pension plan is adequately funded, over time, to meet its ongoing and future liabilities. The UK Group plan expects to be able to provide benefits (in accordance with the plan rules) with a very low level of reliance on future funding from the Group. The Group’s earnings and cash flows may be adversely affected by the need to provide additional funding to eliminate pension fund deficits in its defined benefit plans. The Group’s greatest exposure relates to the UK defined benefit pension plan, which is valued every three years. Pension fund deficits may arise because of inadequate investment returns, increased member life expectancy, changes in actuarial assumptions and changes in pension regulations, including accounting rules and minimum funding requests.
Although the UK defined benefit plan is significantly
de-risked
(given, in addition to ade-risked
investment policy, it was also in significant surplus as at 1 January 2021, being the date of the last triennial valuation) the ability to achieve and maintain this standard remains subject to market conditions, meaning that additional funding could still be required from the Group in the future.ITEM 4. | INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY |
Pearson plc, (Pearson or the Group) is a worldwide learning company with its principal operations in the education, assessment and certifications markets. The Group delivers content, assessment and services, powered by technology, in order to drive personalized learning at scale. The Group creates and manages intellectual
13
property, which it promotes and sells to its customers under well-known brand names. The Group delivers its content in a variety of forms and through a variety of channels, with emphasis on digital services. Though it has a presence in circa 200 countries around the world, today its largest markets are North America (67% of 2021 sales) and Europe (including the UK) (18% of 2021 sales).
Pearson was incorporated and registered in 1897 under the laws of England and Wales as a limited company and
re-registered
under the UK Companies Act as a public limited company in 1981. The Group conducts its operations primarily through its subsidiaries and other affiliates. Its principal executive offices are located at 80 Strand, London WC2R 0RL, United Kingdom (telephone: +44 20 7010 2000) and its website address is https://plc.pearson.com/Overview
The Group is a leading provider of educational materials and learning technologies. It provides test development, processing and scoring services to governments, educational institutions, corporations and professional bodies around the world. It provides content across the curriculum and a range of education services including teacher development, educational software and system-wide solutions, it owns and operates colleges and schools (including virtual schools).
The Group is run as one global learning company, operating around six geographical areas (UK, Europe, US, Canada, Asia Pacific, Other countries) organized in five main global business divisions, each of which are reporting segments (Virtual Learning, Higher Education, English Language Learning, Workforce Skills and Assessment & Qualifications). Within each geographical area, the Group provides content, assessment and digital services to schools, colleges and universities, as well as professional and vocational education to learners. The results of the Businesses under Strategic Review are reported separately.
Recent developments
On 11 March 2022, Apollo Global Management, Inc. and its subsidiaries (“Apollo”), on behalf of certain of its affiliated funds, announced that it was in the preliminary stages of evaluating a possible cash offer by certain of Apollo’s affiliated funds for Pearson. Apollo further noted that there could be no certainty that any offer would be made, nor as to the terms on which any such offer might be made, and that, in accordance with Rule 2.6(a) of the City Code on Takeovers and Mergers (the “Code”), Apollo was required, by not later than 5.00 p.m. UK on 8 April 2022 either to announce a firm intention to make an offer for Pearson in accordance with Rule 2.7 of the Code or announce that it does not intend to make an offer for Pearson, in which case the announcement would be treated as a statement to which Rule 2.8 of the Code applies (a “Rule 2.8 Announcement”).
Further on 11 March 2022, Pearson announced that it had previously received two unsolicited, preliminary and highly conditional proposals from Apollo regarding a possible cash offer for the entire issued and to be issued share capital of the Company, on 5th November 2021 for 800 pence per share and on 7th March 2022 for a total value of 854.2 pence per share, being 840 pence per share plus the 2021 final dividend of 14.2 pence per share which has been announced but not yet paid (the “2021 Final Dividend”). The Board of Pearson had considered each of these proposals, together with its financial and legal advisers, and had concluded in each case that the proposal significantly undervalued the Company and its future prospects. Accordingly, the Board of Pearson had unanimously rejected each proposal.
On 30 March 2022, Apollo issued a Rule 2.8 Announcement confirming that it did not intend to make a formal offer for Pearson. Subsequently on 30 March 2022, Pearson acknowledged Apollo’s Rule 2.8 Announcement and noted that on 28 March 2022 it had received a third such proposal from Apollo for a total value of 884.2 pence per share, being 870 pence per share plus the 2021 Final Dividend of 14.2 pence per share for eligible shareholders, which the Board had considered, together with its financial and legal advisers, and had concluded that it significantly undervalued the Company and its future prospects and accordingly had rejected it, leading to Apollo’s Rule 2.8 Announcement earlier that day.
14
Selected consolidated financial data
The table below shows selected consolidated financial data under IFRS as issued by the IASB and in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006 and in accordance with
UK-adopted
IFRS. The selected consolidated income statement data for the years ended December 31, 2021, 2020 and 2019 and the selected consolidated balance sheet data as at December 31, 2021 and 2020 have been derived from the Group’s audited consolidated financial statements included in “Item 18. Financial Statements” in this Annual Report.On May 5, 2017, the Group announced that it was undertaking a strategic review of its US
K-12
courseware business. The USK-12
business was classified as held for sale on the Group’s balance sheet as at December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2018. On March 29, 2019 the Group completed the sale of its USK-12
courseware business to Nexus Capital Management LP resulting in apre-tax
profit on sale of $13m.On October 5, 2017 the Group completed the sale of a 22% share in Penguin Random House to Bertelsmann, retaining a 25% share. Following the announcement of planned sale of the remaining 25% share in December 2019, the business was classified as held for sale on the Group’s balance sheet as at December 31, 2019. On April 1, 2020, the Group completed the sale of the remaining 25% share in Penguin Random House to Bertelsmann resulting in a
pre-tax
profit on sale of £180m.In November 2020, the Group announced the sale of its interests in Pearson Institute of Higher Education (PIHE) in South Africa. The business was classified as held for sale on the Group’s balance sheet as at December 31, 2020. The sale completed on February 5, 2021 for nominal consideration realising a loss on disposal of £5m in 2021.
In March 2021, the Group announced that it was launching a strategic review of its international courseware local publishing businesses. The strategic review is progressing in line with plan. The related assets have been assessed in light of IFRS 5
‘Non-current
Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations’ and they do not meet the criteria to be classified as held for sale at 31 December 2021.In October 2021, the sale of the Group’s interests in K12 Sistemas in Brazil was completed, realizing a profit of £84m.
There were no significant acquisitions made in 2019 or 2020.
In September 2021, Pearson completed the acquisition of 100% of the share capital of Faethm Holdings Pty Limited (Faethm) for £65m, having already held 9% of the share capital previously. Faethm will form part of the Workforce Skills Division.
The Group made two additional acquisitions of subsidiaries, Opinion Interactive LLC in February 2021 and MZ Development Inc. in July 2021, for total consideration of £11m. In both cases, the Group acquired 100% of the share capital of the respective entities. Both will be part of the Assessment & Qualifications division.
On 28 January 2022, the Group completed the acquisition of 100% of the share capital of Credly Inc., having previously held a 19.9% interest in the Company. Total consideration is c$200m, comprising upfront cash consideration of c$142m, Pearson’s existing interest valued at c$42m and c$16m of deferred consideration. Net assets acquired will mainly comprise acquired intangible assets. Credly will also form part of the Workforce Skills division.
In January 2022, the Group received $117m in relation to full and final payment of the remaining receivable balance which arose on the disposal of the US
K-12
business in 2019.In February 2022, the Group renegotiated its revolving credit facility, extending the maturity of $1bn of the facility by one year to 2026.
15
On 24 February 2022, the Board approved a £350m share buyback programme in order to return capital to shareholders. The programme is expected to commence in 2022.
The selected consolidated financial information should be read in conjunction with “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects” and the Group’s consolidated financial statements and the related notes appearing elsewhere in this Annual Report. The information provided below is not necessarily indicative of the results that may be expected from future operations.
For convenience, the Group has translated the 2021 amounts into US dollars at the rate of £1.00 = $1.35, the noon buying rate in The City of New York for cable transfers and foreign currencies as certified by the Federal Reserve Bank of New York for customs purposes on December 31, 2021.
Year Ended December 31 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2021 | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | 2018 | 2017 | |||||||||||||||||||
$ | £ | £ | £ | £ | £ | |||||||||||||||||||
(In millions, except for per share amounts) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Consolidated Income Statement data | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 4,628 | 3,428 | 3,397 | 3,869 | 4,129 | 4,513 | ||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit/(loss) | 247 | 183 | 411 | 275 | 553 | 451 | ||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) after taxation from continuing operations | 216 | 160 | 310 | 266 | 590 | 408 | ||||||||||||||||||
Profit/(loss) for the financial year | 216 | 160 | 310 | 266 | 590 | 408 | ||||||||||||||||||
Consolidated Earnings data per share | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Basic earnings/(loss) per equity share(1) | 28.5¢ | 21.1p | 41.0p | 34.0p | 75.6p | 49.9p | ||||||||||||||||||
Diluted earnings/(loss) per equity share(2) | 28.2¢ | 20.9p | 41.0p | 34.0p | 75.5p | 49.9p | ||||||||||||||||||
Basic earnings/(loss) from continuing operations per equity share(1) | 28.5¢ | 21.1p | 41.0p | 34.0p | 75.6p | 49.9p | ||||||||||||||||||
Diluted earnings/(loss) from continuing operations per equity share(2) | 28.2¢ | 20.9p | 41.0p | 34.0p | 75.5p | 49.9p | ||||||||||||||||||
Dividends per ordinary share | 27.7¢ | 20.5p | 19.5p | 19.5p | 18.5p | 17.0p | ||||||||||||||||||
Consolidated Balance Sheet data at period end | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total assets (non-current assets plus current assets) | 9,913 | 7,343 | 7,451 | 7,650 | 7,905 | 7,888 | ||||||||||||||||||
Net assets | 5,778 | 4,280 | 4,134 | 4,323 | 4,525 | 4,021 | ||||||||||||||||||
Long-term obligations(3) | (2,002 | ) | (1,483 | ) | (1,672 | ) | (1,835 | ) | (1,246 | ) | (1,662 | ) | ||||||||||||
Capital stock | 255 | 189 | 188 | 195 | 195 | 200 | ||||||||||||||||||
Number of equity shares outstanding (millions of ordinary shares) | 757 | 757 | 753 | 782 | 781 | 802 |
Notes:
(1) | Basic earnings per equity share is based on profit for the financial period and the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the period. |
(2) | Diluted earnings per equity share is based on diluted earnings for the financial period and the diluted weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the period. Diluted earnings comprise earnings adjusted for the tax benefit on the conversion of share options by employees and the weighted average number of ordinary shares adjusted for the dilutive effect of share options. |
(3) | Long-term obligations comprise any liabilities with a maturity of more than one year, including medium and long-term borrowings, derivative financial instruments, pension obligations, long-term provisions, deferred income and tax liabilities. |
Dividend information
The Group pays dividends to holders of ordinary shares on dates that are fixed in accordance with the guidelines of the London Stock Exchange. The board of directors normally declares an interim dividend in July or August of each year to be paid in September or October. The board of directors normally recommends a final
16
dividend following the end of the fiscal year to which it relates, to be paid in the following May or June, subject to shareholders’ approval at the annual general meeting. At the Group’s annual general meeting on April 29, 2022 shareholders will be asked to approve a final dividend of 14.2p per ordinary share for the year ended December 31, 2021.
The table below sets forth the amounts of interim, final and total dividends paid in respect of each fiscal year indicated and is translated into cents per ordinary share at the noon buying rate in The City of New York on each of the respective payment dates for interim and final dividends. The final dividend for the 2021 fiscal year will be paid on May 6, 2022 (subject to shareholder approval).
Fiscal year | Interim | Final | Total | Interim | Final | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
(Pence per ordinary share) | (Cents per ordinary share) | |||||||||||||||||||||||
2021 | 6.3 | 14.2 | 20.5 | 8.5 | 19.2 | * | 27.7 | |||||||||||||||||
2020 | 6.0 | 13.5 | 19.5 | 7.7 | 18.5 | 26.2 | ||||||||||||||||||
2019 | 6.0 | 13.5 | 19.5 | 8.0 | 16.7 | 24.7 | ||||||||||||||||||
2018 | 5.5 | 13.0 | 18.5 | 7.2 | 16.9 | 24.1 | ||||||||||||||||||
2017 | 5.0 | 12.0 | 17.0 | 6.8 | 16.2 | 23.0 |
* | As the 2021 final dividend had not been paid by the filing date, the dividend has been translated into cents using the noon buying rate for sterling as at December 31, 2021. |
Future dividends will be dependent on the Group’s future earnings, financial condition and cash flow, as well as other factors affecting the Group.
The Group’s strategy
The Group’s mission is to create vibrant and enriching learning experiences designed for real life impact and its vision is that everyone can realize the life they imagine through learning. At Pearson, we add life to a lifetime of learning. With us, learning isn’t just something to get through; it’s a chance for a breakthrough. A challenging, enriching experience you undertake knowing it’s taking you forward and making an impact.
Following the appointment of Andy Bird as CEO in October 2020, the Group announced a new strategy. That strategy, developed closely with the Board and unveiled in March 2021, is based around establishing a lifelong, direct relationship with consumers. Our priorities continue to centre on building a company that is digital first, puts the consumer at its heart, and delivers high quality learning products at scale to more people than ever before.
To do that, we created a new organisational structure with five core divisions. The new divisions are: Assessment & Qualifications, Virtual Learning, English Language Learning, Workforce Skills and Higher Education. In addition, the International Courseware local publishing businesses are under strategic review and during this time are being managed as a separate division, known as Strategic Review.
These divisions are underpinned by a dedicated direct to consumer team that successfully launched Pearson+ last July. We have also recently introduced a new company purpose: ‘to add life to a lifetime of learning.’ We redefined Pearson’s purpose for the new reality of a world in which learning is becoming more fluid and exists inside and outside of formal education.
We believe that the success of Pearson and the work we do has never been more important. The world is changing, and the very definition of learning is expanding. We no longer move only in a linear fashion through school, into higher education, and then on to employment. All of us are learning all the time. Pearson is
re-focused
andre-organized
to capitalize on this new wave of learning.We also recognize that learning is no longer a phase of life, it’s a lifelong journey. The need to upskill and reskill has never been more urgent. So, while we’ll continue to work with long standing partners such as schools,
17
universities, and colleges, we are also increasingly working with employers. Companies now play a critical role in that learning lifecycle and we have an opportunity to help individuals and employers turn the great resignation into the great
re-engagement.
The recent acquisitions of Faethm and Credly in our Workforce Skills division signal the direction of travel you can expect from us, including the expansion into data as a service for employers and into credentialing for workers. In English Language Learning, we are building a business aimed at being the destination for committed English learners. We are focused on continuing to grow our institutional business and high stakes assessments, while building adirect-to
consumer strategy.There are three reasons why we believe Pearson can win in this new environment:
1. | We are the world’s leading learning company with a strong brand, an unmatched scope and scale; and have the deep expertise of thousands of employees who deliver high quality, trusted learning solutions every day. |
2. | We have a great foundation of established businesses that are well-managed, cash generative and underpin the company financially. |
3. | We are bringing together the multiple facets of our expertise to deliver innovative digital learning products through a more connected commercial and consumer strategy. |
Pearson is not just a collection of individual businesses, but, increasingly, a highly interconnected company, with capabilities that work together to help people learn at multiple points in their lives. Pearson has the potential to accelerate growth when we leverage our businesses in a coordinated fashion across the entire spectrum of learning.
Pearson+ is critical to fulfilling that strategy. We’re building Pearson+ as the premier digital learning ecosystem for life — whether through school, university, work, languages, or life skills — for a growing addressable market globally. Pearson+ will become the core digital offering for this company, reaching multiple demographics and learners, giving us the opportunity to create a meaningful business on a global scale. Consumers need a way to discover, learn, build skills, and show credentials and they want a great user experience. We can deliver that with a broader Pearson+ vision, by drawing on the assets of each Pearson business and leveraging our growing relationships with students, consumers, and enterprises. We can also support this with a robust data infrastructure. The possibilities are vast when we can connect these assets into one trusted ecosystem designed to meet
consumer-led
learning where it happens.We also continue to evolve our sustainable business strategy to align with our company strategy and purpose and to drive learning for everyone. We have placed renewed energy into building our talent and our innovation culture, so our people can make a difference at scale. As we become more digital, we’re providing products with a smaller carbon footprint, along with products and services that meet the demands of a green economy and content that influences action. As such, we are on track with our goal to make Pearson a net zero carbon business by 2030.
We believe our strategic priorities, combined with our disciplined approach to capital allocation, will enable us to create sustainable, long-term value for every Pearson stakeholder.
Operating divisions
Pearson is the world’s leading learning company, serving customers in nearly 200 countries with digital content, assessments, qualifications, and data.
As a result of the new strategy announced in March 2021, the operating segments reported to the Group’s chief operating decision-maker, the Pearson Executive Management team, have changed from 1 July 2021 to reflect the new structure. There are now five main global business divisions, which are each considered separate operating segments for management and reporting purposes. These five divisions are Assessment &
18
Qualifications, Virtual Learning, English Language Learning, Workforce Skills and Higher Education. In addition, the International Courseware local publishing businesses are under strategic review and during this time are being managed as a separate division, known as Strategic Review. For the comparative periods, the Group has separately disclosed the results from the Penguin Random
House associate to the point of disposal in April
2020.
Assessment & Qualifications
Assessment & Qualifications comprises Pearson VUE, US School Assessment, Clinical Assessment, UK GCSE and A Levels and International academic qualifications.
As people
up-skill
andre-skill
more often in their lives, they are increasingly looking to some form of certification to prove their achievement. Everything we do across our five divisions has the potential to lead to some form of assessment, qualification or certificate, ensuring this division is our largest business by revenue and consumer reach.Our Assessment & Qualifications division provides the assessments, qualifications, certifications and licences that enable people to demonstrate their knowledge, skills and aptitude across a lifetime of learning, from school to professional careers. The learning we offer in all our other divisions has the potential to lead to some form of assessment, qualification, certification or licence, and this continues to be a significant opportunity for us.
Our partners include major multinational employers, governments, schools and professional bodies, and our services are used in some of the fastest growing institutions and industries in the world, such as
K-12
(primary/secondary) schools in the US, healthcare, cloud computing and IT. The division operates through four business units: Pearson VUE; US Student Assessment; UK & International Qualifications; and Clinical Assessment.Through Pearson VUE, learners validate what they have learned in order to gain a certificate or licence. Learners take nearly 17 million exams through Pearson VUE each year in more than 200 countries. To best serve customers and help people advance in their careers during the pandemic, Pearson VUE enabled millions of people to test remotely from their home, emerging as a large player in online invigilation.
Pearson’s US Student Assessment division acts as a partner with states, districts and educators to help
K-12
students advance at an appropriate pace in their schooling. UK & International Qualifications develops highly sought after academic and vocational qualifications.Clinical Assessment provides psychological assessment in health and education. The business produces hundreds of scientifically backed products and solutions designed to help experts understand how people learn. The team brings together innovation with quality test design to develop effective tools for children and adults, educators and clinicians.
See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Results of Operations — Year Ended December 31, 2021 compared to year ended December 31, 2020 — Sales and operating profit by division —” for a discussion of developments during 2021 with respect to this segment.
Assessment
& Qualifications
Virtual Learning
Virtual Learning comprises our Virtual Schools and Online Program Management (OPM) businesses.
There is a growing international demand for virtual schooling, partly down to advances in technology, but also accelerated by the recent pandemic.
Our Virtual Learning division offers highly effective online learning for every age and stage of education. Users are able to learn where, when, and how they learn best, giving them a truly personalized experience. It’s designed to be smart, flexible, and inspiring education that propels people forward in their lives and careers.
19
Students in grades
K-12
in the US (equivalent to primary and secondary school in the UK) can enrol in full-time online public or private school programs offered by Pearson Virtual Schools. Fully accredited and staffed with specially trained teachers, these online schools have been providing high quality alternatives to the traditional classroom experience for over 20 years. Students are prepared to be adaptable; equipped with the academic and life skills they need to thrive today and in an ever-changing world.K-12
online school options include Connections Academy(US-based
public schools), Pearson Online Academies (international private schools), and programs for school districts across the US.Adult learners, universities and employers rely on Pearson for exclusive online higher education programs and Online Program Management (OPM) services, including degrees, certificates and short courses. Students gain access to convenient, compelling online learning to boost employability and advance in their careers, while higher education institutions extend their reach and provide the flexible online options their students want.
For employers, our OPM business delivers vital upskilling and reskilling to keep pace with the future of work. This business operates in the US and internationally.
See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Results of Operations — Year Ended December 31, 2021 compared to year ended December 31, 2020 — Sales and operating profit by division — Virtual Learning” for a discussion of developments during 2021 with respect to this segment.
English Language Learning
The English Language Learning division comprises Pearson Test of English, Institutional Courseware and English Online Solutions.
English is a mandatory requirement in more than 140 national curricula, and there are over 1.5 billion people worldwide learning English today. We aim to be the world’s leading destination for committed English language learners – people willing to dedicate time and money to their English learning. We want to work with those committed learners to help them achieve their full potential in life through improved English proficiency.
We have a set of strong, unique assets to support our English learners. The Global Scale of English, a leading global measurement standard, enables people to gauge and track their progress in English. The Pearson Test of English is a digital test with AI scoring that provides fast, accurate, secure, and unbiased results. We are widely available in 118 countries, thanks to our network of 389 Pearson VUE test centres. It is a trusted brand for entry into higher education and a gateway to immigration recognized by regulators in the main receiving countries.
We also offer digital and blended English solutions to academic institutions and private language schools in 163 countries around the world, bringing together courseware and assessment with teacher support and learning platforms.
See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Results of Operations — Year Ended December 31, 2021 compared to year ended December 31, 2020 — Sales and operating profit by division —” for a discussion of developments during 2021 with respect to this segment.
English Language Learning
Workforce Skills
Workforce Skills comprises BTEC, GED, TalentLens, Pearson College and Apprenticeships. It also now encompasses recently acquired businesses, Faethm and Credly.
The world of work is changing fast, creating a need for constant upskilling and reskilling, both from organisations looking to support their employees, and from individuals looking to make changes in their careers.
20
In our Workforce Skills division, we are creating a world where everyone is prepared for the future of work, and where success is no longer only about what you’ve done but what you can do.
The global talent market has never been more important than it is today, and we are positioned to meet the needs of employees and employers in a changing global economy. We help employers understand labour market dynamics and how best to futureproof their workforces at scale, while helping workers gain the skills they need to boost their employability and open up new job and career prospects.
Our unique offer uses workforce analysis, personalized learning, assessment and verified skills credentials to close skills gaps, realize untapped potential and mobilize talent. We help employers understand, maintain and enhance the value of their most important asset – their people – and help employees make important breakthroughs in their careers.
See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Results of Operations — Year Ended December 31, 2021 compared to year ended December 31, 2020 — Sales and operating profit by division —” for a discussion of developments during 2021 with respect to this segment.
Workforce Skills
Higher Education
Higher Education comprises our US, Canadian and International Higher Education Courseware businesses.
Pearson creates personalized, digital learning experiences for higher education and college students and believe that the future of learning and our US Higher Education Courseware business is increasingly digitally driven.
Pearson is the leader in producing higher education learning media in North America, as well as reaching into other major markets around the world. We offer vibrant digital content with enriching experiences that lead to positive learning outcomes for more than 10 million higher education students every year.
We partner with thousands of expert authors to create content in more than 100 academic disciplines. We are leaders in science, technology, engineering and maths (STEM), as well as IT among other disciplines. Our leading content is delivered through digital eBooks and popular interactive multimedia on platforms such as MyLab, including new Interactive Labs; Mastering; Revel; and Pearson+.
In July 2021, we launched Pearson+, asubscription experience that gives students simple and affordable access to eBooks and study tools. Pearson+ was designed with input from authors and students and is winning praise from students, faculty, and authors.
direct-to-consumer
In addition to helping build stronger student relationships, Pearson+ will shift commerce away from secondary market sellers to our owned sites and apps. This gives students a reliable
e-commerce
experience and access to the most current learning content and study tools.Our higher education products are guided by professional insights from educators and by preferences expressed by faculties. They are supported by technology that is stable, secure and accessible. We are committed to ensuring that diversity, equality, and inclusion are integral to our products so that everyone can realize the life they imagine through learning, whatever their background or abilities.
See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Results of Operations — Year ended December 31, 2021 compared to year ended December 31, 2020 — Sales and operating profit by division “” for a discussion of developments during 2021 with respect to this segment.
Higher Education
Strategic Review
Strategic Review comprises the International Courseware local publishing businesses.
21
Operating cycles
The Group determines a normal operating cycle separately for each entity/cash generating unit with distinct economic characteristics. The “normal operating cycle” for each of the Group’s businesses is primarily based on the expected period over which content or services will generate cash flows.
The Higher Education courseware market is primarily driven by an adoption cycle, with colleges and professors typically refreshing their courses and selecting revised programs on a regular basis, often in line with the release of new content or new technology offerings. The Company renews its product development assets to reflect new content and capabilities which enhance the attractiveness of its offering to both educators and learners.
Analysis of historical data shows that the typical life cycle of Higher Education content is up to 5 years but varies by product. In addition to content, the Group also develops technology platforms for products and the life cycle for these platforms can be in excess of the 5 years cycle for content. Again, the operating cycle for content and platforms mirrors the market cycle.
Historically for a major content refresh a development phase of typically 12 to 18 months for Higher Education precedes the period during which the Company receives and delivers against orders for the products it has developed for the program.
The operating cycles in respect of the Group’s professional and clinical content are more specialized in nature as they relate to educational or heavy reference products released into smaller markets (e.g. the financial training and IT sectors). Nevertheless, in these markets, there is still a regular cycle of product renewal, in line with demand which management monitor. Typically, the life cycle is 5 years for Professional content and 7 years for Clinical content. Elsewhere in the Group, operating cycles are typically less than one year.
Competition
The Group’s businesses operate in highly competitive markets. The Group faces competitive threats both from large media players and from smaller businesses, online and mobile portals and operators in the digital arena that provide alternative sources of content. Alternative distribution channels, e.g. digital format, the internet, online retailers, growing delivery platforms (e.g.,
e-readers
or tablets), pose both threats and opportunities to traditional publishing business models, potentially impacting both sales volumes and pricing.In Assessment & Qualifications, the Group competes with other companies offering test development and administration including Educational Testing Service (ETS), American Institute for Research (AIR), Measured Progress Inc, and others. The Professional Certification business competes with Prometric globally and a number of other smaller players in local markets. The UK qualifications business competes with AQA and OCR in general qualifications as well as a number of smaller players.
In Virtual Learning, the Group competes with companies such as Stride in virtual schools and 2U Inc. in Online Program Management, alongside smaller niche players that specialize in a particular academic discipline or focus on a learning technology.
In English language teaching (ELT) courseware, the Group competes with Oxford University Press, Macmillan and other publishers. In English language testing Pearson Test of English Academic competes with alternative tests including iELTS and TOEFL.
In Workforce Skills, the vocational qualifications business competes with City and Guilds globally alongside smaller niche and local market providers, our assessments businesses compete with HiSET in high school equivalency and SHL in skills and ability testing, and our enterprise data, technology and learning businesses compete with Learning platforms such as Guild, talent management platforms such as Eightfold.ai, and data services such as Emsi.
22
In Higher Education, the Group competes with other publishers and creators of educational materials and services. These companies include publishers such as Cengage Learning, McGraw-Hill Education and Houghton Mifflin Harcourt.
Competition is based on the ability to deliver quality products and services that address the specified curriculum needs and appeal to the student, organizations, school boards, educators, employers and government officials making purchasing decisions.
Intellectual property
The Group’s principal intellectual property assets consist of its:
• | trademarks and other rights via its brands (including corporate and business unit brands, imprints, as well as product and service brands); |
• | copyrights for its textbook and related educational content and software code; and |
• | patents and trade secrets related to the innovative methods deployed in its key technologies. |
The Group believes it has taken reasonable legal steps to protect its key brands in its major markets and copyright in its content and has taken appropriate steps to develop a comprehensive patent program to ensure appropriate protection of emerging inventions that are critical to its new business strategies.
Raw materials
Paper remains the principal raw material used by the Group although its use is declining given the shift to digital products. The Group purchases most of its paper through its global outsourcing partner LSC Communications located in the United States. The Group has not experienced and does not anticipate difficulty in obtaining adequate supplies of paper for its operations, with sourcing available from numerous suppliers. While local prices fluctuate depending upon local market conditions, the Group has not experienced extensive volatility in fulfilling paper requirements. In the event of a sharp increase in paper prices, the Group has a number of alternatives to minimize the impact on its operating margins, including modifying the grades of paper used in production and passing on price increases to customers.
Government regulation
The manufacture of certain products in various markets is subject to governmental regulation relating to the discharge of materials into the environment. Operations are also subject to the risks and uncertainties attendant to doing business in numerous countries. Some of the countries in which the Group conducts these operations maintain controls on the repatriation of earnings and capital and restrict the means available for hedging potential currency fluctuation risks. The operations that are affected by these controls, however, are not material. Accordingly, these controls have not significantly affected the Group’s international operations. Regulatory authorities may have enforcement powers that could have an impact. The Group believes, however, that in light of the nature of its business the risk of these sanctions does not represent a material threat.
Climate change
Our goal is to become a net zero carbon business by 2030 and reducing our scope 1, 2 and 3 carbon emissions by 50% over the same time period, as approved by the Science Based Targets initiative (SBTi), and to minimize the environmental impact of our products as we transition to being a digital business. The Group has made good progress towards our target and as at 31 December 2021, we reduced our combined Scope 1, 2 and 3 emissions by 26% from our 2018 baseline that was adjusted for business disposals. The ongoing work we have undertaken to digitize our business and reduce our physical footprint has been a key driver of the reduction. The impact of
COVID-19
will also have had an impact due to international mobility restrictions and office closures,23
however it has accelerated the changes in how we do business and the shift to digital. There are many factors which will impact the remainder of our journey to net zero, significantly, the rate of change of our suppliers’ own transition has an impact on ours. Over 95% of our emissions fall within Scope 3, with our supply chain and printed books accounting for 24%. There are many actions we can take and are already making progress with our supply chain partners and sourcing initiatives. In the supply chain, alignment with our GHG strategy is a requirement of doing business. Within books we have already achieved significant carbon reductions from the transition from printed to digital product. We will continue with our digital transformation and we are also now focusing on using lower carbon paper and printing on demand to reduce emissions further. Our emissions data was subject to external independent assurance by Corporate Citizenship. The scope of the assurance covers our energy consumption, Scope 1, 2 and 3 GHG emissions and renewable electricity claims.
Our Organisational Risk Management process provides a framework for identification, analysis and response to various forms of risk, the establishment of risk thresholds, and the creation of processes intended to mitigate, monitor and manage risks within these thresholds. Climate change is not a principal risk for the Group for the year ended 31 December 2021, but we have identified the climate transition as an emerging risk due to its intensifying importance to all stakeholders. In 2021, we commissioned the Carbon Trust to undertake a project to identify and quantify the potential impact of climate change risks and opportunities to our business. We considered various climate scenarios, from a well below 2 degree scenario to a 4.3 degree scenario, covering a broad range of outcomes to help provide insight into some of the risks and opportunities that may arise, covering a period out to 2100. Our analysis identified six main categories of risks and opportunities across Pearson. In assessing the risks for Pearson it was determined that there were no significant material risks arising in the near term (up to 2025). Longer term, the key risks to the business were considered to be supply chain risk and outsourcing risk. However, these are not expected to have a material impact on the business in any scenario.
The Board’s Reputation & Responsibility Committee (RRC) is the main governance body for sustainability at Pearson and has responsibility for the oversight of climate change considerations. The RRC works closely with Pearson’s other Board Committees to ensure alignment and rigour of governance across all the potential impacts of climate change from strategic to financial and risk considerations. The Committee members have the necessary experience to provide appropriate oversight for climate change. We recognize that the skills and expertise of the Committee will need to continually evolve given the rapid pace of change in environmental issues. The Audit Committee and the Pearson Executive Management team have reviewed and approved the Group’s environmental Rebaselining Policy, and will continue to be involved in the development, monitoring and execution of our roadmap to achieve net zero by 2030.
Licenses, patents and contracts
The Group is not dependent upon any particular licenses, patents or new manufacturing processes that are material to its business or profitability. Likewise, it is not materially dependent upon any particular contracts with suppliers or customers, including contracts of an industrial, commercial or financial nature. Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Group’s education business is dependent upon licensed rights since most textbooks and digital learning tools include content and/or software that is licensed to it by third parties (or assigned subject to royalty arrangements). In addition, some software products in various business lines, particularly those of its Clinical business, rely upon patents licensed from third parties.
Legal proceedings
The Group and its subsidiaries are from time to time the subject of legal proceedings incidental to the nature of its and their operations. These may include private litigation or arbitrations, governmental proceedings and investigations by regulatory bodies.
On August 16, 2021 Pearson reached a settlement with the SEC concerning Pearson’s public disclosures in July 2019 respecting a data breach that had occurred in 2018 in connection with its AIMSweb 1.0, a
web-based
24
software for entering and tracking students’ academic performance (that was retired in July 2019 in accordance with a previously scheduled retirement plan). The settlement included findings that Pearson violated Sections 17(a)(2) and 17(a)(3) of the Securities Act of 1933, as amended, Section 13(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended, and certain of the rules thereunder respecting accurate and not misleading reporting and the maintenance of disclosure controls and procedures, the entry of an administrativeorder, and the payment of a civil penalty of $1.0 million. Under the settlement, Pearson neither admitted nor denied the findings set forth in the SEC’s order. The issues occurred in 2018 and 2019, since which time a series of improvements have been made in relation to data privacy, cyber security and communications.
cease-and-desist
Organizational structure
Pearson plc is a holding company which conducts its business primarily through subsidiaries and other affiliates throughout the world. Below is a list of its significant subsidiaries as at December 31, 2021, including name, country of incorporation or residence, proportion of ownership interest and, if different, proportion of voting power held.
Name power | Country of incorporation/residence | Percentage interest/voting | ||
Pearson Education Inc. | United States (Delaware) | 100% | ||
Pearson Education Ltd. | England and Wales | 100% | ||
NCS Pearson Inc. | United States (Minnesota) | 100% |
On May 5, 2017, the Group announced that it was undertaking a strategic review of its US K12 courseware business. The US K12 business was classified as held for sale on the Group’s balance sheet as at December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2018. On March 29, 2019 the Group completed the sale of its US K12 courseware business to Nexus Capital Management LP resulting in a
pre-tax
profit on sale of $13m.Until April 2020, the Group owned a 25% interest in Penguin Random House, which was formed on July 1, 2013, upon the completion of an agreement between Pearson and Bertelsmann to merge their respective publishing companies, Penguin and Random House. Pearson originally owned a 47% stake in Penguin Random House but sold 22% to Bertelsmann on October 5, 2017, and sold the remaining 25% interest to Bertelsmann on April 1, 2020.
In November 2020, the Group announced the sale of its interests in Pearson Institute of Higher Education (PIHE) in South Africa. The business was classified as held for sale on the Group’s balance sheet as at December 31, 2020. The sale completed on February 5, 2021 for nominal consideration realising a loss on disposal of £5m in 2021.
In March 2021, the Group announced that it was launching a strategic review of its international courseware local publishing businesses. The strategic review is progressing in line with plan. The related assets have been assessed in light of IFRS 5
‘Non-current
Assets Held for Sale and Discontinued Operations’ and they do not meet the criteria to be classified as held for sale at 31 December 2021.In September 2021, Pearson completed the acquisition of 100% of the share capital of Faethm Holdings Pty Limited (Faethm) for £65m, having already held 9% of the share capital previously. Faethm will form part of the Workforce Skills Division.
The Group made two additional acquisitions of subsidiaries, Opinion Interactive LLC in February 2021 and MZ Development Inc. in July 2021, for total consideration of £11m. In both cases, the Group acquired 100% of the share capital of the respective entities. Both will be part of the Assessment & Qualifications division.
In October 2021, the sale of the Group’s interests in K12 Sistemas in Brazil was completed, realizing a profit of £84m.
25
On 28 January 2022, the Group completed the acquisition of 100% of the share capital of Credly Inc., having previously held a 19.9% interest in the Company. Total consideration is c$200m, comprising upfront cash consideration of c$142m, Pearson’s existing interest valued at c$42m and c$16m of deferred consideration. Net assets acquired will mainly comprise acquired intangible assets. Credly will form part of the Workforce Skills division.
Property, plant and equipment
The Group’s headquarters are located at leasehold premises in London, England. As at December 31, 2021 it owned or leased approximately 744 properties, including approximately 599 testing/teaching centers in over 60 countries worldwide, the majority of which are located in the United Kingdom and the United States.
The properties owned and leased by the Group consist mainly of offices, distribution centers and computer testing / teaching centers.
In some cases properties leased by the Group are then sublet to third parties.
The vast majority of printing is carried out by third party suppliers. The Group operates a small digital print operation as part of its Pearson Assessment & Testing businesses which providesproducts, typically custom client applications.
short-run
andprint-on-demand
The Group owns the following principal properties at December 31, 2021:
General use of property | Location | Area in square feet | ||||
Office | Iowa City, Iowa, USA | 312,760 | ||||
Warehouse/Office | Cedar Rapids, Iowa, USA | 205,000 | ||||
Testing | Owatonna, Minnesota, USA | 128,000 | ||||
Office/Warehouse | Hadley, Massachusetts, USA | 85,570 |
The Group leased the following principal properties at December 31, 2021:
General use of property | Location | Area in square feet | ||||
Warehouse | Cranbury, New Jersey, USA* | 886,748 | ||||
Office | Hudson, New York, USA* | 311,473 | ||||
Office | Westminster, London, UK* | 282,923 | ||||
Office | Hoboken, New Jersey, USA* | 216,273 | ||||
Office | Bloomington, Minnesota, USA* | 147,159 | ||||
Warehouse/Office | Cedar Rapids, Iowa, USA | 119,682 | ||||
Office | San Antonio, Texas, USA* | 117,063 | ||||
Warehouse | Naucalpan de Juarez, Mexico | 113,634 |
* | Properties have either been fully or partially sublet or are being marketed for sublet. |
Capital Expenditures
See “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Liquidity and Capital Resources” for description of the Company’s capital expenditure.
ITEM 4A. | UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS |
The Company has not received, 180 days or more before the end of the 2021 fiscal year, any written comments from the Securities and Exchange Commission staff regarding its periodic reports under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), which remain unresolved.
26
ITEM 5. | OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS |
The following discussion and analysis of the Group’s performance from management’s perspective is based on and should be read in conjunction with the consolidated financial statements, including the related notes, appearing elsewhere in this Annual Report. The purpose of the item 5 is to facilitate a discussion and analysis of the Group’s performance from management’s perspective. The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with international accounting standards in conformity with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. In addition, the consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with international financial reporting standards as issued by the UK
(‘UK-adopted
IFRS’), which was brought into law on 31 December 2020, and adopted by the Group on 1 January 2021. The change constitutes a change in accounting framework, but there was no impact on recognition, measurement or disclosure in the period as a result of the change in framework. The consolidated financial statements have also been prepared in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). At the balance sheet date, in respect of accounting standards applied by the Group, there is no difference betweenUK-adopted
IFRS and IASB issued IFRS.Where this discussion refers to constant currency comparisons, these are estimated by
re-calculating
the current year results using the exchange rates prevailing for the prior period. The increase or reduction in the value calculated is the estimate of the impact of exchange rates. The Group believes this presentation provides a more useful period to period comparison as changes due solely to movements in exchange rates are eliminated. Where this discussion refers to portfolio changes this is calculated by taking account of the contribution from acquisitions and by excluding sales and profits made by businesses disposed in either 2020 or 2021. Where this discussion refers to underlying comparisons this includes both constant currency and portfolio changes.Adjusted operating profit is the key financial measure used by management to evaluate the performance of the Group and allocate resources to business segments over time by separating out those items of income and expenditure relating to acquisitions and disposals, major restructuring programs and certain other items that are not representative of underlying performance. Reconciliations of adjusted operating profit to consolidated operating profit are included below under ’Group performance’, ‘Sales and operating profit by segment’ and in note 2 within Item 18 — Financial Statements.
On 8 March 2021, the Group announced a new strategy, which included a new management structure and operating model. As a result, the operating segments reported to the Group’s chief operating decision-maker, the Pearson Executive Management team, have changed from 1 July 2021 to reflect the new structure. There are now five main global business divisions, which are each considered separate operating segments for management and reporting purposes. These five divisions are Assessment & Qualifications, Virtual Learning, English Language Learning, Workforce Skills and Higher Education. In addition, the International Courseware local publishing businesses are under strategic review and during this time are being managed as a separate division, known as Strategic Review. For the comparative periods, the Group has separately disclosed the results from the Penguin Random
House associate to the point of disposal in April
2020.
All figures for 2020 and 2019 have been restated to reflect 2021 segments.
General overview
Introduction
The Group’s primary segments for management and reporting are as follows:
• | Assessment & Qualifications — Pearson VUE, US School Assessment, Clinical Assessment, UK GCSE and A Levels and International academic qualifications |
• | Virtual Learning — Virtual Schools and Online Program Management. |
• | English Language Learning — Pearson Test of English, Institutional Courseware and English Online Solutions. |
27
• | Workforce Skills — BTEC, GED, TalentLens, Faethm, Pearson College and Apprenticeships |
• | Higher Education — US, Canadian and International Higher Education Courseware businesses. |
In addition, the International Courseware local publishing businesses are under strategic review and during this time are being managed as a separate division, known as Strategic Review. For the comparative period, the Group has separately disclosed the results from the Penguin Random House associate to the point of disposal in April 2020.
See Item 4 for a summary of recent acquisition and disposal activity.
Group Performance
The Group’s total sales increased by £31m or 1% from £3,397m in 2020 to £3,428m in 2021, and the Group’s total adjusted operating profit increased by £72m or 23% from £313m in 2020 to £385m in 2021.
Portfolio changes mainly relate to the sale of Pearson Institute of Higher Education (‘PIHE’) in 2021, the sale of the K12 Sistemas business in Brazil in 2021 and the sale of our remaining interest in Penguin Random House in the first half of 2020. Acquisitions, including Spotlight and Faethm in 2021, had only a small impact on reported sales and profits.
On an underlying basis, sales increased by 8% in 2021 compared to 2020 and adjusted operating profit increased by 33%. Currency movements decreased sales by £206m and decreased adjusted operating profit by £30m. Portfolio changes decreased sales by £27m and decreased adjusted operating profit by £1m. There were no new accounting standards adopted in 2021 that impacted sales or profits.
Adjusted operating profit excludes intangible charges for amortisation and impairment, acquisition related costs, gains and losses arising from acquisitions and disposals and the cost of major restructuring. A summary of these adjustments is included below:
2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Operating Profit | 183 | 411 | 275 | |||||||||
Add back: | ||||||||||||
Cost of major restructuring | 214 | — | 159 | |||||||||
Intangible charges | 51 | 80 | 163 | |||||||||
Other net gains and losses | (63 | ) | (178 | ) | (16 | ) | ||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 385 | 313 | 581 | |||||||||
The operating profit of £183m in 2021 compares to a profit of £411m in 2020. The decrease in 2021 is mainly due to the gain on sale of Penguin Random House recognized in 2020 and restructuring costs in 2021 offset by improved trading profits, reduced intangible charges and gains on the 2021 business disposals.
In March 2021, the Group announced a major restructuring programme to run primarily in 2021. The programme includes the reorganisation of the Group into five global business divisions and the simplification of the Group’s property portfolio. The restructuring costs in 2021 of £214m mainly relate to the impairment of right of use property assets, the write-down of product development assets and staff redundancies. There were no costs of major restructuring in 2020.
Intangible amortisation charges in 2021 were £51m compared to a charge of £80m in 2020. This is due to a reduction in acquisition activity in recent years and additional intangible charges which were recorded in 2020 and are not repeated in 2021.
28
Other net gains and losses in 2021 largely relate to gains from the disposal of PIHE and the K12 Sistemas business in Brazil offset by costs related to the acquisition of Faethm and the wind down of certain strategic review businesses. In 2020, other net gains and losses largely relate to the sale of the remaining interest in Penguin Random House.
The profit before taxation in 2021 of £157m compares to a profit before taxation of £354m in 2020. The decrease in profit before taxation of £197m reflects the decrease in the reported operating profit identified above offset by a decrease in net finance costs of £31m from £57m in 2020 to £26m in 2021.
Net interest payable in 2021 was £57m, compared to £61m in 2020. The decrease is mainly due a reduction in interest payable on lease liabilities following the disposal of PIHE. Also included in net finance costs are net finance costs relating to employee benefit plans, foreign exchange and other gains and losses. In 2021, the total of these items was a gain of £31m compared to a gain of £4m in 2020. Net finance income relating to retirement benefits decreased from £6m in 2020 to £4m in 2021 reflecting the comparative funding position of the plans at the beginning of each year and higher prevailing discount rates. In 2021, finance income of £6m relating to the revaluation of the US
K-12
disposal proceeds was recorded and there were gains on long-term interest rate hedges and foreign exchange gains on unhedged inter-company loans and cash and cash equivalents in 2021 compared to 2020.The reported tax charge in 2021 was a credit of £3m (1.8%) compared to a charge of £44m (12.5%) in 2020. The principal reasons for reduction in the tax charge are the benefit received from the revaluation of deferred tax assets following the increase in the UK tax rate from 19% to 25% together with a benefit from a change in local tax law.
Net cash generated from operations increased to £570m in 2021 from £450m in 2020. The increase is largely explained by the drop-through of increased adjusted operating profits and an improvement in net working capital.
In 2021, there was an overall £176m decrease in cash and cash equivalents compared to an increase of £679m in 2020. The decrease in 2021 is primarily due to repayments of borrowings of £167m, dividends paid of £149m, tax paid of £177m, interest payments of £67m, capital expenditure of £176m, acquisitions of £69m and repayments of lease liabilities of £88m. These were offset by the cash inflow from operations of £570m and proceeds from disposals of businesses and investments of £131m.
The Group’s net debt reduced from £463m at the end of 2020 to £350m at the end of 2021. A breakdown of net debt is provided in note 18 of the financial statements. The decrease is largely due to positive operating cashflow, proceeds from disposals of businesses and investments and the disposal of lease liabilities with PIHE partially offset by consideration paid for acquisitions and tax, interest and dividend payments. Tax payments in 2021 include amounts related to State Aid which the Group expects to recover in due course. In May 2021, the Group repaid the remaining €195m of its €500m Euro 1.85% notes.
Going concern and liquidity
In assessing the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern for the period to 30 June 2023, the Board analysed a variety of downside scenarios including a severe but plausible scenario where the Group is impacted by a combination of all principal risks from 2022 as well as reverse stress testing to identify what would be required to either breach covenants or run out of liquidity. The severe but plausible scenario modelled a severe reduction in revenue, profit and operating cash flow from risks which in aggregate were significantly greater than seen in 2021 continuing throughout 2022 to 2023.
At 31 December 2021, the Group had available liquidity of c£1.6bn, comprising central cash balances and its undrawn $1.19bn Revolving Credit Facility (RCF). In February 2022, the Group renegotiated its revolving
29
credit facility, extending the maturity of $1bn of the facility by one year to February 2026. Even under a severe downside case, the Group would maintain comfortable liquidity headroom and sufficient headroom against covenant requirements during the period under assessment even before modelling the mitigating effect of actions that management would take in the event that these downside risks were to crystallize.
On 24 February 2022, the Board approved a £350m share buyback programme in order to return capital to shareholders. See ”Liquidity and Capital resources.”
Sales information by segment
The following table shows sales information for each of the past three years by segment:
Year ended December 31 | ||||||||||||
2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
Assessment & Qualifications | 1,204 | 1,082 | 1,280 | |||||||||
Virtual Learning | 713 | 692 | 584 | |||||||||
English Language Learning | 238 | 218 | 320 | |||||||||
Workforce Skills | 172 | 163 | 185 | |||||||||
Higher Education | 849 | 956 | 1,102 | |||||||||
Strategic Review | 252 | 286 | 398 | |||||||||
Total continuing operations | 3,428 | 3,397 | 3,869 | |||||||||
Sales information by geographic market supplied
The following table shows sales information for each of the past three years by geographic region:
Year ended December 31 | ||||||||||||
2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | ||||||||||
UK | 355 | 319 | 385 | |||||||||
Europe | 249 | 216 | 244 | |||||||||
North America | 2,293 | 2,426 | 2,522 | |||||||||
Asia Pacific | 359 | 251 | 441 | |||||||||
Other countries | 172 | 185 | 277 | |||||||||
Total continuing operations | 3,428 | 3,397 | 3,869 | |||||||||
In the table above sales are allocated based on the country in which the customer is located.
Exchange rate fluctuations
The Group earns a significant proportion of its sales and profits in overseas currencies, principally the US dollar. Sales and profits are translated into sterling in the consolidated financial statements using average rates. The average rate used for the US dollar was £1:$1.38 in 2021, £1:$1.28 in 2020 and £1:$1.28 in 2019. Fluctuations in exchange rates can have a significant impact on the Group’s reported sales and profits. In 2021, the Group generated 64% of its continuing sales in the US (2020: 69%; 2019: 62%). In 2021, the Group estimates that a five-cent change in the average exchange rate between the US dollar and sterling would have had an impact on its reported earnings per share of approximately 0.9p, using adjusted operating profit the impact would be approximately 1.5p. See “Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk” for more information on how foreign exchange risk is managed. The
year-end
US dollar rate for 2021 was £1:$1.35 compared to £1:$1.37 for 2020 and £1:$1.32 for 2019. The total impact on shareholders’ funds of foreign exchange translation was a loss of £2m in 2021 compared to a loss of £179m in 2020. These net movements are principally driven by movements in the US dollar as a significant portion of the Group’s operations are in the US.30
Critical accounting estimates
The Group’s consolidated financial statements included in “Item 18. Financial statements” are prepared based on the accounting policies described in note 1 to the consolidated financial statements.
Certain of these accounting policies require the application of management judgment in selecting assumptions when making significant estimates about matters that are inherently uncertain. Management bases its estimates on historical experience and other assumptions that it believes are reasonable. These policies are described in note 1a (3) in “Item 18. Financial Statements”.
Results of operations
Year ended December 31, 2021 compared to year ended December 31, 2020
Consolidated results of operations
Sales
The Group’s total sales increased to £3,428m in 2021 from £3,397m in 2020, an increase of £31m or 1%. The year on year increase was impacted by currency movements, primarily the comparative strength of the US dollar relative to sterling during the year. In 2021, currency movements decreased sales by £206m when compared to the equivalent figures at constant 2020 rates. When measured at 2020 constant exchange rates, the Group’s sales increased by 7%. There is also a £27m decrease in sales as a result of portfolio changes. Portfolio changes are calculated by taking account of the additional sales (at constant exchange rates) from acquisitions made in the current year, such as Faethm. Sales made by businesses disposed in either the current year or the prior year are also excluded, such as PIHE and the K12 Sistemas business in Brazil. On an underlying basis, sales increased by 8% in 2021 compared to 2020.
Cost of goods sold and operating expenses
The following table summarizes the Group’s cost of sales, net operating expense and other net gains and losses:
Year ended December 31 | ||||||||
2021 | 2020 | |||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Cost of goods sold | 1,747 | 1,767 | ||||||
Operating expenses: | ||||||||
Distribution costs | 62 | 59 | ||||||
Selling, marketing and product development costs | 521 | 572 | ||||||
Administrative and other expenses | 802 | 816 | ||||||
Restructuring costs | 214 | — | ||||||
Other income | (37 | ) | (45 | ) | ||||
Total net operating expenses | 1,562 | 1,402 | ||||||
Other net gains | (63 | ) | (178 | ) | ||||
Total continuing operations | 3,246 | 2,991 | ||||||
Cost of goods sold
.
pre-publication
costs, royalty charges, the cost of service provision in the assessment and testing business and the cost of teaching and facilities in direct delivery businesses. The Group’s cost of sales decreased by £20m, or 1%, from £1,767m in 2020, to £1,747m in 2021. The decrease largely reflects favorable foreign exchange movements. On a constant exchange rate basis cost of goods sold have increased due to sales31
growth in Virtual Learning and sales recovery in Assessment & Qualifications and English Language Learning, partially offset by sales decline in Higher Education and the absence of costs from businesses disposed. In addition, cost of sales as a percentage of sales decreased largely as a result of improvements in the operating leverage particularly in Assessment & Qualifications. Cost of goods sold was 51.0% of sales in 2021 compared to 52.0% in 2020.
Distribution costs
Distribution costs consist primarily of shipping costs, postage and packing. Distribution costs increased by £3m primarily reflecting sales increases partially offset by the decrease in physical print sales.
Selling, marketing and product development costs
.
Administrative and other expenses
The Group’s administrative and other expenses decreased by £14m or 2% from £816m in 2020 to £802m in 2021. The decrease is primarily explained by the impact of lower intangible charges, benefits from restructuring programs and favorable foreign exchange movements, partially offset by an increase in costs as the business returned to ‘normal’ post
COVID-19.
Restructuring costs
In March 2021, the Group announced a major restructuring programme to run primarily in 2021. The programme includes the reorganisation of the Group into five global business divisions and the simplification of the Group’s property portfolio. The restructuring costs in 2021 of £214m mainly relate to the impairment of right of use property assets, the write-down of product development assets and staff redundancies. There were no costs of major restructuring in 2020.
Other income
Other operating income mainly consists of freight recharges,
sub-rights
and licensing income, distribution commissions, investment income and gains on minor asset disposals together with service fee income from Penguin Random House. Other operating income decreased to £37m in 2021 compared to £45m in 2020.Other net gains and losses
.
Operating profit
The operating profit of £183m in 2021 compares to a profit of £411m in 2020. The decrease in 2021 is mainly due to the gain on sale of Penguin Random House recognized in 2020 and restructuring costs in 2021 offset by improved trading profits, reduced intangible charges and gains on the 2021 business disposals
After stripping out the effect of the portfolio changes, intangible charges, restructuring costs and the impact of currency movements, profits from trading increased by £103m or 33%. This underlying trading increase was primarily due to operating leverage on our revenue growth and cost savings, offset by inflation and investment to drive future growth. At a divisional level, you can see more normalised margins as the businesses recovered post-COVID.
Net finance costs
Net finance costs decreased by £31m from £57m in 2020 to £26m in 2021. The Group’s net interest payable reflected in adjusted earnings decreased from £61m in 2020 to £57m in 2021. The decrease is mainly due a reduction in interest payable on lease liabilities following the disposal of PIHE. In 2021, the total of items
32
excluded from adjusted earnings was income of £31m compared to income of £4m in 2020. Net finance income relating to retirement benefits decreased from £6m in 2020 to £4m in 2021 reflecting the comparative funding position of the plans at the beginning of each year and higher prevailing discount rates. In 2021, finance income of £6m relating to the revaluation of the US
K-12
disposal proceeds was recorded and there were gains on long-term interest rate hedges and foreign exchange gains on unhedged inter-company loans and cash and cash equivalents in 2021 compared to 2020.For a more detailed discussion of the Group’s borrowings and interest expenses see “Liquidity and Capital Resources — Capital Resources” and “— Borrowings” below and “Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk”.
Taxation
The reported tax credit in 2021 was £3m (1.8%) compared to a charge of £44m (12.5%) in 2020. The principal reasons for reduction in the tax charge are the benefit received from the revaluation of deferred tax assets following the increase in the UK tax rate from 19% to 25% together with a benefit from a change in Italian tax law.
The UK Budget in March 2021 announced an increase in the UK corporation tax rate to 25% with effect from 1 April 2023. This was substantively enacted on 24 May 2021. The UK corporation tax rate increase has resulted in an increase of £27m in the UK deferred tax liability associated with the UK Group pension plan asset position, which has been recognized in other comprehensive income, together with a £25m increase in UK deferred tax assets, which has been recognized in the income statement. The UK corporation tax rate change is beneficial to the Group’s statutory tax as it increases the value of certain UK tax attributes of the Group such as tax losses and, as noted above, reduces the overall statutory tax charge.
In February 2021, the Group received charging notices requiring payment of materially all of the alleged State Aid. Payments totalling £105m (comprising tax and interest) were made during 2021. The Group expects to recover the funds in due course.
Discontinued operations
There were no discontinued operations in either 2020 or 2021.
Profit for the year
The profit for the financial year in 2021 was £160m compared to a profit in 2020 of £310m. The decrease in 2021 is mainly due to a reduction in the operating profit as a result of the gain on sale of Penguin Random House recognized in 2020 and restructuring costs in 2021 offset by improved trading profits, reduced intangible charges and gains on the 2021 business disposals. In addition, there were higher finance costs and tax charges in 2020.
Earnings per ordinary share
The basic earnings per ordinary share, which is defined as the profit for the financial year divided by the weighted average number of shares in issue, was 21.1p in 2021 compared to 41.0p in 2020. The decrease in 2021 is mainly due to a reduction in the operating profit as a result of the gain on sale of Penguin Random House recognized in 2020 and restructuring costs in 2021 offset by improved trading profits, reduced intangible charges and gains on the 2021 business disposals. In addition there were higher finance costs and tax charges in 2020.
The diluted earnings per ordinary share was 20.9p in 2021 and 41.0p in 2020, with the dilutive effect of options being minimal.
33
Sales and operating profit by segment
The following tables summarize the Group’s sales and adjusted operating profit for each of the Group’s business segments. Adjusted operating profit is included as it is the key financial measure used by management to evaluate the performance of the Group and allocate resources to business segments over time by separating out those items of income and expenditure relating to acquisitions and disposals, major restructuring programs and certain other items that are not representative of underlying performance. Reconciliations of adjusted operating profit to consolidated operating profit are included below and in note 2 within Item 18 — Financial Statements.
The Group’s adjusted operating profit, excludes other net gains and losses, amortization and impairment of acquired intangibles and the cost of major restructuring programs. The intangible charges relate only to intangible assets acquired through business combinations and intangibles relating to associates. These intangible charges are excluded as they reflect past acquisition activity and do not necessarily reflect the current year performance of the Group. Other net gains and losses represent profits and losses on the sale of subsidiaries, joint ventures, associates and other financial assets. Other net gains and losses also includes costs related to business closures and acquisitions. Other net gains and losses are excluded from adjusted operating profit as it is important to highlight their impact on operating profit in the period in which the transactions take place. The costs related to major restructuring programmes are excluded from adjusted operating profit as they do not necessarily reflect the current year performance of the Group.
A reconciliation of operating profit to adjusted operating profit for continuing operations is included in the tables below:
all figures in £ millions | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Businesses under Strategic Review | Penguin Randon House | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 1,204 | 713 | 238 | 172 | 849 | 252 | — | 3,428 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
35 | % | 21 | % | 7 | % | 5 | % | 25 | % | 7 | % | — | 100 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit /(loss) | 155 | (41 | ) | (15 | ) | (10 | ) | 8 | 86 | — | 183 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of majorrestructuring | 48 | 48 | 27 | 28 | 63 | — | — | 214 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | 13 | 25 | 3 | 7 | 2 | 1 | — | 51 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | 2 | — | (65 | ) | — | (63 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 216 | 32 | 15 | 27 | 73 | 22 | — | 385 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2020 1 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 1,082 | 692 | 218 | 163 | 956 | 286 | — | 3,397 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
33 | % | 20 | % | 6 | % | 5 | % | 28 | % | 8 | % | — | 100 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit / (loss) | 118 | (1 | ) | (6 | ) | 18 | 90 | 11 | 181 | 411 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of major restructuring | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | 29 | 30 | 7 | 8 | 3 | 3 | — | 80 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | — | — | 2 | (180 | ) | (178 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 147 | 29 | 1 | 26 | 93 | 16 | 1 | 313 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
1. | Comparative amounts have been represented to reflect the new operating segments. |
Assessment & Qualifications
Assessment & Qualifications sales increased from £1,082m in 2020 to £1,204m in 2021, an increase of £122m or 11%. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates and the contribution from portfolio changes, Assessment & Qualifications sales increased by 18% in 2021 compared to 2020. Professional
34
Certification (VUE) revenue was up 19%, with OnVUE continuing to benefit from growth in the IT sector. US Student Assessment revenue was up 17% and Clinical Assessment revenue was up 30% with strong product launches in the year. Pearson VUE and Clinical Assessment revenues have now grown in comparison to 2019, showing more than
post-COVID-19
recovery.Adjusted operating profit increased 59% in underlying and 47% in headline terms due to the operating leverage on revenue growth partly offset by currency movements.
Pearson VUE revenue grew 19% in underlying terms with test volumes increasing 30% to 16.8m due to
COVID-19
recovery, new client launches and growth in existing programmes. We renewed 99% of our expiring contract base and fully resumed exam deliveries in our testing centres. Volumes in OnVUE, Pearson’s online proctoring service, grew 46% to 3m reflecting continuing demand for remote testing and as a complementary expansion to our test centre-based delivery options.In US Student Assessment, revenue increased 17% in underlying terms due to new contract wins and a return to state testing in 2021, following 2020cancellations.
COVID-19-related
In Clinical Assessment, revenue increased 30% in underlying terms due to new product releases and a backlog of demand for mental health services as
in-person
assessments resumed and schools reopened. Revenue growth continued for our digitally delivered assessments as they have become more widely accepted.The Assessment & Qualifications results also include intangible charges of £13m in 2021 compared to £29m in 2020 reflecting impairments made in 2020. Major restructuring costs were £48m in 2021 and £nil in 2020.
Virtual Learning
Virtual Learning sales increased from £692m in 2020 to £713m in 2021, an increase of £21m or 3%. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, Virtual Learning’s sales increased by 11% in 2021 compared to 2020. Revenue growth reflects strong enrolment growth in Virtual Schools in the 2020/2021 academic year, with good underlying enrolment growth in OPM.
Adjusted operating profit grew 28% in underlying terms, due to operating leverage and efficiency improvements in OPM more than offsetting the investment in our Virtual Schools’ platform and customer care support, as well as margin impact in OPM due to discontinued programs. Headline profit grew 10% with good growth in adjusted operating profit partially offset by currency movements.
Virtual Schools performed strongly driven by 43% enrolment growth in new and existing schools for the 2020/2021 academic year. We opened five new full-time, online partner schools in Florida, Rhode Island, Colorado, South Carolina, and Oregon. We also announced our first Connections Academy in the state of Virginia, which begins enrolment in March 2022, one school in New Mexico moved from a partner school to district programme. This brings the 2021/2022 total number of partner schools to 47 in 30 states. Enrolments in the 2021/2022 academic year grew by 2% despite a significant unwinding of the “covid cohort”.
In OPM, we saw good underlying enrolment growth of 7% as Maryville University extended its OPM partnership for online degrees in the high-demand field of Nursing through to 2033 and Northeastern University added a new online master’s degree and certificate programs in Nursing and Healthcare. We ended the year with a total of 477 programs across 31 partners with the addition of 43 new programs in North America across 21 partners, and 7 new programs internationally where underlying enrolments grew by more than 80%.
The Virtual Learning results also include intangible charges of £25m in 2021 compared to £30m in 2020 reflecting the impact of historical acquisition activity. Major restructuring costs were £48m in 2021 and £nil in 2020.
35
English Language Learning
English Language Learning sales increased from £218m in 2020 to £238m in 2021, an increase of £20m or 9%. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, English Language Learning’s sales increased by 17% in 2021 compared to 2020. Revenue growth is due to
COVID-19
recovery in both International courseware and Pearson Test of English (PTE) where volumes grew 25% compared to 2020.Adjusted operating profit increased in underlying and headline terms due to increased revenue.
The English Language Learning results also include intangible charges of £3m in 2021 compared to £7m in 2020 reflecting the impact of historical acquisition activity. Major restructuring costs were £27m in 2021 and £nil in 2020.
Workforce Skills
Workforce Skills sales increased from £163m in 2020 to £172m in 2021, an increase of £9m or 6%. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates and the contribution from portfolio changes, Workforce Skills sales increased by 6% in 2021 compared to 2020. This was predominantly driven by strong growth in GED and TalentLens due to a recovery from
COVID-19
and further expansion of their enterprise sales. GED test volumes increased by 43%, enabled by the provision of online proctored testing, launched in June 2020, which grew by 200%. BTEC and Apprenticeship sales grew by 4%, with strong international growth partially offset by lower growth in the UK, as registrations declined as a result ofCOVID-19
disruption and rebates for exam cancellations continued in 2021.Adjusted operating profit grew 8% in underlying terms, with strong flow through of sales growth operating leverage. Headline profits grew 4% with good underlying growth offset by portfolio changes.
The Workforce Skills results also include intangible charges of £7m in 2021 compared to £8m in 2020. Major restructuring costs were £28m in 2021 and £nil in 2020. Other net gains and losses in 2021 relate to the acquisition of Faethm.
Higher Education
Higher Education sales decreased from £956m in 2020 to £849m in 2021, a decrease of £107m or 11%. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, Higher Education sales decreased by 5% in 2021 compared to 2020. Growth in Canadian and UK Higher Education Courseware were more than offset by a 6% decline in US Higher Education Courseware driven by a decline in enrolments and courses per enrolment combined, as well as price pressure due to the mix shift from print and bundles to
e-text
and platform, and lower monetisation.Adjusted operating profit declined 15% in underlying and 22% in headline terms. This is driven by the combined effects of the revenue declines and continued investments in our content and platforms (inclusive of Pearson+).
We saw continued momentum in Inclusive Access where sales toinstitutions grew 18% representing 16% of total US Higher Education Courseware revenue versus 13% last year.
not-for-profit
The Higher Education results also include intangible charges of £2m in 2021 compared to £3m in 2020. Major restructuring costs were £63m in 2021 and £nil in 2020.
Strategic Review
Strategic Review sales decreased from £286m in 2020 to £252m in 2021, a decrease of £34m or 12%. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates and the contribution from portfolio changes, Strategic Review sales increased by 1% in 2021 compared to 2020.
36
The Strategic Review results also include intangible charges of £1m in 2021 compared to £3m in 2020. Other net gains and losses in 2021 primarily relate to the disposals of PIHE and the
K-12
Sistemas business in Brazil.Penguin Random House
In April 2020, the Group completed the sale of the remaining 25% interest in Penguin Random House to Bertelsmann, generating net proceeds of £531m and resulting in a
pre-tax
profit of £180m. Dividend income of £1m was recognized in 2020pre-disposal.
Results of operations
Year ended December 31, 2020 compared to year ended December 31, 2019
For commentary on the results of our operations for the year ended December 31, 2020 compared to the year ended December 31, 2019, please refer to our Form
20-F
for the year ended December 31, 2020, which was filed on April 1, 2021. However, as our operating segments have changed during the year ended December 31, 2021, the revised commentary for sales and operating profit by segment has been updated below –Sales and operating profit by segment
The following tables summarize the Group’s sales and adjusted operating profit for each of the Group’s business segments. Adjusted operating profit is included as it is the key financial measure used by management to evaluate the performance of the Group and allocate resources to business segments over time by separating out those items of income and expenditure relating to acquisitions and disposals, major restructuring programs and certain other items that are not representative of underlying performance. Reconciliations of adjusted operating profit to consolidated operating profit are included below and in note 2 within Item 18 — Financial Statements.
A reconciliation of operating profit to adjusted operating profit for continuing operations is included in the tables below:
all figures in £ millions | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Businesses under Strategic Review | Penguin Randon House | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2020 1 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 1,082 | 692 | 218 | 163 | 956 | 286 | — | 3,397 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
33 | % | 20 | % | 6 | % | 5 | % | 28 | % | 8 | % | — | 100 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit / (loss) | 118 | (1 | ) | (6 | ) | 18 | 90 | 11 | 181 | 411 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of major restructuring | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | 29 | 30 | 7 | 8 | 3 | 3 | — | 80 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | — | — | 2 | (180 | ) | (178 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 147 | 29 | 1 | 26 | 93 | 16 | 1 | 313 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
37
all figures in £ millions | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Businesses under Strategic Review | Penguin Randon House | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
2019 1 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 1,280 | 584 | 320 | 185 | 1,102 | 398 | — | 3,869 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
33 | % | 15 | % | 8 | % | 5 | % | 29 | % | 10 | % | — | 100 | % | ||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit / (loss) | 191 | (36 | ) | (31 | ) | 15 | 66 | 19 | 51 | 275 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of major restructuring | 38 | 13 | 10 | 7 | 68 | 21 | 2 | 159 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | 23 | 36 | 80 | 9 | — | 3 | 12 | 163 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | — | — | (16 | ) | — | (16 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 252 | 13 | 59 | 31 | 134 | 27 | 65 | 581 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
1. | Comparative amounts have been represented to reflect the new operating segments. |
Assessment & Qualifications
Assessment & Qualifications sales decreased by £198m or 15% from £1,280m in 2019 to £1,082m in 2020 and adjusted operating profit decreased by £105m or 42% from £252m in 2019 to £147m in 2020. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, Assessment & Qualifications sales decreased by 16% in 2020 compared to 2019 and adjusted operating profit also decreased by 44%.
Sales declined 10% at Pearson VUE reflecting the impact of the test center closures in the first half of the year offset by pent up demand in the second half partially moderated by further lockdowns in Q4. Online Proctoring saw strong growth in the year with volumes up from 0.2m at the end of 2019 to 2.1m at the end of 2020 predominantly driven by demand from the IT sector. Overall testing volumes were down 22% to 12.9m due to test center closures. In School and Clinical Assessment, cancelation of Spring testing and school closures impacted both businesses respectively in H1 with a further modest impact due to
COVID-19
in H2.In the UK, qualifications revenue was impacted by the cancelation of exams in 2020, as well as the end of the NCT contract.
Adjusted operating profit declined 42% due to the
COVID-19
impact on trading, partially offset by mitigating actions.The Assessment & Qualifications results also include intangible charges of £29m in 2020 compared to £23m in 2019 reflecting impairments made in 2020. Major restructuring costs were £38m in 2019 and £nil in 2020.
Virtual Learning
Virtual Learning sales increased by £108m or 18% from £584m in 2019 to £692m in 2020 and adjusted operating profit increased by £16m or 123% from £13m in 2019 to £29m in 2020. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, Virtual Learning sales increased by 18% in 2020 compared to 2019 and adjusted operating profit also increased by 108%.
The sales growth reflects strong enrolment growth in Virtual Schools and good growth in OPM. Adjusted operating profit growth was due to margin on sales growth more than offsetting the investment in our virtual schools platform and customer care support and margin impact in OPM due to discontinued programs.
38
Virtual Schools performed strongly driven by 43% enrolment growth in new and existing schools for the 2020/2021 academic year. We opened three new full-time, state-wide partner schools, and combined with two contract exits this took the total partner schools to 43 in 29 states.
In OPM, we saw good sales growth with a strong performance in undergraduate and international, partially offset by discontinued programs. We also saw the benefits of the operational changes, with increased efficiencies in our student recruitment process and student acquisition costs. Underlying course enrolments (excluding discontinued programs) grew 20% and total course enrolments declined 7%. We delivered 470 programs across 34 partners globally.
The Virtual Learning results also include intangible charges of £30m in 2020 compared to £36m in 2019 reflecting the impact of historical acquisition activity in recent years. Major restructuring costs were £13m in 2019 and £nil in 2020.
English Language Learning
English Language Learning sales decreased by £102m or 32% from £320m in 2019 to £218m in 2020 and adjusted operating profit decreased by £58m or 98% from £59m in 2019 to £1m in 2020. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, English Language Learning sales decreased by 28% in 2020 compared to 2019 and adjusted operating profit also decreased by 100%.
The sales decline reflects the interruption of Australian immigration and test center closures impacting PTE. PTE volumes were down 36% with declines in all key markets except China where we saw 17% growth due to an improved competitive performance. Courseware sales also declined due to the
COVID-19
pandemic.Divisional profitability has been impacted by the PTE and courseware sales decline, market contraction as a result of the pandemic in our high margin franchise business in Brazil, and by investment in our English Assessment products.
The English Language Learning results also include intangible charges of £7m in 2020 compared to £80m in 2019 due to impairments recorded in 2019. Major restructuring costs were £10m in 2019 and £nil in 2020.
Workforce Skills
Workforce Skills sales decreased by £22m or 12% from £185m in 2019 to £163m in 2020 and adjusted operating profit decreased by £5m or 16% from £31m in 2019 to £26m in 2020. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates and the contribution from portfolio changes, Workforce Skills sales decreased by 14% in 2020 compared to 2019 and adjusted operating profit also decreased by 13%.
Sales decreased due to the impact of the
COVID-19
pandemic, in particular, the impact on BTEC and apprenticeships in the UK.The Workforce Skills results also include intangible charges of £8m in 2020 compared to £9m in 2019. Major restructuring costs were £7m in 2019 and £nil in 2020.
Higher Education
Higher Education sales decreased by £146m or 13% from £1,102m in 2019 to £956m in 2020 and adjusted operating profit decreased by £41m or 31% from £134m in 2019 to £93m in 2020. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates, Higher Education sales decreased by 13% in 2020 compared to 2019 and adjusted operating profit also decreased by 25%.
39
In US Higher Education Courseware sales declined 12% with total unit sales increasing slightly and digital registrations including eBooks growing 9%. In Canada and international Higher Education, courseware sales were down significantly due to bookstore closures during the pandemic.
Adjusted operating profit declined 31% due to the impact of trading partially offset by restructuring and discretionary savings.
The Group continued to see unbundling of premium priced print and digital products for digital only formats. In 2020 2.2m textbooks were sold into US Higher Education colleges, compared with 3.7m in 2019. Sales of standalone eBook units into colleges grew 33% to 3.7m units, showing signs of secondary market recapture. There has also been continued momentum in Inclusive Access with sales toinstitutions up 29% on last year representing 13% of US Higher Education Courseware revenue.
not-for-profit
The Higher Education results also include intangible charges of £3m in 2020 compared to £nil in 2019. Major restructuring costs were £68m in 2019 and £nil in 2020.
Strategic Review
Strategic Review sales decreased by £112m or 28% from £398m in 2019 to £286m in 2020 and adjusted operating profit decreased by £11m or 41% from £27m in 2019 to £16m in 2020. The Group estimates that after excluding the impact of exchange rates and the contribution from portfolio changes, Strategic Review sales decreased by 10% in 2020 compared to 2019 and adjusted operating profit also decreased by 51%.
The sales decline reflects budgetary pressures caused by the impact of
COVID-19
on courseware purchasing, with budget constraints and school closures leading to fewer purchases. The sales decline also reflects the disposal of the US K12 business in 2019.The Strategic Review results also include other net gains and losses of £2m loss in 2020 compared to a £16m gain in 2019. In 2019 these primarily relate to the gain on sale of the US K12 business and in 2020 they primarily relate to charge in relation to the disposal of PIHE.
The Strategic Review results also include intangible charges of £3m in 2020 compared to £3m in 2019. Major restructuring costs were £21m in 2019 and £nil in 2020.
Penguin Random House
The Group’s share of Penguin Random House adjusted operating profits was £nil in 2020 compared to £65m in 2019. Dividend income of £1m was recognized in 2020. In December 2019, the Group announced the sale of its remaining 25% interest in Penguin Random House. At the end of December 2019 the Group’s share of the assets of Penguin Random House was classified as held for sale on the balance sheet. In April 2020, the Group completed the sale of the remaining 25% interest in Penguin Random House to Bertelsmann, generating net proceeds of £531m and resulting in a
pre-tax
profit of £180m.Liquidity and capital resources
Cash flows and financing
Net cash generated from operations increased to £570m in 2021 from £450m in 2020. The decrease in cash generated from operations is largely explained by the drop-through of increased operating profits and an improvement in net working capital (including product development) offset by an increase in capital expenditure.
Net interest paid at £54m in 2021 compares to £50m in 2020 and primarily reflects a reduction in interest on lease liabilities following the disposal of PIHE. Tax paid in 2021 was £177m compared to tax received of £2m in 2020 with the increase mainly explained by the £97m payment related to State Aid which the Group expects to recover in due course and refunds received in 2020 in the US and UK relating to historical periods.
40
Capital expenditure on property, plant and equipment was £64m in 2021 compared to £53m in 2020. There were no material property sales in 2021 or 2020. Capital expenditure on software intangibles increased to £112m in 2021 from £81m in 2020. The increase in expenditure on software intangibles reflects the fact that we paused elements of technology programmes at the height of the pandemic in 2020.
Cash outflow from acquisitions in 2021 was £69m compared to £12m in 2020. The cash outflow in 2021 relating to acquisitions of subsidiaries is £55m, comprising £46m related to the acquisition of Faethm, £5m of cash consideration paid in relation to two smaller acquisitions, and £4m in relation to prior year acquisitions. In addition, there is a cash outflow of £10m relating to the acquisition of interests in two associates, Smashcut and Academy of Pop and an outflow of £4m relating to the acquisition of investments. There were no significant acquisitions in 2020, the net cash outflow on acquisition of subsidiaries in 2020 relates to deferred payments for prior year acquisitions and investment purchases.
The net cash inflow in respect of businesses and investments disposed was £131m in 2021 compared to £631m in 2020. In 2021, the cash inflow of £83m relating to the disposal of subsidiaries mainly relates to the disposal of the K12 Sistemas business and deferred proceeds from the US
K-12
Courseware sale in 2019 offset by cash disposed with PIHE and other disposal costs. In 2021 there is also a cash inflow of £48m relating to the disposal of certain investments held at fair value through other comprehensive income. In 2020 the cash received largely related to the disposal of Penguin Random House and the partial repayment of the receivable held in relation to the disposal of the USK-12
business.Dividends from joint ventures and associates decreased from £4m in 2020 to £nil in 2021. The reduction is primarily due to the fact that the Penguin Random House disposal completed in April 2020.
The cash outflow from financing of £414m in 2021 compares to £299m in 2020 and includes the repayment of borrowings of £167m in 2021 and £230m in 2020. These repayments include the repayment of the remaining €195m of its €500m Euro 1.85% notes in 2021 and the repayment of the draw down of the revolving credit facility in 2020.
In June 2020, the Group completed the issuance of £350m guaranteed notes maturing 4 June 2030. The notes bear a coupon of 3.75% and were issued in accordance with the ICMA Social Bond Principles 2018, with the proceeds primarily used to finance and
re-finance
delivery of education in our Connections Academy, BTEC and GED businesses to help achieve the United Nations’ 4th Sustainable Development Goal (SDG) for a Quality Education.Also included in financing cash flows are repayments of lease liabilities which decreased from £92m in 2020 to £88m in 2021. Dividends paid to company shareholders in 2021 of £149m compares to £146m in 2020. Cash returned to shareholders via the share buyback program in 2020 amounted to £176m in 2020. Treasury share purchases in 2021 in respect of employee share plans were £16m compared to £6m in 2020.
Overall the Group’s net borrowings decreased from £463m at the end of 2020 to £350m at the end of 2021. The Group’s cash and cash equivalents decreased from £1,113m at the end of 2020 to £937m at the end of 2021.
Capital resources
The Group’s borrowings fluctuate by season because of the academic year’s effect on the working capital requirements in the educational materials businesses. Assuming no acquisitions or disposals, the Group’s maximum level of net debt normally occurs in July, and its minimum level of net debt normally occurs in December.
In assessing the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern for the period to 30 June 2023, the board analysed a variety of downside scenarios including a severe but plausible scenario where the Group is impacted
41
by all principal risks from 2022 as well as reverse stress testing to identify what would be required to either breach covenants or run out of liquidity. The severe but plausible scenario modelled a severe reduction in revenue, profit and operating cash flow from risks which in aggregate were significantly greater than seen in 2021 continuing throughout 2022 to 2023.
At 31 December 2021, the Group had available liquidity of c£1.6bn, comprising central cash balances and its undrawn $1.19bn Revolving Credit Facility (RCF). In February 2022, the Group renegotiated its revolving credit facility, extending the maturity of $1bn of the facility by one year to February 2026. Even under a severe downside case, the Group would maintain comfortable liquidity headroom and sufficient headroom against covenant requirements during the period under assessment even before modelling the mitigating effect of actions that management would take in the event that these downside risks were to crystallize.
At December 31, 2021, the Group’s net debt was £350m compared to £463m at December 31, 2020. The decrease is largely due to positive operating cash flow and proceeds from disposals of businesses partially offset by tax, interest and dividend payments. Tax payments in 2021 include amounts related to State Aid which the Group expects to recover in due course.
Net debt is defined as all short-term, medium-term and long-term borrowing (including leases and related derivatives), less all cash, cash equivalents, other liquid resources and the net investment in finance lease receivables, and a breakdown is provided in note 18 of the financial statements. Cash equivalents comprise short-term deposits with a maturity of up to 90 days, while liquid resources comprise short-term deposits with maturities of more than 90 days and other marketable instruments which are readily realizable and held on a short-term basis. Total short-term, medium- term and long-term borrowing excluding derivatives amounted to £1,400m at December 31, 2021, compared to £1,720m at December 31, 2020 reflecting the repayment of the bond in 2021 and the disposal of lease liabilities with PIHE. At December 31, 2021, total cash and liquid resources were £937m, compared to £1,116m at December 31, 2020. The decrease in 2021 is primarily due to repayments of borrowings of £167m, dividends paid of £149m, tax paid of £177m, interest payments of £67m, capital expenditure of £176m, acquisitions of £69m and repayments of lease liabilities of £88m. These were offset by the cash inflow from operations of £570m and proceeds from disposals of businesses and investments of £131m.
At 31 December 2021, the Group was rated
BBB-
(stable outlook) with Fitch and Baa3 (stable outlook) with Moody’s.Contractual obligations
The following table summarizes the maturity of the Group’s borrowings, its obligations under
non-cancellable
leases, deferred consideration and pension funding obligations, exclusive of anticipated interest payments. Due to the variability of future interest payments, these have been excluded from the table below:Year ended December 31, 2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||
Total | Less than one year | One to Two years | Two to five years | After five years | ||||||||||||||||
£m | £m | £m | £m | £m | ||||||||||||||||
Gross Borrowings: | ||||||||||||||||||||
Bank loans and overdrafts | — | — | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Revolving credit facility | — | — | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Bonds | 767 | 87 | 70 | 257 | 353 | |||||||||||||||
Lease liabilities | 633 | 68 | 71 | 178 | 316 | |||||||||||||||
Deferred consideration | 44 | 6 | 15 | 13 | 10 | |||||||||||||||
UK pension funding obligation | — | — | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Total | 1,444 | 161 | 156 | 448 | 679 | |||||||||||||||
42
The UK pension plan’s most recent triennial actuarial valuation for funding purposes was completed as at January 1, 2021 and this valuation revealed a technical provision funding surplus of £160m. The plan expects to be able to provide benefits (in accordance with the plan rules) with a very low level of reliance on future funding from the Group.
At December 31, 2021 the Group had no capital commitments for fixed assets. Other than as outlined above, there are no other reasonably likely material cash requirements, other than those business as usual costs incurred in the ordinary course of business. At December 31, 2021, these business as usual costs include payroll costs and other executory contracts, that have not be recorded as a liability at the balance sheet date, but instead will be recorded as incurred. There are contingent liabilities in respect of indemnities, warranties, legal and royalty claims and guarantees in relation to former subsidiaries and in respect of guarantees in relation to subsidiaries and associates. In addition, there are contingent liabilities in respect of tax assessments as outlined in note 34 in “Item 18. Financial statements”. None of these claims, guarantees or assessments is currently expected to result in a material gain or loss.
Off-balance
sheet arrangementsThe Group does not have any
off-balance
sheet arrangements, as defined by the SEC for the purposes of the Form20-F,
that have or are reasonably likely to have a material current or future effect on the Group’s financial position or results of operations.Borrowings
The Group finances its operations by a mixture of cash flows from operations, short-term borrowings from banks and commercial paper markets, and longer-term loans from banks and capital markets.
At December 31, 2021, the Group had an undrawn $1.19bn committed revolving credit facility with a maturity date in February 2025. The facility set in place in March 2019, contains two key covenants measured for each
12-month
period ending June 30 and December 31:The Group must maintain the ratio of its profit before interest, tax and amortization to its net interest payable at no less than 3:1; and must maintain the ratio of its net debt to its EBITDA at no more than 4:1. “EBITDA” refers to earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortization. The Group is currently in compliance with these covenants.
See note 18 of “Item 18. Financial Statements” for information on the Group’s longer-term loans from banks and capital markets.
Treasury policy
The Group’s treasury policy is described in note 19 of “Item 18. Financial Statements”. For a more detailed discussion of the Group’s borrowing and use of derivatives, see “Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk”.
Related parties
There were no significant or unusual related party transactions in 2021, 2020 or 2019. Refer to note 36 in “Item 18. Financial Statements”.
Accounting policies
For a description of the Group’s principal accounting policies used refer to note 1 in “Item 18. Financial Statements”.
43
ITEM 6. DIRECTORS, | SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES |
Directors and senior management
The Group is managed by a Board of Directors and a Chief Executive who reports to the Board and manages through an Executive Committee. The Group refers to the Board of Directors, the Chair of the Board of Directors and the Executive Committee as its “senior management”.
The following table sets forth information concerning Directors, as of February 28, 2022.
Name | Age | Position | ||||
Sidney Taurel | 73 | Chair | ||||
Andy Bird, CBE | 58 | Chief Executive | ||||
Sally Johnson | 48 | Chief Financial Officer | ||||
Sherry Coutu, CBE | 58 | Non-executive Director | ||||
Esther Lee | 63 | Non-executive Director | ||||
Linda Lorimer | 69 | Non-executive Director | ||||
Graeme Pitkethly | 55 | Non-executive Director | ||||
Tim Score | 61 | Senior Independent Director and Deputy Chair Designate | ||||
Lincoln Wallen | 61 | Non-executive Director |
On March 1, 2022 Omid Kordestani was appointed as
Non-executive
Director and Chair Designate. Mr Kordestani will succeed Sidney Taurel asNon-Executive
Chair upon conclusion of the company’s AGM in April 2022. Mr Score will also take on the role of Deputy Chair upon conclusion of the AGM.Sidney Taurel
Appointed January 1, 2016. Chair of the Nomination & Governance Committee and Member of the Remuneration Committee.
Sidney has 50 years of experience in business and finance and is currently a
non-executive
director of H.I.G. Acquisition Corp. He was Chief Executive Officer of global pharmaceutical firm Eli Lilly and Company from 1998 until 2008, Chairman from 1999 until 2008, and has been Chairman Emeritus since 2009. His37-year
career at Eli Lilly included time spent in Brazil, France, Eastern Europe, the US and the UK. Sidney is a former director of IBM (2001-2021), McGraw-Hill (1996-2016) serving in both as chair of the Compensation Committee for several years, and of ITT Corp (1996-2001) where he chaired the Audit Committee. In 2002, Sidney received three US presidential appointments to: the Homeland Security Advisory Council, the President’s Export Council and the Advisory Committee for Trade Policy and Negotiations, and is an officer of the French Legion of Honour. Current notable commitments: H.I.G. Acquisition Corporation.Andy Bird, CBE
Appointed to the Board May 1, 2020. Appointed as Chief Executive on October 19, 2020. Member of the Reputation & Responsibility Committee.
Andy has a long and distinguished career spanning over 35 years in the media industry, and is an accomplished, strategic leader of global consumer content businesses. Most recently, he spent 14 years working for The Walt Disney Company, joining the business as President of Walt Disney International in 2004, before being appointed Chair in 2008. He held this role for a decade, during which time he transformed the organisation into a digital-first, direct to consumer business, focused on serving the diverse needs of customers around the world. In addition, Andy worked to establish the iconic brand in China through the creation of Disney English, teaching English language to local families through immersive learning experiences. Prior to Disney, Andy worked in a number of senior positions at AOL Time Warner, and spent the earlier part of his career at Piccadilly Radio, Virgin Broadcasting Company, BSB Music Channel, Big & Good Productions and Unique Broadcasting.
44
Sally Johnson
Appointed on April 24, 2020.
Sally joined Pearson in 2000 and has held various finance and operations roles across the business, both at a corporate level and within the divisions, including The Penguin Group. She brings to the Board extensive commercial and strategic finance experience as well as transformation, treasury, tax, risk management, business and financial operations, investor relations and M&A expertise. She has held various senior level roles across the business, most recently as Deputy CFO of Pearson. Sally is a member of the Institute of Chartered Accountants in England and Wales and trained at PricewaterhouseCoopers. She was also a Trustee for the Pearson Pension Plan from 2012 to 2018.
Sherry Coutu, CBE
Appointed on May 1, 2019. Chair of the Remuneration Committee and Member of the Nomination & Governance Committee.
Sherry has extensive experience in the technology industry. She has also served on the boards of a range of companies and charities, with a focus on working with entrepreneurs and specialising in consumer digital, information services, and education. Sherry is the Chair of Founders4Schools and founder of the
Scale-Up
Institute. Previously, she was CEO of Interactive Investor International plc, and has served on the boards of Cambridge Assessment, Bloomberg New Energy Finance and the London Stock Exchange plc as well as being SID and Remuneration Committee Chair of RM plc. Sherry has started and/or invested in over 60 technology businesses and served on the boards of Zoopla plc, Raspberry Pi, NESTA, and the Advisory boards of the National Gallery, Royal Society and LinkedIn. She was appointed Commander of the British Empire in the 2013 New Year Honours for her services to entrepreneurship.Omid Kordestani
Appointed to the Board March 1, 2022.
Omid Kordestani is an international businessman who serves on the boards of Twitter, Inc., Klarna Bank AB and Klarna Holding AB and is a Council Member for Balderton Capital. He was Executive Chairman of Twitter, Inc between October 2015 and May 2020. From August 2014 to August 2015, Mr Kordestani served as Senior Vice President and Chief Business Officer at Google and previously from May 1999 to April 2009 as Senior Vice President of Global Sales and Business Development. From 1995 to 1999, Mr Kordestani served as Vice President of Business Development at Netscape Communications Corporation. Prior to joining Netscape Communications Corporation, Mr Kordestani held positions in business development, product management and marketing at The 3DO Company, Go Corporation and Hewlett-Packard Company. Current notable commitments: Twitter, Inc.
Esther Lee
Appointed on February 1, 2022.
Esther brings significant experience to the Pearson Board through her prior executive leadership roles in developing customer strategies to drive growth, global marketing and branding, driving digital transformation and building high-performance teams. She has a long track record of senior leadership roles working for global consumer-facing brands. Most recently she served as Executive Vice President—Global Chief Marketing Officer at MetLife Inc. Previously, Esther served as Senior Vice President—Brand Marketing, Advertising and Sponsorships for AT&T, and she has served as CEO of North America and President of Global Brands for Euro RSCG Worldwide. Prior to that, she served for five years as Global Chief Creative Officer for The Coca-Cola
45
Company. Esther is a Board member at The Clorox Company (NYSE: CLX) where she chairs the Nomination & Governance Committee. She has a BA in economics from Cornell University. Current notable commitments: The Clorox Company.
Linda Lorimer
Appointed July 1, 2013. Chair of the Reputation & Responsibility Committee and Member of the Audit Committee.
Linda is currently a Senior Advisor at the Boston Consulting Group and has spent almost 40 years serving higher education. She retired from Yale in 2016 after 34 years at the university where she served in an array of senior positions, including Vice President for Global & Strategic Initiatives. She oversaw the development of Yale’s online education division and the expansion of Yale’s international programmes and centres. During her tenure, she was responsible for many administrative services, ranging from Yale’s public communications and alumni relations to sustainability, human resources and the university press. She also served on the boards of several public companies, including as Presiding Director of the McGraw-Hill companies. Linda is a trustee of Hollins University and a member of the board of Yale New Haven Hospital, where she chairs the nominating and governance committee, and also remains on several consequential advisory committees at Yale University.
Graeme Pitkethly
Appointed on May 1, 2019. Member of the Audit and Reputation & Responsibility Committees.
Graeme joined Unilever in 2002 and, prior to being appointed CFO and Board member, was responsible for Unilever’s UK and Ireland business. Previously, he had held a number of senior financial and commercial roles within Unilever, including Senior Vice President of Finance for Global Markets, Group Treasurer, Global Head of M&A and Chief Financial Officer of Unilever Indonesia. Graeme spent the earlier part of his career in senior corporate finance roles in the telecommunications industry with FLAG Telecom, and started his career at PricewaterhouseCoopers. Graeme is currently Vice Chair of the Task Force on Climate Related Financial Disclosures, Vice Chair of the 100 Group Main Committee and is a Chartered Accountant. Current notable commitments: Unilever plc (Chief Financial Officer).
Tim Score
Appointed January 1, 2015. Chair of the Audit Committee, Member of the Nomination & Governance and Remuneration Committees.
Tim has extensive experience of the technology sector in both developed and emerging markets, having served as Chief Financial Officer of ARM Holdings plc, the world’s leading semiconductor IP company, for 13 years. He is an experienced
non-executive
director and was appointed as anon-executive
Director of Bridgepoint Group PLC in 2021, alongside his roles as Chair of The British Land Company plc, anon-executive
director of the Football Association, and a Trustee of the National Theatre. Tim has garnered extensive financial and listed company experience during previous and current positions. He served on the board of National Express Group plc from 2005 to 2014, including time as interim Chairman and six years as the Senior Independent Director. Earlier in his career Tim held senior finance roles with Rebus Group, William Baird, LucasVarity plc and BTR plc. Current notable commitments: The British Land Company plc (Chair), Bridgepoint Group PLC(Non-Executive
Director).Annette Thomas
Appointed October 1, 2021. Member of the Nomination & Governance and Reputation & Responsibility Committees.
46
Annette has a
25-year
track record in leading global publishing and data analytics businesses, across academic, educational and consumer media verticals. Most recently, she served as CEO of Guardian Media Group, a position she held until June 2021. Prior to this, Annette was CEO of the Web of Science Group at Clarivate Analytics, a data, analytics and software business focused on research and higher education. She has also served as CEO of Macmillan Publishers and led the digital and global transformation of Nature Publishing Group. She currently serves as a trustee of Yale University. Her previousnon-executive
experience includes serving asnon-executive
director at Clarivate Analytics (2017), and as a board member for Cambridge University Press and Cambridge Assessment (2019-2020). She has also previously acted as an advisor to Creative Commons and Bain Capital.Lincoln Wallen
Appointed January 1, 2016. Member of the Audit and Reputation & Responsibility Committees.
Lincoln has extensive experience in the technology and media industries, and is currently CTO of Improbable, a technologycompany spun out of DreamWorks Animation Studios in Los Angeles, a position he held until 2017. He worked at DreamWorks Animation for nine years in a variety of leadership roles including Chief Technology Officer and Head of Animation Technology. He was formerly CTO at Electronic Arts Mobile, leading their entry into the mobile gaming business internationally. Lincoln is a
start-up
supplying next-generation cloud hosting and networking services to the video game industry. Lincoln was CEO of DWA Nova, asoftware-as-a-service
Non-Executive
Director of the Smith Institute for Industrial Mathematics and Systems Engineering and Varjo, a manufacturer of augmented, virtual and mixed reality headsets for professionals. His early career involved 20 years of professional IT and mathematics research, including as a reader in Computer Science at Oxford. Current notable commitments: Improbable (Chief Technology Officer).The following table sets forth information concerning the Executive Committee, as at February 28, 2022.
Name | Position | |
Tom ap Simon | President, Virtual Learning | |
Ali Bebo | Chief Human Resources Officer | |
Tim Bozik | President, Higher Education; Interim Chief Product Officer and Co-President, Direct to Consumer | |
Lynne Frank | Chief Marketing Officer and Co-President, Direct-to- Consumer | |
Gio Giovannelli | President, English Language Learning | |
Mike Howells | President, Workforce Skills | |
Cinthia Nespoli | Chief Legal Officer | |
Art Valentine | President, Assessment & Qualifications |
On March 16, 2022, Marykay Wells (Chief Information Officer) joined the Pearson Executive Management Team.
Tom ap Simon
Tom has 19 years of international business and finance experience. At Pearson, he has led the Virtual Schools business, worked in finance for the emerging markets businesses and led M&A activity in the US. Previously, he worked in investment banking at RW Baird. Tom holds an MA in Economics and Politics from the University of Edinburgh.
Ali Bebo
Ali is a senior executive with over 25 years of experience transforming culture for transformative business performance across multiple industries. Prior to joining Pearson, she was an officer and CHRO for Hologic, Inc.,
47
a global medical technology company. Prior to Hologic, she held various HR leadership roles with the specialty retail company, ANN INC. Ali earned her BA in political science from the University of California, Los Angeles.
Tim Bozik
Tim has more than 30 years of extensive leadership experience in higher education products and the business of delivering them at Pearson. Tim earned a Bachelor’s Degree from the University of Notre Dame and currently serves on the Board of Directors for the Association of American Publishers.
Lynne Frank
Lynne has over 25 years of experience in the media industry. Previously, she has worked in companies such as WarnerMedia, ESPN/Disney and Turner Broadcasting. Lynne holds a degree in economics and business, and a certificate in corporate board governance from the University of California, Los Angeles (UCLA).
Gio Giovannelli
Gio has over 25 years of international business experience, including four CEO roles in Brazil. Previous board roles include BOVESPA-listed Natura and CVC Viagens. Gio graduated from Bocconi University, holds an Economics Ph.D. and is OPM graduate of Harvard Business School.
Mike Howells
Mike has more than 20 years of international business experience. Previously, he has worked in the British diplomatic network and the UK Foreign, Commonwealth and Development Office. Mike holds a masters degree in International Law from the University of Nottingham and an Anthropology degree from University College London.
Cinthia Nespoli
Cinthia has over 18 years of international legal and compliance experience. Previously, she held leadership roles in legal and compliance at multinational companies. Cinthia was admitted to the Brazilian bar in 2004 and earned her law degree from Pontifícia Universidade Católica de Campinas and a post-graduate degree in tax law from Pontifícia Universidade Católica de São Paulo.
Art Valentine
Art has more than 30 years of leadership experience in assessments, testing, and technology. Prior to his 16 years at Pearson serving as a senior leader of Pearson VUE and as Managing Director of Pearson Clinical Assessments, Art worked at Promissor which was acquired by Pearson in 2006. Art earned his MS in Mathematical Science/Computer Science from the University of North Carolina Chapel Hill.
Marykay Wells
Marykay Wells joined Pearson in 2014 and is responsible for leading the execution of the company’s corporate digital transformation strategy that is driving the shift from print to digital products. She has over 30 years of experience with proven success in strategic planning and execution of large, global technology transformations. Marykay builds high performing teams by establishing customer-first values and cultivating an environment of collaboration, integration, and innovation.
Compensation of senior management
It is the role of the Remuneration Committee (the Committee) to approve the remuneration and benefits packages of the Executive Directors and other members of the Pearson Executive.
48
The principal duties of the Committee are to:
• | Determine and regularly review the remuneration policies for the Executive Directors and other members of Pearson’s Executive management (who report directly to the Chief Executive). This includes base salary, incentive arrangements, pension arrangements, any other benefits and entitlements on termination of employment. When setting remuneration policy and packages, the Committee takes into account all factors which it deems necessary, including wider remuneration practices and related policies for the wider workforce. |
• | Ensure the company maintains an appropriate level of engagement with its shareholders and shareholder representative bodies in relation to the Directors’ Remuneration Policy and its implementation. |
• | Regularly review the implementation and operation of the Directors’ Remuneration Policy and approve the individual remuneration and benefits packages of Executive management. |
• | Approve the design of, and determine targets for, any performance-related pay plans operated by the Group for Pearson Executive management and approve the total payments to be made under such plans. |
• | Advise and decide on general and specific remuneration arrangements in connection with the termination of employment of Executive management. |
• | Delegated responsibility for determining the remuneration and benefits package of the Chair of the Board. |
• | Review updates from management on talent, retention and gender pay gap. |
• | Have oversight of workforce remuneration, policies and practice for the wider organization. |
Remuneration policy
The 2020 Directors’ Remuneration Policy (2020 policy) was approved by our shareholders at the Annual General Meeting held on 24 April 2020. The 2020 policy is underpinned by Pearson’s remuneration principals and aligns the remuneration arrangements for Executive Directors with our strategy and the interests of our long-term shareholders.
The Committee’s starting point continues to be that total remuneration should reward both short and long- term results, delivering competitive rewards for target performance, but outstanding rewards for exceptional performance.
Total remuneration is composed of fixed and performance-linked elements, with each element supporting different objectives. Base salary: helps to recruit, reward and retain employees. Base salary reflects the employment market, level, role, skills, experience and individual contribution. Allowances and benefits: help the company to recruit and retain employees. Retirement benefits: help to recruit and retain staff and recognize their long-term commitment to the company. Annual incentives: Recognize and motivate the achievement of annual business goals and strategic objectives. Annual incentives typically have a focus on key financial and
non-financial
metrics and reward employees for the company’s performance and their individual contribution to the success of the company. Long-term incentives: help to recruit, reward and retain people, drive long-term earnings, share price growth and value creation to align the interests of Executives and shareholders. Long-term incentives encourage long-term shareholding and commitment to the company and link management’s long-term reward and wealth to corporate performance in a flexible way.For Executive Director benchmarking purposes, the Committee reviews remuneration by reference to different comparator groups including survey data from companies of similar size and scope, excluding financial services companies.
49
Consistent with its policy, the Committee places considerable emphasis on the performance-linked elements (i.e. annual and long-term incentives). The Committee continues to review the mix of fixed and performance- linked remuneration on an annual basis, consistent with its overall philosophy.
Base salary
Base salaries are set to provide the appropriate rate of remuneration for the job, taking into account relevant employment markets, business sectors and geographic regions.
Base salaries are typically reviewed annually taking into account: general economic and market conditions; the level of increases made across the company as a whole; particular circumstances such as changes in role, responsibilities or organization; the remuneration and level of increases for executives in similar positions in comparable companies in accordance with their regional employment market; and individual performance.
While there is no maximum salary level or maximum increase that may be offered, salary increases will normally be in line with typical increases awarded to other employees in the Group.
However, increases may be above this level in certain circumstances such as:
• | Where a new Executive Director has been appointed to the Board at a lower than typical market salary to allow for growth in the role then larger increases may be awarded to move salary positioning closer to typical market level as the Executive Director gains experience. |
• | Where an Executive Director has been promoted or has had a change in responsibilities. |
• | Where there has been a significant change in market practice or where there has been a significant change in the size and/or scope of the business. |
Allowances and benefits
Allowances and benefits comprise cash allowances and
non-cash
benefits and which may include:• | travel-related benefits (such as company car, car allowance and private use of a driver); |
• | health-related benefits (such as healthcare, health assessment and gym benefit); |
• | and risk benefits (such as additional life cover and long-term disability insurance that are not covered by the company’s retirement plans). |
Executive Directors are also eligible to participate in savings-related share acquisition programs, which are not subject to any performance conditions, on the same terms and to the same value as other employees.
Where an Executive Director is required to relocate to perform their role, appropriate
one-off
oron-going
expatriate/relocation benefits may be provided (e.g. housing, schooling etc.).The Committee may introduce other benefits, where it is considered appropriate to do so, taking into account the individual circumstances, the country of residence of a Director, the benefits available to all employees and the wider external market.
The cost of the provision of allowances and benefits varies from year to year depending on the cost to the company and there is no prescribed maximum limit. However, the Committee monitors annually the overall cost of the benefits provided along with market data, to ensure that it remains appropriate.
Retirement benefits
Employees in the UK are eligible to join the Money Purchase 2003 section of the Pearson Group Pension Plan. Executive Directors are eligible to join this plan or receive a cash allowance of equivalent value.
50
If any Executive Director is from, or works, outside the UK, the Committee retains a discretion to put in place retirement benefit arrangements for that Director in line with local market practice including defined benefit pension arrangements operated by Pearson locally. The maximum value of such arrangement will reflect local market practice at the relevant time.
The Committee will also honor all
pre-existing
retirement benefit obligations, commitments or other entitlements that were entered into by a member of the Pearson Group before that person became a Director, such as participation in the Final Pay section of the Pearson Group Pension Plan, which is closed to new members.New appointments
From 2020, in line with our approved 2020 policy, new executive appointments to the Board are eligible to receive pension contributions of up to 16% of pensionable salary or a cash allowance of up to 16% of salary in line with the maximum company contribution as a percentage of salary that UK employees who are over 45 are eligible to receive.
UK Executive Directors who are, or become, affected by the lifetime allowance may be provided with appropriate benefits, as an alternative to further accrual of pension benefits such as a cash supplement, in line with the treatment for the employee population.
The pension or equivalent entitlements of each Director are as follows:
Andy Bird
Andy Bird receives a payment in lieu of pension at 16% of his base salary in line with the pension provision for UK employees of a similar age.
Sally Johnson
Sally Johnson is an existing member of the Final Pay Section of the Pearson Pension Plan. Her accrual rate is 1/60th of pensionable salary per annum, restricted to the Plan earnings cap (£172,800 per annum in 2021/22). There are no enhanced early retirement benefits.
Annual incentives
Measures and performance targets are set by the Committee at the start of the year, with payment made after year end following the Committee’s assessment of performance relative to targets.
Annual Incentive Plans are discretionary. The Committee reserves the right to adjust payments up or down if it believes that the outcome does not reflect underlying financial or
non-financial
performance or if such other exceptional factors warrant doing so.The Committee may apply malus and / or clawback for a period of five years in circumstances, such as financial misstatement, individual misconduct or reputational damage to the company.
Annual incentives will not exceed 200% of base salary. For the Chief Executive, the individual maximum incentive opportunity is 200% of base salary and 170% for the Chief Financial Officer. There is normally no
pay-out
for performance at threshold. 50% of the maximum is payable foron-target
levels of performance.The Committee has the discretion to select the performance measures and relative weightings from year to year to ensure continuing alignment with strategy and to ensure targets are sufficiently stretching. The Committee sets performance targets for each measure annually. Annual incentives will normally be based on
51
financial and strategic performance targets. Financial metrics will normally account for at least 75% of the total annual opportunity with the remaining portion normally being based on strategic and / or performance against personal objectives.
The plan is designed to incentivize and reward underlying performance. Actual results may be adjusted to remove the effect of foreign exchange and portfolio changes (acquisitions and disposals) and other relevant factors that the Committee considers do not reflect the underlying performance of the business in the performance year.
The funding of annual incentives will normally be related to the performance against financial and strategic imperatives performance targets. For the 2022 financial year the annual bonus will be based 30% on adjusted operating profit, 30% on sales performance, 20% on operating cash flow and 20% on strategic measures. Each performance measure will operate independently but a financial underpin will apply in respect of the strategic measures. There will be no changes to the maximum annual incentive opportunities for 2022.
Performance metrics linked to strategic objectives can be selected annually to support the Group’s strategy. A
pay-out
will only be made if a minimum level of performance has been achieved under the financial metrics, as determined by the Committee each year.The strategic measures for 2022 will focus on:
• | Accelerating growth through digital transformation and business model innovation |
• | Establishing Pearson as purpose-driven across product, people and the planet |
The targets for 2022 are as follows:
Weighting | Threshold | Target | Maximum | |||||
Digital sales growth | 10% | Plan less 2% | Plan | Plan plus 2% | ||||
Invest in diverse pipeline and increase representation at management levels | 5% | 50% female and ethnic minority representation in leadership development and mentoring programmes + 50% female and 20% ethnic minority representation in leadership succession plans | Threshold + 5% increase in female and ethnic minority representation at VP level and above | Threshold + 10% increase in female and ethnic minority representation at VP level and above | ||||
Reduce carbon footprint – net annual reduction versus 2021 baseline | 5% | 1% reduction | 2% reduction | 5% reduction |
Details of the financial measures, weightings and targets will be disclosed in the annual Remuneration Report for the relevant financial year if and to the extent that the Committee deems them to be no longer commercially sensitive. The performance period is one year.
52
Long-term incentives
Awards of shares are made on an annual basis, which vest on a sliding scale based on performance, assessed against corporate performance targets measured at the end of the three-year performance period.
Awards are normally subject to a post vesting holding period for two years following the end of the performance period.
Participants may receive additional shares representing the gross value of dividends that would have been paid on shares that vest during the performance period.
The Committee reserves the right to adjust
pay-outs
up or down before they are released if it believes that the vesting outcome does not reflect underlying financial ornon-financial
performance or if such other exceptional factors warrant doing so. In making such adjustments, the Committee is guided by the principle of aligning shareholder and management interests.The Committee may apply malus and / or clawback for a period of five years in circumstances, such as financial misstatement, individual misconduct, or reputational damage to the company.
The maximum award is 350% of base salary in respect of a financial year.
The Committee will determine the performance measures, weightings and targets governing an award of shares prior to grant to ensure continuing alignment with strategy and to ensure that targets are sufficiently stretching.
The Committee establishes a threshold below which no
pay-out
is achieved and a maximum at or above which the award pays out in full. The proportion of the award that vests at threshold may be up to 25%.Awards will normally be subject to the achievement of targets for earnings per share, return on invested capital and relative total shareholder return (weighted equally). The Committee may determine that different measures or weightings may apply for future awards, however, the Committee would intend to consult with shareholders in advance if there was to be a significant change in the weighting of measures or the performance measures used.
Andy Bird and Sally Johnson were eligible for a Long-Term Incentive Plan (LTIP) award in 2021. The maximum face value of the award granted was 300% and 245% of base salary respectively. Face value was determined using a share price of 826.7p
(five-day
average to 4 May 2021), which is the share price used to determine award values for LTIP awards to the wider employee population.The 2021 LTIP award will vest on 1 May 2024 subject to the following performance targets:
EPS (1/3) | Net ROIC (1/3) | Relative TSR (1/3) | ||||||||
Vesting schedule (% of max) | Adjusted EPS for FY23 | Vesting schedule (% of max) | Adjusted net ROIC for FY23 | Vesting schedule (% of max) | Ranked position vs. FTSE 100 | |||||
15% | 46.5p | 15% | 5.5% | 25% | Median | |||||
65% | 53.5p | 65% | 6.5% | — | — | |||||
100% | 61.0p | 100% | 7.5% | 100% | Upper quartile |
Note: | straight line vesting between points shown, with no vesting for performance below threshold. |
For 2022, Andy Bird and Sally Johnson will be granted an award of 300% and 245% of base salary, respectively.
53
Performance measures and targets for 2022 are as follows:
EPS (1/3) | Net ROIC (1/3) | Relative TSR (1/3) | ||||||||
Vesting schedule (% of max) | Adjusted EPS for FY23 | Vesting schedule (% of max) | Adjusted net ROIC for FY23 | Vesting schedule (% of max) | Ranked position vs. FTSE 100 | |||||
15% | 48.0p | 15% | 6.0% | 25% | Median | |||||
65% | 55.0p | 65% | 7.0% | — | — | |||||
100% | 64.0p | 100% | 8.0% | 100% | Upper quartile |
In May 2019, former Chief Executive John Fallon was made an award under the 2019 LTIP. This award was based on performance the business delivered over the three-year period from 2019 to 2021.
The LTIP award made to John Fallon would have vested on the normal vesting date,
pro-rated
for time to reflect John’s departure prior to the normal vesting date, but the applicable performance targets have not been met and therefore his award, together with awards for other participants, will lapse in full.Co-investment
awardIn order to secure Andy Bird as our Chief Executive the Committee developed a
one-off
co-investment
award. The Committee recognizes that such aone-off
arrangement is not typical in the UK market, but believe it was the optimal structure to secure Andy Bird’s recruitment whilst incentivizing the creation of long-term shareholder value and keeping our forward-looking 2020 policy unchanged.The grant of the
co-investment
award was conditional on Andy purchasing Pearson shares equal to 300% of base salary by 31 December 2020 (being a total value of $3.75m), which he must continue to hold throughout the period to 31 December 2023. This personal investment by Andy demonstrates his commitment to the role and creates immediate alignment with shareholders.In consideration for this investment, Andy was granted a
co-investment
award equal to 750% of base salary.The
co-investment
award vests in three equal tranches as soon as practicable following 31 December 2021, 31 December 2022 and 31 December 2023 respectively and is subject to performance underpins and Andy’s continued employment as at each vesting date.Shares that vest will be subject to a holding period until 31 December 2023. The
co-investment
award was designed taking into account Andy’s home market – the US – where the structure of pay is often very different to the UK and aims to incentivize the transformation of the business and growth in the near-term. It was therefore considered appropriate that the phased vesting schedule and holding period to December 2023 reflect the period over which it is expected value will be delivered to our shareholders.The vesting of the
co-investment
award is subject to the achievement of performance underpins to ensure the Committee can reduce vesting if in its opinion the performance of the business or the individual does not support this. These underpins are intended to prevent payment for failure.The vesting of each tranche of the award will be subject to the following performance underpins:
• | an appropriate level of progress being made in relation to delivering our strategy including our ongoing transition from print to digital |
• | no significant ESG issues related to Andy’s tenure occurring which result in significant reputational damage |
54
In addition, the vesting of the final tranche of the award will also be subject to the following TSR underpin:
• | the company’s TSR from the date of the announcement of Andy’s appointment to 31 December 2023 is either (1) positive; or (2) is at median or above when compared to the performance of the FTSE 100 |
If one or more of the underpins are not achieved, then the Committee would consider whether, and to what extent, a discretionary reduction in the number of shares vesting was required.
When determining the vesting of each tranche of the
co-investment
award, in addition to assessing the specific underpins, the Committee undertakes a thorough and robust review process which considers a holistic view of the wider stakeholder experience, including that of shareholders, employees, customers, and suppliers. Full details of this assessment will be disclosed in the annual Remuneration Report for the relevant financial year.Shareholding policy
Executive Directors are expected to build up a shareholding in the company. The target holding is 300% of salary for the Chief Executive and 200% of salary for the Chief Financial Officer. Members of the executive management team are expected to build a holding of 100%.
Post-employment shareholding policy
Executive Directors are expected to retain their shareholding guideline (or actual holding if lower) for two years following stepping down as an Executive Director. This provision does not apply to any shares purchased by the Executive Director.
Service agreements
In accordance with long established policy, all Executive Directors have service agreements under which, other than by termination in accordance with the terms of these agreements, employment continues indefinitely. There are no special provisions for notice or
non-share-based
compensation in the event of a change of control of Pearson. It is Pearson’s policy that the company may terminate the Chair’s and Executive Directors’ service agreements by giving no more than 12 months’ notice.Payment in lieu of notice
As an alternative, for Executive Directors, Pearson may at its discretion pay in lieu of that notice. Payment in lieu of notice may be made in equal monthly installments from the date of termination to the end of any unexpired notice period. Payment in lieu of notice in installments may also be subject to mitigation and reduced taking into account earnings from alternative employment.
For Executive Directors, payment in lieu of notice comprises 100% of the annual salary at the date of termination and the annual cost to the company of providing pension and all other benefits. For the Chair, payment in lieu of notice comprises 100% of the annual fees at the date of termination.
The company may, depending on the circumstances of the termination, determine that it will not pay the Director in lieu of notice and may instead terminate a Director’s contract in breach and make a damages payment, taking into account as appropriate the Director’s ability to mitigate their loss.
The company may also pay an amount considered to be reasonable by the Committee in respect of fees for legal and tax advice and outplacement support for the departing Director. The Committee reserves the right to make any other payments in connection with a Director’s cessation of office or employment where the payments
55
are made in good faith, in discharge of an existing legal obligation (or by way of damages for breach of such an obligation) or by way of settlement of any claim arising in connection with the cessation of a Director’s office or employment.
Share awards
On cessation of employment, unless otherwise provided for under the rules of Pearson’s discretionary share plans, Executive Directors’ entitlements to any unvested awards lapse automatically. In the case of termination of employment due to injury, disability,
ill-health
or redundancy (as determined by the Committee), where a participant’s employing company ceases to be part of Pearson, or any other reason if the Committee so decides in its absolute discretion:• | Awards that are subject to performance conditions will stay in force as if the participant had not ceased employment and shall vest on the original vesting date / be released in line with normal time horizons. |
• | Awards that are not subject to a performance condition will be released as soon as practicable following cessation of employment. |
• | The number of shares that are released shall be pro-rated for the period of the participant’s service in the restricted period (although the Committee may in its absolute discretion waive or vary thepro-rating). |
In determining whether and how to exercise its discretion under Pearson’s discretionary share plans, the Committee will have regard to all relevant circumstances distinguishing between different types of leaver, the circumstances at the time the award was originally made, the Director’s performance and the circumstances in which the Director left employment.
The rules of Pearson’s discretionary share plans also make provision for the treatment of awards in respect of corporate activity, including a change of control of Pearson. The Committee would act in accordance with the terms of the awards in these circumstances, which includes terms as to the assessment of performance conditions and time apportionment.
Annual bonus
On cessation of employment, Executive Directors, participating in an Annual Incentive Plan for the relevant financial year, may, at the Committee’s discretion, retain entitlement to a pro rata annual incentive award, for their period of service during the financial year prior to their leaving date. Such
pay-out
will normally be calculated in good faith on the same terms and paid at the same time as for continuing Executive Directors.Other elements of remuneration
Eligibility for allowances and benefits including retirement benefits normally cease when an employee retires or when an employee’s employment is terminated for any other reason.
Executive Directors’
Non-Executive
DirectorshipsThe Group’s policy is that Executive Directors may, by agreement with the Board, serve as
Non-Executives
of other companies and retain any fees payable for their services. Neither of the current Executive Directors, Andy Bird nor Sally Johnson, hold any notable external commitments.Chair’s and
Non-Executive
Directors’ remunerationThe Chair is paid a single fee for all of their responsibilities. The Chair’s fee is set at a level that is competitive with those of Chairs in similar positions in comparable companies.
56
The
Non-Executive
Directors are paid a basic fee. The Chair and members of the main Board Committees and the Senior Independent Director are paid an additional fee to reflect their extra responsibilities. A Deputy Chair fee, which is a single fee for all their responsibilities, will be introduced from the 2022 AGM.Fees for
Non-Executive
Directors are determined by the full board having regard to market practice.Additional fees or other payments may be paid to reflect additional responsibilities, roles or contribution, as appropriate.
The Chair and
Non-Executive
Directors are not entitled to any annual or long-term incentive, retirement or other employee benefits. Selected benefits may be introduced, if considered appropriate.Pearson reimburses the Chair’s and
Non-Executive
Directors’ travel and other business expenses, and any tax incurred thereon, if applicable.Normally a minimum of 25% of the Chair and
Non-Executive
Directors’ basic fee is paid in Pearson shares that theNon-Executive
Directors have committed to retain for the period of their directorships. Shares are normally acquired quarterly at the prevailing market price with the individual’safter-tax
fee payments.Fee levels are reviewed on a periodic basis.
The basic total fees payable to the
Non-Executive
Directors (excluding the Chair) are subject to the limit set out in the Articles of Association of the company (currently £1,000,000) and as increased by ordinary resolution from time to time.With effect from April 2022 | ||||
Non-Executive Director | £ | 70,000 | ||
Chairmanship of Audit Committee | £ | 27,500 | ||
Chairmanship of Remuneration Committee | £ | 22,000 | ||
Chairmanship of Nomination and Governance Committee | £ | 15,000 | ||
Chairmanship of Reputation and Responsibility Committee | £ | 15,000 | ||
Membership of Audit Committee | £ | 15,000 | ||
Membership of Remuneration Committee | £ | 10,000 | ||
Membership of Nomination and Governance Committee | £ | 8,000 | ||
Membership of Reputation and Responsibility Committee | £ | 8,000 | ||
Senior Independent Director (until 2022 AGM) | £ | 22,000 | ||
Deputy Chair (from 2022 AGM) | £ | 175,000 |
Notes
(1) | The fee paid to the Chair remains unchanged for 2022 at £500,000. |
(2) | The fees paid to Non-Executive Directors are unchanged for 2022. |
(3) | Non-Executive Directors serve Pearson under letters of appointment and do not have service contracts. There is no entitlement to compensation on the termination of their directorships. |
57
Remuneration of board of directors
The remuneration received by the Chair,
Non-Executive
Directors and Executive Directors in respect of the financial year ending December 31, 2021 was as follows:Base Salary/ Fees | Allowances & Benefits(1) | Annual Incentives | Long-term Incentives | Co-investment plan | Retirement Benefits | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
£000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | £000 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Chair | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sidney Taurel | 500 | — | — | — | — | — | 500 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Non-Executive Directors | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Elizabeth Corley | 111 | — | — | — | — | — | 111 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Sherry Coutu | 92 | — | — | — | — | — | 92 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Vivienne Cox | 43 | — | — | — | — | — | 43 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Linda Lorimer | 100 | — | — | — | — | — | 100 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Michael Lynton | 31 | — | — | — | — | — | 31 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Graeme Pitkethly | 93 | — | — | — | — | — | 93 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Tim Score | 130 | — | — | — | — | — | 130 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Lincoln Wallen | 93 | — | — | — | — | — | 93 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Annette Thomas | 21 | — | — | — | — | — | 21 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Executive Directors | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Andy Bird | 910 | 271 | 1,145 | — | 2,696 | 145 | 5,167 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Sally Johnson | 521 | 16 | 560 | — | — | 58 | 1,155 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Board of Directors | 2,645 | 287 | 1,705 | — | 2,696 | 203 | 7,536 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Notes:
(1) | Travel benefits include car allowance and reimbursements of a taxable nature resulting from business travel and engagements. Health benefits comprise healthcare, health assessment and dental care. Risk-related benefits comprise of life and other insurance policies. Accommodation benefits for Andy Bird relate to a contribution towards the rental costs of an apartment in New York to be used for business purposes, the cost of which has been capped at $240,000 per year ($20,000 per month) prior to any taxes which may be due. In addition to the allowances and benefits set out, Executive Directors may also participate in company benefit or policy arrangements that have no taxable value and/ or are available to all other employees in the same location. Sally Johnson’s life cover is arranged under The Pearson Pension Plan’s UK group-wide policy. |
(2) | Remuneration for Andy Bird has been converted using a USD: GBP exchange rate of 1.3753 (average exchange rate for 2021). |
(3) | Elizabeth Corley stepped down from the Board on 31 December 2021. |
(4) | Vivienne Cox stepped down from the Board on 30 April 2021. |
(5) | Michael Lynton stepped down from the Board on 30 April 2021. |
(6) | Annette Thomas joined the Board on 1 October 2021. |
Share options for senior management
Sally Johnson holds 2,658 options under the Pearson Save For Shares scheme, a savings-related share acquisition program open to all employees. These are not subject to future performance conditions.
Share ownership of senior management
The table below shows the number of ordinary shares and conditional shares held by Directors and their connected persons as at December 31 2021. Additional information with respect to share options held by, and bonus awards for, these persons is set out above in “Remuneration of Senior Management” and “Share Options
58
of Senior Management”. The total number of ordinary shares held by senior management as of December 31, 2021 was 1,010,088.
As at 31 December 2021 | Ordinary Shares (1) | Conditional Shares | ||||||
Chair | ||||||||
Sidney Taurel | 234,894 | — | ||||||
Executive Directors | ||||||||
Andy Bird | 586,437 | 1,541,177 | ||||||
Sally Johnson | 20,265 | 384,655 | ||||||
Non-Executive Directors | ||||||||
Elizabeth Corley | 39,206 | — | ||||||
Sherry Coutu | 6,566 | — | ||||||
Vivienne Cox | 9,220 | — | ||||||
Linda Lorimer | 15,435 | — | ||||||
Michael Lynton | 20,820 | — | ||||||
Graeme Pitkethly | 9,162 | — | ||||||
Tim Score | 54,593 | — | ||||||
Lincoln Wallen | 13,490 | — | ||||||
Annette Thomas | — | — |
Notes:
(1) | Share interests are shown as at 31 December 2021. For Directors who stepped down from the Board during the year, share interests are shown as at the date of their stepping down. |
(2) | Ordinary shares include both ordinary shares listed on the London Stock Exchange and American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) listed on the New York Stock Exchange. The figures include both shares and ADRs acquired by individuals under the long-term incentive plan and any other share plans they might have participated in. |
(3) | Conditional shares means unvested shares which remain subject to performance conditions, performance underpins and/or continuing employment for a pre-defined period. |
(4) | The register of Directors’ interests contains full details of Directors’ shareholdings and options to subscribe for shares. The market price on December 31, 2021 was 613.20 p per share and the range during the year was 571.80 p to 869.40 p. |
(5) | Andy Bird‘s first tranche of the Co-investment plan, 412,933 shares (including 9,980 dividend equivalent shares), vested on 25 February 2022, taking his conditional shares to 1,345,808 (after the sales of shares to cover any tax liability). The vestedco-investment shares are subject to a holding period until 31 December 2023 and are subject to continued employment. There have been no other changes in the interests of any Director between 31 December 2021 and 30 March 2022, being the latest practicable date prior to the publication of this report. |
The total remuneration of the Executive Committee is set out in the table below:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | |||
Short-term employee benefits | 6 | |||
Retirement benefits | 1 | |||
Share-based payment costs | 8 | |||
Total | 15 | |||
Employee share ownership plans
In 1998, Pearson introduced a Worldwide Save For Shares Plan (“Plan”). Under this Plan, employees around the world have the option to save a portion of their monthly salary over periods of three or five years. At
59
the end of this period, the employee has the option to purchase ordinary shares with the accumulated funds at a purchase price equal to 80% of the market price prevailing at the commencement of the employee’s participation in the plan. In 2014, shareholders approved the renewal and extension of the life of the Plan in the UK by a further ten years, until 2024 and the renewal of the directors’ authority to continue to operate equivalent arrangements for employees based outside of the UK. As part of this renewal, the savings limit for the UK HMRC-approved part of the plan (which forms the basis of the plan in the rest of the world outside the US) was increased from £250 to £500 per month. Since 2020, Pearson has only operated a three-year Plan under the new name “Save For Shares”.
In the United States, Pearson operates an employee stock purchase plan (“ESPP”) under Section 423 of the US Internal Revenue Code of 1986. This plan was introduced in 2000 following Pearson’s listing on the New York Stock Exchange. Under it, participants save a portion of their monthly salary over six month periods, at the end of which they have the option to purchase ADRs with their accumulated funds at a purchase price equal to 85% of the lower of the market price prevailing at the beginning or end of the period. The maximum employee contribution under the plan is $1,000 per month.
Board practices
As at February 28, 2022, the Group’s Board comprises the Chair, two Executive Directors and seven
Non-Executive
Directors. Omid Kordestani has joined the Board from March 1, 2022, and will succeed Sidney Taurel asNon-Executive
Chair upon conclusion of the company’s AGM in April 2022. The articles of association provide that all the Directors at the date of the notice convening the annual general meeting shall retire from office. A retiring Director shall, if willing to act, be eligible forre-appointment.
If they are notre-appointed,
they shall retain office until the meeting appoints someone in their place, or if it does not do so, until the end of the meeting or, if the meeting is adjourned, the end of the adjourned meeting. The articles of association also provide that every Director be subject tore-appointment
by shareholders at the next annual general meeting following their appointment.All of the Directors, save Sidney Taurel, will offer themselves for
re-election
at the forthcoming annual general meeting on April 29, 2022.Pearson is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”). As a listed
non-US
issuer, the Group is not required to comply with some of the NYSE’s corporate governance rules, but must disclose on its website any significant ways in which its corporate governance practices differ from those followed by US companies under the NYSE listing standards. At this time, the Group believes that it is in compliance in all material respects with all the NYSE rules except that the Remuneration Committee and the Nomination & Governance Committee are not composed entirely of independent Directors as the Chair, who is not considered independent under NYSE rules, is a member of each Committee in addition to independent Directors.The Board of Directors has established the following formal Committees, all of which report to the Board. Each Committee has its own written terms of reference setting out its authority and duties. These can be found on the Governance section of our website (
pearsonplc.com
).Details of each of the Committees is set out below. Committee members are as at February 28, 2022.
Audit Committee
This Committee appraises the Group’s financial management and reporting and assesses the integrity of its accounting procedures and financial control. In addition, the Committee has oversight of risk management systems, including data privacy and cyber security matters, and the internal control environment. Tim Score chairs this Committee and its other members are Linda Lorimer, Graeme Pitkethly and Lincoln Wallen. Each member is “financially literate” for the purposes of the NYSE listing standards. In addition, the Board of
60
Directors have determined that Tim Score is an audit committee financial expert within the meaning of the applicable rules and regulations of the SEC. The Group’s internal and external auditors have direct access to the Committee to raise any matter of concern and to report the results of work directed by the Committee.
Remuneration Committee
This Committee meets regularly to determine the remuneration and benefits of the executive Directors and oversees remuneration arrangements for the Pearson Executive. The Committee also recommends the Chair’s remuneration to the Board of Directors for its decision. Sherry Coutu chairs this Committee and its other members are Tim Score and Sidney Taurel.
Nomination & Governance Committee
This Committee reviews corporate governance matters including UK Corporate Governance Code compliance and Board evaluation, considers the appointment of new Directors, Board experience and diversity, and reviews Board induction and succession plans. The Committee is Chaired by Sidney Taurel and its other members are Sherry Coutu, Tim Score and Annette Thomas.
Reputation & Responsibility Committee
This Committee considers the Group’s impact on our various stakeholders, including society and the communities in which the Group operates, ensuring strategies are in place to manage and improve the Group’s reputation, whilst considering ESG matters. Linda Lorimer chairs this Committee and its other members are Andy Bird, Graeme Pitkethly, Annette Thomas and Lincoln Wallen.
Employees
The average number of persons employed by the Group in continuing operations during each of the three fiscal years ended 2021 were as follows:
• | 20,744 in fiscal 2021, and |
• | 21,191 in fiscal 2020, and |
• | 22,243 in fiscal 2019. |
Through its subsidiaries, the Group has entered into collective bargaining agreements with employees in various locations. The Group’s management has no reason to believe that it would not be able to renegotiate any such agreements on satisfactory terms. The Group encourages employees to contribute actively to the business in the context of their particular job roles and believes that the relations with its employees are generally good.
The table set forth below shows for 2021, 2020 and 2019 the average number of persons employed in each of the Group’s geographical areas.
Average number employed | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
UK | 3,395 | 3,304 | 3,309 | |||||||||
Other European Countries | 878 | 886 | 927 | |||||||||
US | 11,757 | 11,432 | 12,286 | |||||||||
Canada | 593 | 648 | 694 | |||||||||
Asia Pacific | 2,738 | 2,812 | 2,800 | |||||||||
Other Countries | 1,383 | 2,109 | 2,227 | |||||||||
Continuing operations | 20,744 | 21,191 | 22,243 | |||||||||
61
2020 and 2019 employee numbers have been restated to be on a comparable basis to the current year. The average number employed in discontinued operations was nil in 2021, nil in 2020, and nil in 2019.
ITEM 7. | MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS |
As at February 28, 2022, the company had been notified under the Financial Conduct Authority’s Disclosure and Transparency Rules of the following significant voting rights in its shares:
Name of Shareholder | Number of ordinary shares held | % of outstanding ordinary shares represented by number of shares held* | ||||||
Cevian Capital II GP Limited Inc | 77,163,275 | 10.19 | % | |||||
Schroders plc | 75,127,663 | 9.98 | % | |||||
Silchester International Investors LLP | 75,051,050 | 9.97 | % | |||||
Blackrock, Inc | 52,766,197 | 7.00 | % | |||||
Ameriprise Financial Inc and its group | 41,236,375 | 5.02 | % | |||||
Libyan Investment Authority** | 24,431,000 | 3.01 | % |
* | % of Issued share capital on date notified |
** | Based on notification to the company dated 7 June 2010. We have been notified of no change to this holding since that date. Assets belonging to, or owned, held or controlled on 16 September 2011 by the Libyan Investment Authority and located outside Libya on that date, are frozen in accordance with The Libya (Sanctions) (EU Exit) Regulations 2020. |
On February 28, 2022, 2,575 record holders with registered addresses in the United States held 29,748,341 ADRs, which represented 3.93% of the Group’s outstanding ordinary shares. Some of these ADRs are held by nominees and so these numbers may not accurately represent the number of shares beneficially owned in the United States.
Loans and equity advanced to joint ventures and associates during the year and as at December 31, 2021 are shown in note 12 in “Item 18. Financial Statements.” Related party transactions in 2021 are set out in note 36 in “Item 18. Financial Statements.
ITEM 8. | FINANCIAL INFORMATION |
The financial statements filed as part of this Annual Report are included on pages F1 through F90 hereof.
Other than those events described in note 37 in “Item 18. Financial Statements” of this Form
20-F
and seasonal fluctuations in borrowings, there has been no significant change to the Group’s financial condition or results of operations since December 31, 2021. The Group’s borrowings fluctuate by season due to the effect of the school year on the working capital requirements of the educational book business. Assuming no acquisitions or disposals, the maximum level of net debt normally occurs in the third quarter, and the minimum level of net debt normally occurs in December.The Group’s policy with respect to dividend distributions is described in response to “Item 4. Information on the Company” above.
See “Item 4. Information on the Company — Legal Proceedings” for information with respect to legal proceedings to which the Group may be subject from time to time.
ITEM 9. | THE OFFER AND LISTING |
The principal trading market for the Group’s ordinary shares is the London Stock Exchange which trade under the symbol “PSON”. Its ordinary shares also trade in the United States in the form of ADSs evidenced by
62
ADRs under a sponsored ADR facility with The Bank of New York Mellon, as depositary. The Group established this facility in March 1995 and most recently amended it in August 2014 in connection with its New York Stock Exchange listing. Each ADS represents one ordinary share.
The ADSs trade on the New York Stock Exchange under the symbol “PSO”.
ITEM 10. | ADDITIONAL INFORMATION |
Articles of association
The Group summarizes below the material provisions of its articles of association, as amended (the), which have been filed as an exhibit to its annual report on Form
Articles of Association
20-F
for the year ended December 31, 2021. The summary below is qualified entirely by reference to the Articles of Association. The Group has multiple business objectives and purposes and is authorized to do such things as the Board may consider fit to further its interests or incidental or conducive to the attainment of its objectives and purposes.Directors’ powers
The Group’s business shall be managed by the Board of Directors and the Board may exercise all such of its powers as are not required by law or by the Articles of Association or by any directions given by the company by special resolution, to be exercised in a general meeting.
Interested Directors
For the purposes of section 175 of the UK Companies Act 2006 (the)
Act
1
, the Board may authorize any matter proposed to it which would, if not so authorized, involve a breach of duty by a Director under that section, including, without limitation, any matter which relates to a situation in which a Director has, or can have, an interest which conflicts, or possibly may conflict, with the interests of the company. Any such authorization will be effective only if:(a) | any requirement as to quorum at the meeting at which the matter is considered is met without counting the Director in question or any other interested Director; and |
(b) | the matter was agreed to without their voting or would have been agreed to if their votes had not been counted. |
The Board may (whether at the time of the giving of the authorization or subsequently) make any such authorization subject to any limits or conditions it expressly imposes but such authorization is otherwise given to the fullest extent permitted. The Board may vary or terminate any such authorization at any time.
Provided that he or she has disclosed to the Board the nature and extent of his or her interest (or else that the Director is not aware of the interest or not aware of the transaction or arrangement in question, or else that the interest cannot be reasonably regarded to give rise to a conflict of interest), a Director notwithstanding his or her office:
(a) | may be a party to, or otherwise interested in, any transaction or arrangement with the company or in which the company is otherwise (directly or indirectly) interested; |
(b) | may act by himself or herself or his or her firm in a professional capacity for the company (otherwise than as auditor) and he or she or his or her firm shall be entitled to remuneration for professional services as if he or she were not a Director; |
(c) | may be a Director or other officer of, or employed by, or a party to a transaction or arrangement with, or otherwise interested in, any body corporate in which the company is otherwise (directly or indirectly) interested. |
63
A Director shall not, by reason of his or her office, be accountable to the company for any remuneration or other benefit which he or she derives from any office or employment or from any transaction or arrangement or from any interest in any body corporate:
(a) | the acceptance, entry into or existence of which has been approved by the Board (subject, in any such case, to any limits or conditions to which such approval was subject); or |
(b) | which he or she is permitted to hold or enter into by virtue of paragraph (a), (b) or (c) above; |
nor shall the receipt of any such remuneration or other benefit constitute a breach of his or her duty under section 176 of the Act.
A Director shall be under no duty to the company with respect to any information which he or she obtains or has obtained otherwise than as a Director of the company and in respect of which he or she owes a duty of confidentiality to another person. However, to the extent that his or her relationship with that other person gives rise to a conflict of interest or possible conflict of interest, the preceding sentence only applies if the existence of such relationship has been approved by the Board. In such circumstances, the Director shall not be in breach of the general duties he or she owes to the company by virtue of sections 171 to 177 of the Act because he or she fails:
(a) | to disclose any such information to the Board or to any Director or other officer or employee of the company; and/or |
(b) | to use or apply any such information in performing his or her duties as a Director of the company. |
Where the existence of a Director’s relationship with another person has been approved by the Board and his or her relationship with that person gives rise to a conflict of interest or possible conflict of interest, the Director shall not be in breach of the general duties he or she owes to the company by virtue of sections 171 to 177 of the Act because he or she:
(a) | absents himself or herself from meetings of the Board at which any matter relating to the conflict of interest or possible conflict of interest will or may be discussed or from the discussion of any such matter at a meeting or otherwise; and/or |
(b) | makes arrangements not to receive documents and information relating to any matter which gives rise to the conflict of interest or possible conflict of interest sent or supplied by the company and/or for such documents and information to be received and read by a professional adviser, for so long as he or she reasonably believes such conflict of interest or possible conflict of interest subsists. |
Except as stated below, a Director shall not vote in respect of any contract or arrangement or any other proposal whatsoever in which he or she has an interest which is, to his or her knowledge, a material interest, otherwise than by virtue of his or her interests in shares or debentures or other securities of or otherwise in or through the company. A Director shall not be counted in the quorum at a meeting of the Board in relation to any resolution on which he or she is debarred from voting.
Notwithstanding the foregoing, a Director will be entitled to vote, and be counted in the quorum, on any resolution concerning any of the following matters:
• | the giving of any guarantee, security or indemnity in respect of money lent or obligations incurred by him or her or by any other person at the request of or for the benefit of the company or any of its subsidiaries; |
• | the giving of any guarantee, security or indemnity to a third party in respect of a debt or obligation of the company or any of its subsidiaries for which he himself or she herself has assumed responsibility in whole or in part and whether alone or jointly with others under a guarantee or indemnity or by the giving of security; |
64
• | any proposal relating to the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings where it is offering securities in which offer a Director is or may be entitled to participate as a holder of securities or in the underwriting or sub-underwriting of which a Director is to participate; |
• | any proposal relating to another company in which he or she and any persons connected with him or her do not to his or her knowledge hold an interest in shares (as that term is used in sections 820 to 825 of the Act) representing one per cent or more of either any class of the equity share capital, or the voting rights, in such company; |
• | any proposal relating to an arrangement for the benefit of the employees of the company or any of its subsidiary undertakings which does not award him or her any privilege or benefit not generally awarded to the employees to whom such arrangement relates; and |
• | any proposal concerning insurance that the company proposes to maintain or purchase for the benefit of Directors or for the benefit of persons, including Directors. |
Where proposals are under consideration concerning the appointment of two or more Directors to offices or employment with us or any company in which the Group is interested, these proposals may be divided and considered separately and each of these Directors, if not prohibited from voting under the provisions of the eighth paragraph before this one, will be entitled to vote and be counted in the quorum with respect to each resolution except that concerning his or her own appointment.
Retirement and
re-appointment
of directorsAt every annual general meeting, all the Directors at the date of the notice convening the annual general meeting shall retire from office. A retiring Director shall, if willing to act, be eligible for
re-appointment.
If he or she is notre-appointed,
he or she shall retain office until the meeting appoints someone in his or her place, or if it does not do so, until of the end of the meeting, or until the end of the adjourned meeting if the meeting is adjourned.Where a Director has been reappointed after notice of the annual general meeting has been given, that Director shall retire at the next annual general meeting of which notice is first given after his or her appointment as Director.
If there is an insufficient number of appointed or
re-appointed
Directors at any of the company’s annual general meetings thus rendering the Board inquorate, all Directors shall be automaticallyre-appointed
only for the purposes of filling vacancies and convening general meetings of the company and to perform such duties as are appropriate to maintain the company as a going concern and to enable it to comply with its legal and regulatory obligations. The Directors are required to convene a further general meeting of the company as soon as reasonably practicable to allow new Directors to be appointed, and such Directors who were not appointed at the original general meeting shall subsequently retire.Borrowing powers
The Board of Directors may exercise all powers to borrow money and to mortgage or charge the Group’s undertaking, property and uncalled capital and to issue debentures and other securities, whether outright or as collateral security for any of its or any third party’s debts, liabilities or obligations. The Board of Directors must restrict the borrowings in order to secure that the aggregate amount of undischarged monies borrowed by the Group (and any of its subsidiaries), but excluding any intra-group debts, shall not at any time (without the previous sanction of the company in the form of an ordinary resolution) exceed a sum equal to twice the aggregate of the adjusted capital and reserves.
Other provisions relating to Directors
Under the Articles of Association, Directors are paid out of the Group’s funds for their services as it may from time to time determine by ordinary resolution and, in the case of
non-executive
Directors, up to an65
aggregate of £1,000,000 per year or such other amounts as resolved by the shareholders at a general meeting. Any Director who is not an Executive Director and who performs special services which in the opinion of the Board are outside the scope of the ordinary duties of a Director, may be paid such extra remuneration by way of additional fee, salary, commission or otherwise as the Board may determine in accordance with the Group’s remuneration policy. Under the Articles of Association, Directors currently are not required to hold any share qualification. However, the remuneration policy mandates a shareholding guideline for executive Directors which they are expected to build towards over a specified period.
General meetings
Pursuant to the Act, the company must hold an annual general meeting (‘AGM’) (within six months beginning with the day following its accounting reference date) at a place and time determined by the Board. The following matters are usually considered at an annual general meeting:
• | approval of final dividends; |
• | consideration of the company’s annual accounts together with associated reports of the Board of Directors and auditors; |
• | appointment or reappointment of Directors; |
• | appointment or reappointment of, and determination of the remuneration of, the auditors; and |
• | renewal, limitation, extension, variation or grant of any authority to the Board in relation to the allotment and repurchase of securities. |
The Board may call a general meeting whenever it thinks fit. If at any time there are not within the United Kingdom sufficient Directors capable of acting to form a quorum, any Director or any two members may convene a general meeting in the same manner as nearly as possible as that in which meetings may be convened by the Board.
No business shall be dealt with at any general meeting unless a quorum is present when the meeting proceeds to business. Three members present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote shall be a quorum for all purposes. A corporation being a member shall be deemed to be personally present if represented by its duly authorized representative.
If a quorum for a meeting convened at the request of shareholders is not present within fifteen minutes of the appointed time (or if during a meeting such a quorum ceases to be present), the meeting will be dissolved. In any other case, the general meeting will be adjourned to such time and with such means of attendance and participation as the chair of the meeting may determine. If at that rescheduled meeting a quorum is not present within fifteen minutes from the time appointed for holding the meeting, the shareholders present in person or by proxy will be a quorum. The chair or, in his or her absence, the deputy chair or any other Director nominated by the Board, will preside as chair at every general meeting. If no Director is present at the general meeting or no Director consents to act as chair, the shareholders present shall elect one of their number to be chair of the meeting.
The Board may resolve to enable persons entitled to attend and participate in a general meeting to do so by simultaneous attendance and participation by means of electronic facility or facilities and determine the means, or all different means, of attendance and participation used in relation to a general meeting. The members present in person or by proxy by means of electronic facility or facilities shall be counted in the quorum for, and entitled to participate in the general meeting in question. That meeting shall be duly constituted and its proceedings valid if the chair of the meeting is satisfied that adequate facilities are available throughout the meeting to ensure that members attending the meeting by all means (including by means of electronic facility or facilities) are able to:
(a) | participate in the business for which the meeting has been convened; |
66
(b) | hear all persons who speak at the meeting; and |
(c) | be heard by all persons present at the meeting. |
A member seeking to be present in person or by proxy at a general meeting by means of electronic facility or facilities is responsible for ensuring they have access to and can use the facility or facilities. The meeting shall be duly constituted and its proceedings valid notwithstanding the inability of the member to gain access to use the facility or facilities, or the loss of access to or use of the facility or facilities during the meeting.
Share Certificates
Every person whose name is entered as a member in the company’s Register of Members shall be entitled to one certificate in respect of each class of shares held (the law regarding this does not apply to stock exchange nominees). Subject to the terms of issue of the shares, certificates are issued following allotment or receipt of the relevant transfer by the Group’s registrar, Equiniti, Aspect House, Spencer Road, Lancing, West Sussex, BN99 6DA, United Kingdom.
Share capital
Any share may be issued with such preferred, deferred or other special rights or other restrictions as may be determined by way of a shareholders’ vote in general meeting. Subject to the Act, any shares may be issued which are to be redeemed or are liable to be redeemed at the option of the company or the shareholders.
There are no provisions in the Articles of Association which discriminate against any existing or prospective shareholder as a result of such shareholder owning a substantial number of shares.
Subject to the terms of the shares which have been issued, the Directors may from time to time make calls upon the shareholders in respect of any moneys unpaid on their shares, provided that (subject to the terms of the shares so issued) no call on any share shall be payable at less than fourteen clear days from the last call. The Directors may, if they see fit, receive from any shareholder willing to advance the same, all and any part of the moneys uncalled and unpaid upon any shares held by him.
Changes in capital
The Group may, from time to time by ordinary resolution subject to the Act:
• | consolidate and divide all or any of its share capital into shares of a larger nominal amount than its existing shares; or |
• | sub-divide all of or any of its existing shares into shares of smaller nominal amounts. |
The Group may, from time to time, increase its share capital by allotting new shares in accordance with the prescribed threshold authorized by shareholders at the last annual general meeting and subject to the consents and procedures required by the Act. The Group may also, by special resolution, reduce its share capital.
On 24 February 2022, the Board approved a £350m share buyback programme in order to return capital to shareholders.
Voting rights
Every holder of ordinary shares present in person or by proxy at a meeting of shareholders has one vote on a vote taken by a show of hands. On a poll, every holder of ordinary shares who is present in person or by proxy has one vote for every twenty-five pence of nominal share capital (being one ordinary share) of which he or she
67
is the holder. Voting at any meeting of shareholders is usually on a poll rather than by show of hands. Voting on a poll is more transparent and equitable because it includes the votes of all shareholders, including those cast by proxies, rather than just the votes of those shareholders who attend the meeting. A poll may be also demanded by:
• | the chair of the meeting; |
• | at least three shareholders present in person or by proxy and entitled to vote; |
• | any shareholder or shareholders present in person or by proxy representing not less than one-tenth of the total voting rights of all shareholders having the right to vote at the meeting; or |
• | any shareholder or shareholders present in person or by proxy holding shares conferring a right to vote at the meeting being shares on which the aggregate sum paid up is equal to not less than one-tenth of the total sum paid up on all shares conferring that right. |
Dividends
Holders of ordinary shares are entitled to receive dividends out of Group profits that are available by law for distribution, as the Group may declare by ordinary resolution, subject to the terms of issue thereof. However, no dividends may be declared in excess of an amount recommended by the Board of Directors. The Board may pay interim dividends on the shares of any class as it deems fit. It may invest or otherwise use all dividends left unclaimed for six months after having been declared for its benefit, until claimed. All dividends unclaimed for a period of eight years after having been declared will be forfeited and revert to the Group.
The Directors may, with the sanction of an ordinary resolution of the shareholders, offer any holders of ordinary shares the right to elect to receive ordinary shares credited as fully paid, in whole or in part, instead of cash in respect of such dividend.
The Directors may deduct from any dividend payable to any shareholder all sums of money (if any) presently payable by that shareholder to the Group on account of calls or otherwise in relation to its shares.
Dividends may be paid by such method or combination of methods as the Board, in its absolute discretion, may decide. Different methods of payment may apply to different holders or groups of holders.
Liquidation rights
In the event of the Group’s liquidation, after payment of all liabilities, its remaining assets would be used to repay the holders of ordinary shares the amount they paid for their ordinary shares. Any balance would be divided among the holders of ordinary shares in proportion to the nominal amount of the ordinary shares held by them.
Other provisions of the Articles of Association
Whenever the Group’s capital is divided into different classes of shares, the special rights attached to any class may, unless otherwise provided by the terms of the issue of the shares of that class, be varied or abrogated, either with the written consent of the holders of three-fourths of the issued shares of the class (excluding any issued as treasury shares) or with the sanction of a special resolution passed at a separate meeting of these holders. In the event that a shareholder or other person appearing to the Board of Directors to be interested in ordinary shares fails to comply with a notice requiring him or her to provide information with respect to their interest in voting shares pursuant to section 793 of the Act, the Board may serve that shareholder with a notice of default. After service of a default notice, that shareholder shall not be entitled to attend or vote at any general meeting or at a separate meeting of holders of a class of shares or on a poll until he or she has complied in full with the Group’s information request.
68
If the shares described in the default notice represent at least
one-fourth
of 1% in nominal value of the issued ordinary shares, then the default notice may additionally direct that in respect of those shares:• | the Group will not pay dividends (or issue shares in lieu of dividends); and |
• | the Group will not register transfers of shares unless (i) the shareholder is not himself in default as regards supplying the information requested and the transfer, when presented for registration, is accompanied by a certificate from the shareholder in such form as the Board of Directors may require to the effect that after due and careful inquiry, the shareholder is satisfied that no person in default is interested in any of the ordinary shares which are being transferred; (ii) the transfer is an approved transfer, as defined in the Articles of Association; or (iii) the registration of the transfer is required by the Uncertificated Securities Regulations 2001. |
No provision of the Articles of Association expressly governs the ordinary share ownership threshold above which shareholder ownership must be disclosed. Under the Disclosure Guidance and Transparency Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority, any person who acquires, either alone or, in specified circumstances, with others an interest in the company’s voting share capital equal to or in excess of 3% comes under an obligation to disclose prescribed particulars to the company in respect of those ordinary shares. A disclosure obligation also arises where a person’s notifiable interests fall below 3%, or where, at or above 3%, the percentage of the company’s voting share capital in which a person has a notifiable interest reaches, exceeds or falls below 3%, 4%, 5%, 6%, 7%, 8%, 9%, 10%, and each 1% threshold thereafter up to 100%.
Limitations affecting holders of ordinary shares or ADSs
Under English law and articles of association, persons who are neither UK residents nor UK nationals may freely hold, vote and transfer ordinary shares in the same manner as UK residents or nationals.
With respect to the items discussed above, applicable UK law is not materially different from applicable US
law.
Material contracts
The Group has not entered into any contracts outside the ordinary course of business during the
two-year
period immediately preceding the date of this annual report, other than the Trust Deed entered into in 2020 with respect to £350.0 million aggregate principal amount of 3.750% guaranteed notes due 2030, in each case, issued by a subsidiary and guaranteed by Pearson, which filed as Exhibit 2.6 of this report.Executive employment contracts
The Group has entered into agreements with each of its Executive Directors pursuant to which such Executive Director is employed by the Group. These agreements describe the duties of such Executive Director and the compensation to be paid by us. See “Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees — Compensation of Senior Management”.
It is the Group’s policy that it may terminate the Executive Directors’ service agreements by giving no more than 12 months’ notice. As an alternative, the Group may at its discretion pay in lieu of that notice.of notice may be made in equal monthly installments from the date of termination to the end of any unexpired notice period. In the case of the Chief Executive,of notice in installments may also be subject to mitigation. For Executive Directors, pay in lieu of notice comprises 100% of the annual salary at the date of termination and the annual cost to the company of providing pension and all other benefits. In limited circumstances, in addition to making a full payment in lieu of notice, the Group may permit an Executive Director to stay employed after the announcement of their departure for a limited period to ensure an effective hand-over and/or allow time for a successor to be appointed. The Group may, depending on the circumstances of
Payment-in-lieu
payment-in-lieu
69
the termination, determine that it will not pay the Director in lieu of notice and may instead terminate a Director’s contract in breach and make a damages payment, taking into account as appropriate the Director’s ability to mitigate their loss.
Exchange controls
There are no UK government laws, decrees, regulations or other legislation which restrict or which may affect the import or export of capital, including the availability of cash and cash equivalents for use by us or the remittance of dividends, interest or other payments to nonresident holders of the Group’s securities, except as otherwise described under “— Tax Considerations” below.
Tax considerations
The following is a discussion of the material US federal income tax considerations and UK tax considerations arising from the acquisition, ownership and disposition of ordinary shares and ADSs by a US holder. A US holder is:
• | an individual citizen or resident of the US, or |
• | a corporation created or organized in or under the laws of the US or any of its political subdivisions, or |
• | an estate or trust the income of which is subject to US federal income taxation regardless of its source. |
This discussion deals only with ordinary shares and ADSs that are held as capital assets by a US holder, and does not address tax considerations applicable to US holders that may be subject to special tax rules, such as:
• | dealers or traders in securities or currencies, |
• | financial institutions or other US holders that treat income in respect of the ordinary shares or ADSs as financial services income, |
• | insurance companies, |
• | tax-exempt entities, |
• | persons acquiring shares or ADSs in connection with employment, |
• | US holders that hold the ordinary shares or ADSs as a part of a straddle or conversion transaction or other arrangement involving more than one position, |
• | US holders that own, or are deemed for US tax purposes to own, 10% or more of the total combined voting power of all classes of the Group’s voting stock, |
• | US holders that have a principal place of business or “tax home” outside the United States, or |
• | US holders whose “functional currency” is not the US dollar. |
For US federal income tax purposes, holders of ADSs will be treated as the owners of the ordinary shares represented by those ADSs. In practice, HM Revenue & Customs (HMRC) will also regard holders of ADSs as the beneficial owners of the ordinary shares represented by those ADSs, although case law has cast some doubt on this. The discussion below assumes that HMRC’s position is followed.
In addition, the following discussion assumes that The Bank of New York Mellon will perform its obligations as depositary in accordance with the terms of the depositary agreement and any related agreements.
Because US and UK tax consequences may differ from one holder to the next, the discussion set out below does not purport to describe all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to you and your particular situation. Accordingly, you are advised to consult your own tax advisor as to the US federal, state and local, UK and other,
70
including foreign, tax consequences of investing in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Except where otherwise indicated, the statements of US and UK tax law set out below are based on the laws, interpretations and tax authority practice in force or applicable as of February 28, 2022 and are subject to any changes occurring after that date, possibly with retroactive effect.
UK income taxation of distributions
The UK does not impose dividend withholding tax on dividends paid by the company.
A US holder that is not resident in the UK for UK tax purposes and does not carry on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK through a branch or agency (or in the case of a company a permanent establishment) to which the ordinary shares or ADSs are attributable will not generally be liable to pay UK tax on dividends paid by the company.
US income taxation of distributions
Distributions that the Group makes with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs, other than distributions in liquidation and distributions in redemption of stock that are treated as exchanges, will be taxed to US holders as ordinary dividend income to the extent that the distributions do not exceed the Group’s current and accumulated earnings and profits. The amount of any distribution will equal the amount of the cash distribution. Distributions, if any, in excess of the Group’s current and accumulated earnings and profits will constitute a
non-taxable
return of capital to a US holder and will be applied against and reduce the US holder’s tax basis in its ordinary shares or ADSs. To the extent that these distributions exceed the tax basis of the US holder in its ordinary shares or ADSs, the excess generally will be treated as capital gain.Dividends that the Group pays will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed to US corporations under Section 243 of the Code.
In the case of distributions in pounds sterling, the amount of the distributions generally will equal the US dollar value of the pounds sterling distributed, determined by reference to the spot currency exchange rate on the date of receipt of the distribution by the US holder in the case of shares or by The Bank of New York Mellon in the case of ADSs, regardless of whether the US holder reports income on a cash basis or an accrual basis. The US holder will realize separate foreign currency gain or loss only to the extent that this gain or loss arises on the actual disposition of pounds sterling received. For US holders claiming tax credits on a cash basis, taxes withheld from the distribution are translated into US dollars at the spot rate on the date of the distribution; for US holders claiming tax credits on an accrual basis, taxes withheld from the distribution are translated into US dollars at the average rate for the taxable year.
A distribution by the company to
non-corporate
shareholders will be taxed as net capital gain at a maximum rate of 20%, provided certain holding periods are met, to the extent such distribution is treated as a dividend under US federal income tax principles. In addition, a 3.8% Medicare tax will generally be imposed on the net investment income, which generally would include distributions treated as dividends under US federal income tax principles, ofnon-corporate
taxpayers whose adjusted gross income exceeds a threshold amount.UK taxation of capital gains
A US holder that is not resident in the UK for UK tax purposes and does not carry on a trade, profession or vocation in the UK through a branch or agency (or in the case of a company a permanent establishment) to which the ordinary shares or ADSs are attributable will not generally be liable for UK taxation on capital gains or eligible for relief for allowable losses, realized on the sale or other disposal of the ordinary shares or ADSs.
A US holder who is an individual who has been resident for tax purposes in the UK but who ceases to be so resident or becomes regarded as resident outside the UK for the purposes of any double tax treaty (“Treaty
71
Non-resident”)
and continues to not be resident in the UK, or continues to be TreatyNon-resident,
for a period of five years or less and who disposes of his ordinary shares or ADSs during that period may also be liable on his return to the UK to UK tax on capital gains, subject to any available exemption or relief, even though he is not resident in the UK, or is TreatyNon-resident,
at the time of the disposal.US income taxation of capital gains
Upon a sale or exchange of ordinary shares or ADSs to a person other than Pearson, a US holder will recognize gain or loss in an amount equal to the difference between the amount realized on the sale or exchange and the US holder’s adjusted tax basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs. Any gain or loss recognized will be capital gain or loss and will be long-term capital gain or loss if the US holder has held the ordinary shares or ADSs for more than one year. Long-term capital gain of a
non-corporate
US holder is generally taxed at a maximum rate of 20%. In addition, a 3.8% Medicare tax will generally be imposed on the net investment income, which generally would include capital gains, ofnon-corporate
taxpayers whose adjusted gross income exceeds a threshold amount.Gain or loss realized by a US holder on the sale or exchange of ordinary shares or ADSs generally will be treated as
US-source
gain or loss for US foreign tax credit purposes.Estate and gift tax
The current Estate and Gift Tax Convention (referred to in this paragraph as the “Convention”), between the US and the UK generally relieves from UK inheritance tax (the equivalent of US estate and gift tax) the transfer of ordinary shares or of ADSs where the transferor is domiciled in the US for the purposes of the Convention. This relief will not apply if the ordinary shares or ADSs are part of the business property of an individual’s permanent establishment in the UK or pertain to the fixed base in the UK of a person providing independent personal services. If no relief is given under the Convention, inheritance tax may be charged on death and also on the amount by which the value of an individual’s estate is reduced as a result of any transfer made by way of gift or other gratuitous or undervalue transfer, in general within seven years of death, and in certain other circumstances. In the unusual case where ordinary shares or ADSs are subject to both UK inheritance tax and US estate or gift tax, the Convention generally provides for tax paid in the UK to be credited against tax payable in the US or for tax paid in the US to be credited against tax payable in the UK based on priority rules set forth in the Convention.
Stamp duty
No stamp duty or stamp duty reserve tax (SDRT) will generally be payable in the UK on the purchase or transfer of an ADS, provided that the ADS, and any separate instrument or written agreement of transfer, remain at all times outside the UK and that the instrument or written agreement of transfer is not executed in the UK. Subject to the following paragraph, UK legislation does however provide for SDRT or (in the case of transfers) stamp duty to be chargeable at the rate of 1.5% of the amount or value of the consideration or, in some circumstances, the value of the ordinary shares (rounded up to the next multiple of £5 in the case of stamp duty), where ordinary shares are issued or transferred to a person whose business is or includes issuing depositary receipts, or to a nominee or agent for such a person, or issued or transferred to a person whose business is or includes the provision of clearance services or to a nominee or agent for such a person.
Following certain EU litigation, HM Revenue & Customs (HMRC) accepted that it would no longer seek to apply the 1.5% SDRT charge when new shares are issued to a clearance service or depositary receipt system (or transferred into a clearance service or depositary receipt system, where such transfer is integral to the raising of capital by the company concerned) on the basis that the charge was not compatible with EU law. Following the UK’s departure from the EU, such
pre-existing
EU law rights, recognized in litigation, were preserved as a domestic law matter following the end of the implementation period on December 31, 2020 pursuant to72
provisions of the UK European Union (Withdrawal) Act 2018. HMRC’s view is that the 1.5% SDRT or stamp duty charge will continue to apply to transfers of shares into a clearance service or depositary receipt system, unless they are an integral part of an issue of share capital. Accordingly, specific professional advice should be sought before paying the 1.5% SDRT or stamp duty charge in any circumstances.
A transfer for value of the underlying ordinary shares will generally be subject to either stamp duty or SDRT, normally at the rate of 0.5% of the amount or value of the consideration (rounded up to the next multiple of £5 in the case of stamp duty). A transfer of ordinary shares from a nominee to its beneficial owner, including the transfer of underlying ordinary shares from the Depositary to an ADS holder, under which no beneficial interest passes will not be subject to stamp duty or SDRT.
Close company status
The Group believes that the close company provisions of the UK Corporation Tax Act 2010 do not apply to it.
Documents on display
Copies of the Group’s Memorandum and Articles of Association are filed as exhibits to this Annual Report. We also file reports and other information with the SEC. These materials, including this Annual Report and the accompanying exhibits are available on the Investors page of the company’s website (pearsonplc.com). In addition, shareholders may visit the Governance section of our website or request a copy of certain documents referred to in this Annual Report by writing to us at the following address: Pearson plc, c/o the Company Secretary, 80 Strand, London WC2R 0RL.
ITEM 11. | QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK |
Introduction
Pearson’s treasury policies set out the group’s principles for addressing key financial risks including capital risk, liquidity risk, foreign exchange risk and interest rate risk and sets out measurable targets for each. The Audit Committee receive quarterly reports incorporating compliance with these measurable targets and review and approve the treasury policies annually.
The treasury function is permitted to use derivatives where their use reduces a risk or allows a transaction to be undertaken more cost effectively. Derivatives permitted include swaps, forwards and collars to manage foreign exchange and interest rate risk, with foreign exchange swap and forward contracts the most commonly executed. Speculative transactions are not permitted.
Capital risk
The Group’s objectives when managing capital are:
• | To maintain a strong balance sheet and a solid investment grade credit rating; |
• | To continue to invest in the business organically and through acquisitions; and |
• | To have a sustainable and progressive dividend policy. |
In September 2021, Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC withdrew its ratings at the request of the Group. Fitch Ratings Limited assigned a first-time Long-Term Issuer Default Rating (“IDR”) of
‘BBB-’
(stable outlook) to the Group. The Group’s bonds are rated Baa3 (stable outlook) andBBB-
(stable outlook) by Moody’s Investors Service and Fitch Ratings Limited respectively.73
Interest and foreign exchange rate management
The Group’s principal currency exposure is to the US dollar (USD) which represents 64% of the Group’s sales. A portion of the Group’s debt is held in US dollars to provide a natural hedge of this exposure.
Pearson achieves this mix in one of three ways:
• | Issuing fixed rate debt in USD; |
• | Issuing fixed debt in euro and swapping it to British Pounds Sterling (GBP) either at fixed or floating rates and swapping an element to USD either using cross currency swaps or foreign exchange swaps; |
• | Borrowing in USD at floating rates on the Group’s bank facility. |
At December 31, 2021, the Group had swap contracts and fixed rate bonds to fix the interest rate on $1,090m compared to $1,554m in 2020 of total fixed debt, excluding leases.
Liquidity and
re-financing
risk managementThe Group regularly reviews the level of cash and debt facilities required to fund its activities. This involves preparing a prudent cash flow forecast for the next three to five years, determining the level of debt facilities required to fund the business, planning for repayments of debt at its maturity and identifying an appropriate amount of headroom to provide a reserve against unexpected outflows.
At December 31, 2021, the Group had cash of £0.9 billion and Pearson’s $1.19bn (£0.9m) US dollar denominated revolving credit facility due 2025 was undrawn.
At December 31, 2020, the Group had cash of £1.1 billion and Pearson’s $1.19bn (£0.9m) US dollar denominated revolving credit facility due 2024 was undrawn.
The $1.19 billion facility contains interest cover and leverage covenants which the Group has complied with for both the years ended December 31, 2020 and December 31, 2021.
In February 2022, the Group renegotiated its revolving credit facility, extending the maturity of $1bn of the facility by one year to 2026.
Financial counterparty risk management
Counterparty credit limits, which take published credit rating and other factors into account, are set to cover the Group’s total aggregate exposure to a single financial institution. The limits applicable to published credit ratings bands are approved by the chief financial officer within guidelines approved by the board. Exposures and limits applicable to each financial institution are reviewed on a regular basis.
ITEM 12. | DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES |
AMERICAN DEPOSITARY SHARES
Fees paid by ADR holders
The Group’s ordinary shares trade in the United States under a sponsored ADR facility with The Bank of New York Mellon as depositary.
The depositary collects its fees for delivery and surrender of ADSs directly from investors depositing shares or surrendering ADSs for the purpose of withdrawal, or from intermediaries acting for them. The depositary collects fees for making distributions to investors by deducting those fees from the amounts distributed or by
74
selling a portion of distributable property to pay the fees. The depositary may collect its annual fee for depositary services by deductions from cash distributions or by directly billing investors or by charging the book-entry system accounts of participants acting for them. The depositary may generally refuse to provide
fee-attracting
services until its fees for those services are paid.The following table summarizes various fees currently charged by The Bank of New York Mellon:
Person depositing or withdrawing shares must pay to the depositary: | For: | |
$ 5.00 (or less) per 100 ADSs (or portion of 100 ADSs) | • Issuance of ADSs, including issuances resulting from a distribution of shares or rights or other property • cancelation of ADSs for the purpose of withdrawal, including if the deposit agreement terminates | |
$ .05 (or less) per ADS | • Any cash distribution to ADS registered holders | |
A fee equivalent to the fee that would be payable if securities distributed had been shares and the shares had been deposited for issuance of ADSs | • Distribution of securities by the depositary to ADS registered holders of deposited securities | |
$.05 (or less) per ADS per calendar year | • Depositary services | |
Registration of transfer fees | • Transfer and registration of shares on the share register to or from the name of the depositary or its agent when shares are deposited or withdrawn | |
Expenses of the depositary | • Cable, telex and facsimile transmissions (when expressly provided in the deposit agreement) • Converting foreign currency to US dollars | |
Taxes and other governmental charges the depositary or the custodian have to pay on any ADS or share underlying an ADS, for example, stock transfer taxes, stamp duty or withholding taxes | • As necessary | |
Any charges incurred by the depositary or its agents for servicing the deposited securities | • As necessary |
Fees incurred in past annual period and fees to be paid in the future
The Depositary reimburses the company for certain expenses it incurs in relation to the ADS program. The Depositary also pays the standardmaintenance costs for the registered ADSs, which consist of the expenses for the mailing and printing of proxy materials, distributing dividend checks, electronic filing of US federal tax information, mailing required tax forms, stationery, postage, facsimile and telephone calls. It also reimburses the company for certain investor relationship programs or special investor relations promotional activities. There are limits on the amount of expenses for which the Depositary will reimburse the company, but the amount of reimbursement is not necessarily tied to the amount of fees the Depositary collects from investors. The company is expecting to receive $50,000 as reimbursement from the depositary with respect to 2021.
out-of-pocket
75
PART II
ITEM 13. | DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES |
None.
ITEM 14. | MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS |
None.
ITEM 15. | CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES |
Disclosure controls and procedures
An evaluation of the effectiveness the Group’s disclosure controls and procedures as of December 31, 2021 was carried out by management, under the supervision and with the participation of the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer. Based on that evaluation, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that the Company’s disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a- 15(e) and
15d-15(e)
under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended) were effective as at December 31, 2021 at a reasonable assurance level. A controls system, no matter how well designed and operated, cannot provide absolute assurance to achieve its objectives.Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting
Management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting for the Company. Internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the Company’s board of directors, management and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. Management has assessed the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021 based on the framework in(2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (“COSO”). Based on this evaluation, management has concluded that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting was effective as of December 31, 2021 based on criteria in(2013) issued by the COSO.
Internal Control — Integrated Framework
Internal Control — Integrated Framework
PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, has audited the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2021, as stated in their report which appears on page
F-2.
Change in internal control over financial reporting
During the period covered by this Annual Report on Form
20-F,
the Group went though an organizational restructure, and in some cases, this impacted the control environment. Other than this, there have been no significant changes in our internal control over financial reporting during the year ended December 31, 2021 that have materially affected, or are reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.ITEM 16A. | AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT |
The members of the Board of Directors of Pearson plc have determined that Tim Score is an audit committee financial expert within the meaning of the applicable rules and regulations of the SEC.
76
ITEM 16B. | CODE OF ETHICS |
Pearson has adopted a code of ethics (the Pearson code of conduct) which applies to all employees including the chief executive officer and chief financial officer and other senior financial management. This code of ethics is available on the Group’s website. The information on this website is not incorporated by reference into this report.
(www.pearson.com/corporate/code-of-conduct.html)
ITEM 16C. | PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES |
In line with best practice, the Group’s relationship with PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (PwC) is governed by its external auditor policy, which is reviewed and approved annually by the audit committee. The policy establishes procedures to ensure the auditors’ independence is not compromised as well as defining those
non-audit
services that PwC may or may not provide to Pearson. These allowable services are in accordance with relevant UK and US legislation.The audit committee approves all audit and
non-audit
services provided by PwC. Where appropriate, services will be tendered prior to awarding this work to the auditor.The following table sets forth remuneration paid to PwC for 2021 and 2020:
Auditors’ Remuneration | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
£m | £m | |||||||
Audit fees | 7 | 7 | ||||||
Tax fees | — | — | ||||||
Audit-related fees | — | — | ||||||
All other fees | — | — |
Audit fees include £35,500 (2020: £35,000) of audit fees relating to the audit of the parent company.
Fees for the audit of the effectiveness of the Group’s internal control over financial reporting are allocated to audit fees paid.
Included in audit related fees is audit related work in relation to disposal transactions and other assurance work related to the audit of the Group’s efficacy program.
ITEM 16D. | EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES |
Not applicable.
ITEM 16E. | PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASES |
Period | Total number of shares purchased | Average price paid per share | Total number of units purchased as part of publicly announced plans or programs | Approximate maximum value of shares that may yet be purchased under the plans or programs | ||||||||||||
February 1, 2019 – February 28, 2019 | 1,500,000 | £ | 8.97 | n/a | n/a | |||||||||||
March 1, 2019 – March 31, 2019 | 3,000,000 | £ | 8.74 | n/a | n/a | |||||||||||
October 1, 2019 – October 31, 2019 | 1,600,000 | £ | 7.39 | n/a | n/a | |||||||||||
January 1, 2020 – January 31, 2020 | 6,680,158 | £ | 5.80 | 6,680,158 | £ | 310m | ||||||||||
February 1, 2020 – February 29, 2020 | 9,958,033 | £ | 5.72 | 9,958,033 | £ | 253m | ||||||||||
March 1, 2020 – March 31, 2020 | 13,239,085 | £ | 5.28 | 13,239,085 | n/a | |||||||||||
July 1, 2020 – July 31, 2020 | 1,105,402 | £ | 5.30 | n/a | n/a | |||||||||||
March 1, 2021 – March 31, 2021 | 795,784 | £ | 8.17 | n/a | n/a | |||||||||||
September 1, 2021 – September 30, 2021 | 1,355,110 | £ | 7.38 | n/a | n/a |
77
All purchases were made in open-market transactions.
Purchases of shares in 2020 and 2021 were made to satisfy obligations under Pearson employee share award programs. None of the foregoing share purchases was made as part of a publicly announced plan or program.
On 24 February 2022, the Board approved a £350m share buyback programme in order to return capital to shareholders. The programme is expected to commence in 2022. The shares bought back will be cancelled and the nominal value of the shares will be transferred to the capital redemption reserve. In 2020, approximately 30m shares were bought back and cancelled at a cost of £176m. The nominal value of these shares, £7m was transferred to the capital redemption reserve.
ITEM 16F. | CHANGE IN REGISTRANT ’ S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT |
The Board of Directors is responsible for proposing the external auditor for election by the shareholders, on recommendation from the Audit Committee of the Board of Directors. Under applicable auditor rotation rules, Pearson must change auditors from its current auditor, PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP (PwC), no later than for the financial year 2024. In March 2021, Pearson initiated a tendering process, overseen by the Audit Committee, for appointment of Pearson plc’s auditor for the financial year 2022. PwC was not invited to tender given their tenure. Following a detailed review of the performance of each firm during the tender process, the Steering Committee, led by members of the Audit Committee, recommended Ernst & Young LLP (EY) as the preferred candidate. In accordance with statutory requirements, a report on the tender selection procedure and conclusions was prepared and validated by the Audit Committee. On June 9, 2021, the Audit Committee and subsequently the Board approved the recommendation to appoint EY and to dismiss PwC at the 2022 AGM following completion by PwC of its procedures on the financial statements of Pearson plc as of and for the year ended December 31, 2021 and the filing of the related Form
20-F.
On June 9, 2021, the Company announced the Board’s intention to propose to shareholders at the 2022 AGM that EY be appointed as the Company’s statutory auditor for the financial year ending 31 December 2022.The reports of PwC on the financial statements for the fiscal years ended December 31, 2021 and 2020 contained no adverse opinion or disclaimer of opinion and were not qualified or modified as to uncertainty, audit scope or accounting principle.
During the fiscal years ended December 31, 2020 and 2019 and the subsequent period through to 30 March 2022 there have been no disagreements with PwC on any matter of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure or auditing scope or procedure, which disagreements if not resolved to the satisfaction of PwC would have caused them to make reference thereto in their reports on the financial statements for such years.
Pearson has requested that PwC furnish it with a letter addressed to the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission stating whether or not it agrees with the above statements. A copy of PwC’s letter dated 30 March 2022, is filed as Exhibit 15.2 to this Form
20-F.
ITEM 16G. | CORPORATE GOVERNANCE |
Pearson is listed on the New York Stock Exchange (“NYSE”). As a listed
non-US
issuer, the Group is required to comply with some of the NYSE’s corporate governance rules, and otherwise must disclose on its website any significant ways in which its corporate governance practices differ from those followed by US companies under the NYSE listing standards. At this time, the Company believes that it is in compliance in all material respects with all the NYSE rules except that the Remuneration Committee and the Nomination & Governance Committee are not composed entirely of independent directors as the Chair, who is not considered independent under NYSE rules, is a member of each committee in addition to independent directors.78
ITEM 16H. | MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE |
Not applicable.
ITEM 16I. | DISCLOSURE REGARDING FOREIGN JURISDICTIONS THAT PREVENT INSPECTIONS |
Not applicable.
79
PART III
ITEM 17. | FINANCIAL STATEMENTS |
Not applicable.
ITEM 18. | FINANCIAL STATEMENTS |
The financial statements filed as part of this Annual Report are included on pages F1 through F90 hereof.
ITEM 19. EXHIBITS
j | Incorporated by reference from the Form 20-F of Pearson plc for the year ended December 31, 2012 and filed March 22, 2013 |
q | Incorporated by reference from the Form 20-F of Pearson plc for the year ended December 31, 2013 and filed March 27, 2014. |
80
∞ | Incorporated by reference from the Form 20-F of Pearson plc for the year ended December 31, 2014 and filed March 26, 2015. |
l | Incorporated by reference from the Form 20-F of Pearson plc for the year ended December 31, 2015 and filed March 23, 2016. |
ß | Incorporated by reference from the Form 20-F of Pearson plc for the year ended December 31, 2019 and filed April 1, 2020. |
h | Incorporated by reference from the Form 20-F of Pearson plc for the year ended December 31, 2020 and filed April 1, 2021. |
81
FINANCIAL STATEMENTS: CONTENTS
F-2 | ||||
F-7 | ||||
F-8 | ||||
F-9 | ||||
F-11 | ||||
F-13 | ||||
F-14 |
F-1
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of Pearson plc
Opinions on the Financial Statements and Internal Control over Financial Reporting
We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of Pearson plc and its subsidiaries (the “Group”) as of 31 December 2021 and 2020 and the related consolidated income statements, consolidated statements of comprehensive income, consolidated statements of changes in equity and consolidated cash flow statements for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2021, including the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). We also have audited the Group’s internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2021, based on criteria established in
Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Group as of 31 December 2021 and 2020 and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2021 in accordance with (i) International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board and
(ii) UK-adopted
International Accounting Standards. Also in our opinion, the Group maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of 31 December 2021 based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework (2013) issued by the COSO.Change in Accounting Principle
As discussed in note 1a to the consolidated financial statements, the Group changed the manner in which it accounted for leases in 2019 due to the adoption of IFRS 16.
Basis for Opinions
The Group’s management is responsible for these consolidated financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting included in “Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting” appearing under Item 15. Our responsibility is to express opinions on the Group’s consolidated financial statements and on the Group’s internal control over financial reporting based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Group in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.
We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the consolidated financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud, and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects.
Our audits of the consolidated financial statements included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the consolidated financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the consolidated financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the consolidated financial statements. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.
F-2
Definition and Limitations of Internal Control over Financial Reporting
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
Critical Audit Matters
The critical audit matters communicated below are matters arising from the current period audit of the consolidated financial statements that were communicated or required to be communicated to the audit committee and that (i) relate to accounts or disclosures that are material to the
consolidated financial statements and (ii) involved our especially challenging, subjective or complex judgments. The communication of critical audit matters does not alter in any way our opinion on the consolidated
financial statements, taken as a whole, and we are not, by communicating the critical audit matters below, providing separate opinions on the critical audit matters or on the accounts or disclosures to which they relate.
Carrying value of goodwill
As described in note 11 to the consolidated financial statements, the Group’s goodwill balance was £2,145 million as of 31 December 2021. Goodwill has been allocated to cash generating units (CGUs) or to an aggregation of CGUs where goodwill could not be reasonably allocated to individual CGUs. CGUs have been revised in 2021 as a result of organisational changes following the announcement of the Group’s new strategy in March 2021 which has triggered a change in the level at which certain businesses are reported and monitored. The newly created CGUs (and aggregated CGU) reflect the level at which goodwill is monitored by management. As a result, goodwill has been reallocated to the new CGUs (or aggregated CGUs). The majority of the goodwill balances have been directly mapped from one previous CGU (or aggregated CGU) to one newly created CGU (or aggregated CGU). Where it was not possible to directly map goodwill, it has been reallocated using a relative value method. Goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment. The recoverable amount of each CGU (or aggregated CGU) is based on the higher of value in use and fair value less costs of disposal. Management’s impairment assessment is based on the value in use of each CGU (or aggregated CGU). For the purpose of estimating value in use, management has used an income approach based on present value techniques. These calculations require the exercise of management judgment in respect of the use of estimates for discount rates, perpetuity growth rates, forecast sales growth rates and operating profit forecasts.
The principal considerations for our determination that performing procedures relating to the carrying value of goodwill is a critical audit matter are the judgments and estimates made by management in identifying the revised CGUs (or aggregated CGUs), in reallocating goodwill to the CGUs (or aggregated CGUs) and in determining the recoverable amount of the CGUs (or aggregated CGUs). This in turn led to a high degree of auditor judgment, subjectivity and effort in performing procedures to evaluate management’s CGU (or aggregated CGU) assessment and goodwill reallocation, the present value techniques used to calculate the value
F-3
in use and the significant assumptions related to discount rates, perpetuity growth rates, forecast sales growth rates and operating profit forecasts. In addition, the audit effort involved the use of professionals with specialized skill and knowledge.
Addressing the matter involved performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence in connection with forming our overall opinion on the consolidated financial statements. These procedures included testing the effectiveness of controls relating to management’s impairment assessment of the carrying value of goodwill. These procedures also included, among others:
— | testing management’s CGU reassessment and the related reallocation of goodwill, including evaluating the relative value methodology applied by management to reallocate goodwill, testing the mathematical accuracy of the allocation exercise and assessing whether goodwill is monitored or measured at a level lower than management’s revised CGUs (or aggregated CGUs); |
— | testing the mathematical integrity of management’s value in use impairment model; |
— | comparing the carrying amounts of net assets subject to impairment testing to the underlying accounting records; |
— | comparing the forecast cash flows (which include forecast sales and operating profit) to board approved budgets and strategic plans and assessing how these budgets and strategic plans are compiled, including an assessment of the historical accuracy of management’s budgeting and forecasting compared to actual results; |
— | evaluating management’s related judgments and estimates, including forecast sales growth rates and operating profit projections; |
— | comparing management’s forecasts and key assumptions to industry projections and to comparable companies where this information was available for specific CGUs (or aggregated CGUs); |
— | using professionals with specialized skill and knowledge to assist in evaluating the appropriateness of the perpetuity growth rate and discount rate for each CGU (or aggregated CGU); and |
— | comparing management’s value in use valuations (i) for businesses under strategic review with initial third party bids received after year-end less estimated disposal costs and (ii) for the remaining CGUs with valuations implied by trading and transaction multiples of the Group’s competitors where this information was available. |
Carrying value ofassets related to land and buildings
right-of-use
As described in note 10 to the consolidated financial statements, the Group’sasset balance related to land and buildings was £196 million as of 31 December 2021. As part of a major restructuring programme, the Group simplified its property portfolio in 2021, reducing the overall office space required. The Group recognised an impairment of £119 million against its land and buildings classified as right-of-use assets. The recoverability of certain of the Group’sassets is now based on the Group’s ability to sublease vacant space. This involves the use of assumptions related to future subleases including the achievable rent, lease start dates, lease incentives such as rent free periods and the discount rates applied.
right-of-use
right-of-use
The principal considerations for our determination that performing procedures relating to carrying value ofassets related to land and buildings is a critical audit matter are the judgments and estimates made by management in determining the recoverable amount of each property. This in turn led to a high degree of
right-of-use
F-4
auditor judgment, subjectivity and effort in evaluating audit evidence and in determining the reasonableness of the estimates and assumptions related to future subleases. In addition, the audit effort involved the use of professionals with specialized skill and knowledge.
Addressing the matter involved performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence in connection with forming our overall opinion on the consolidated financial statements. These procedures included testing the effectiveness of controls relating to management’s impairment assessment of the carrying value ofassets related to land and buildings. These procedures also included, among others:
right-of-use
— | assessing management’s right-of-use |
— | testing the mathematical accuracy of management’s right-of-use |
— | comparing the carrying amounts of the net assets subject to impairment assessment to the underlying accounting records; |
— | evaluating management’s related judgments and estimates, including the amount of achievable rent, lease start dates and lease incentives such as rent free periods; |
— | using professionals with specialized skill and knowledge to assist in evaluating the appropriateness of the assumptions used by management, including the discount rates applied; and |
— | evaluating management’s impairment trigger assessment for the Group’s remaining property portfolio not subject to impairment in 2021. |
Assessment & Qualifications assessments revenue recognition for US Student Assessment
As described in note 3 of the consolidated financial statements, £973 million of the Group’s Assessment & Qualification assessments revenue for the year ended 31 December 2021 was derived from products and services transferred over time. Revenue is recognised for these contracts over time as the customer is benefiting as performance takes place through a continuous transfer of control to the customer. As control transfers over time, revenue is recognised based on the extent of progress towards completion of the performance obligation. The selection of the method to measure progress towards completion requires judgment and is based on the nature of the services provided. Revenue is recognised on a percentage of cost basis, calculated using the proportion of the total costs incurred to date. From 2021, the proportion of estimated costs incurred to date is primarily based on historical cost analysis for similar groups of contracts, with regular
true-ups
to contract costs throughout the contract period. Previously, the proportion of costs incurred to date was based on individual contract analysis. The change in input methodology has not resulted in a material impact on revenue recognition.The principal considerations for our determination that performing procedures relating to Assessment & Qualifications assessments revenue recognition for US Student Assessment is a critical audit matter are the high degree of auditor judgment, subjectivity and effort in evaluating audit evidence in assessing the impact of the change in method to measure progress towards completion.
Addressing the matter involved performing procedures and evaluating audit evidence in connection with forming our overall opinion on the consolidated financial statements. These procedures included testing the effectiveness of controls relating to management’s analysis of progress towards completion. These procedures also included, among others:
— | understanding and evaluating management’s rationale for changing methodology for new contracts in 2021; |
F-5
— | evaluating how similar groups of contracts have been identified; |
— | testing management’s historical cost profile calculations by contract grouping; |
— | testing management’s assessment of the difference between the previous approach of determining percentage of completion by individual contract analysis and the grouping of similar contracts applied to new contracts in 2021; |
— | assessing the appropriateness of a contract grouping approach under IFRS 15; |
— | testing costs incurred to date and management’s estimates of forecast costs and revenues by reference to historical experience and current contract status; |
— | recalculating management’s percentage of cost estimates; and |
— | performing look-back tests to assess management’s historical accuracy of forecasting for contract costs. |
/s/PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
London, United Kingdom
30 March 2022
We have served as the Group’s auditor since 1996.
F-6
Consolidated income statement
Year ended 31 December
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Continuing operations | ||||||||||||||||
Sales | 2,3 | 3,428 | 3,397 | 3,869 | ||||||||||||
Cost of goods sold | 4 | (1,747 | ) | (1,767 | ) | (1,858 | ) | |||||||||
Gross profit | 1,681 | 1,630 | 2,011 | |||||||||||||
Operating expenses | 4 | (1,562 | ) | (1,402 | ) | (1,806 | ) | |||||||||
Other net gains and losses | 4 | 63 | 178 | 16 | ||||||||||||
Share of results of joint ventures and associates | 12 | 1 | 5 | 54 | ||||||||||||
Operating profit | 2 | 183 | 411 | 275 | ||||||||||||
Finance costs | 6 | (68 | ) | (107 | ) | (84 | ) | |||||||||
Finance income | 6 | 42 | 50 | 41 | ||||||||||||
Profit before tax | 157 | 354 | 232 | |||||||||||||
Income tax | 7 | 3 | (44 | ) | 34 | |||||||||||
Profit for the year | 160 | 310 | 266 | |||||||||||||
Attributable to: | ||||||||||||||||
Equity holders of the company | 159 | 310 | 264 | |||||||||||||
Non-controlling interest | 1 | — | 2 | |||||||||||||
Earnings per share attributable to equity holders of the company during the year | ||||||||||||||||
– basic | 8 | 21.1p | 41.0p | 34.0p | ||||||||||||
– diluted | 8 | 20.9p | 41.0p | 34.0p | ||||||||||||
F-
7
Consolidated statement of comprehensive income
Year ended 31 December
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Profit for the year | 160 | 310 | 266 | |||||||||||||
Items that may be reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations – Group | (6 | ) | (109 | ) | (113 | ) | ||||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations – associates | — | — | (2 | ) | ||||||||||||
Currency translation adjustment disposed | 4 | (70 | ) | 4 | ||||||||||||
Attributable tax | 7 | 10 | (13 | ) | 5 | |||||||||||
Items that are not reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||
Fair value gain on other financial assets | 24 | 14 | 20 | |||||||||||||
Attributable tax | 7 | (3 | ) | (6 | ) | (4 | ) | |||||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations – Group | 25 | 149 | (23 | ) | (145 | ) | ||||||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations – associates | — | — | (4 | ) | ||||||||||||
Attributable tax | 7 | (61 | ) | 2 | 22 | |||||||||||
Other comprehensive income/(expense) for the year | 29 | 117 | (205 | ) | (217 | ) | ||||||||||
Total comprehensive income for the year | 277 | 105 | 49 | |||||||||||||
Attributable to: | ||||||||||||||||
Equity holders of the company | 276 | 105 | 47 | |||||||||||||
Non-controlling interest | 1 | — | 2 | |||||||||||||
F-
8
Consolidated balance sheet
As at 31 December
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | |||||||||
Assets | ||||||||||||
Non-current assets | ||||||||||||
Property, plant and equipment | 10 | 366 | 515 | |||||||||
Intangible assets | 11 | 2,769 | 2,742 | |||||||||
Investments in joint ventures and associates | 12 | 24 | 6 | |||||||||
Deferred income tax assets | 13 | 57 | 32 | |||||||||
Financial assets – derivative financial instruments | 16 | 30 | 45 | |||||||||
Retirement benefit assets | 25 | 537 | 410 | |||||||||
Other financial assets | 15 | 113 | 138 | |||||||||
Income tax assets | 97 | — | ||||||||||
Trade and other receivables | 22 | 129 | 223 | |||||||||
4,122 | 4,111 | |||||||||||
Current assets | ||||||||||||
Intangible assets – product development | 20 | 894 | 905 | |||||||||
Inventories | 21 | 98 | 129 | |||||||||
Trade and other receivables | 22 | 1,257 | 1,118 | |||||||||
Financial assets – derivative financial instruments | 16 | 2 | 18 | |||||||||
Income tax assets | 26 | — | ||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents (excluding overdrafts) | 17 | 937 | 1,097 | |||||||||
3,214 | 3,267 | |||||||||||
Assets classified as held for sale | 32 | 7 | 73 | |||||||||
Total assets | 7,343 | 7,451 | ||||||||||
Liabilities | ||||||||||||
Non-current liabilities | ||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | 18 | (1,245 | ) | (1,397 | ) | |||||||
Financial liabilities – derivative financial instruments | 16 | (30 | ) | (40 | ) | |||||||
Deferred income tax liabilities | 13 | (40 | ) | (62 | ) | |||||||
Retirement benefit obligations | 25 | (66 | ) | (85 | ) | |||||||
Provisions for other liabilities and charges | 23 | (7 | ) | (8 | ) | |||||||
Other liabilities | 24 | (95 | ) | (80 | ) | |||||||
(1,483 | ) | (1,672 | ) | |||||||||
F-
9
Consolidated balance sheet continued
As at 31 December
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | |||||||||
Current liabilities | ||||||||||||
Trade and other liabilities | 24 | (1,256 | ) | (1,196 | ) | |||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | 18 | (155 | ) | (254 | ) | |||||||
Financial liabilities – derivative financial instruments | 16 | (4 | ) | (12 | ) | |||||||
Income tax liabilities | (125 | ) | (84 | ) | ||||||||
Provisions for other liabilities and charges | 23 | (40 | ) | (25 | ) | |||||||
(1,580 | ) | (1,571 | ) | |||||||||
Liabilities classified as held for sale | 32 | 0 | (74 | ) | ||||||||
Total liabilities | (3,063 | ) | (3,317 | ) | ||||||||
Net assets | 4,280 | 4,134 | ||||||||||
Equity | ||||||||||||
Share capital | 27 | 189 | 188 | |||||||||
Share premium | 27 | 2,626 | 2,620 | |||||||||
Treasury shares | 28 | (12 | ) | (7 | ) | |||||||
Capital redemption reserve | 18 | 18 | ||||||||||
Fair value reserve | 33 | 53 | ||||||||||
Translation reserve | 386 | 388 | ||||||||||
Retained earnings | 1,030 | 865 | ||||||||||
Total equity attributable to equity holders of the company | 4,270 | 4,125 | ||||||||||
Non-controlling interest | 10 | 9 | ||||||||||
Total equity | 4,280 | 4,134 | ||||||||||
These financial statements have been approved for issue by the Board of Directors on March 30, 2022 and signed on its behalf by
Sally Johnson
Chief Financial Officer
Pearson plc
Registered number: 00053723
F-
10
Consolidated statement of changes in equity
Year ended 31 December
Equity attributable to equity holders of the company | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Share capital | Share premium | Treasury shares | Capital redemption reserve | Fair value reserve | Translation reserve | Retained earnings | Total | Non- controlling interest | Total equity | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2021 | 188 | 2,620 | (7 | ) | 18 | 53 | 388 | 865 | 4,125 | 9 | 4,134 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the year | — | — | — | — | — | — | 159 | 159 | 1 | 160 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other comprehensive income/(expense) | — | — | — | — | 24 | (2 | ) | 95 | 117 | — | 117 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total comprehensive income/(expense) | — | — | — | — | 24 | (2 | ) | 254 | 276 | 1 | 277 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Equity-settled transactions | — | — | — | — | — | — | 28 | 28 | — | 28 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Issue of ordinary shares under share option schemes | 1 | 6 | (1 | ) | — | — | — | — | 6 | — | 6 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Buyback of equity | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Purchase of treasury shares | — | — | (16 | ) | — | — | — | — | (16 | ) | — | (16 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Release of treasury shares | — | — | 12 | — | — | — | (12 | ) | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Transfer of gain on disposal of FVOCI investment | — | — | — | — | (44 | ) | — | 44 | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends | — | — | — | — | — | — | (149 | ) | (149 | ) | — | (149 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 189 | 2,626 | (12 | ) | 18 | 33 | 386 | 1,030 | 4,270 | 10 | 4,280 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Equity attributable to equity holders of the company | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Share capital | Share premium | Treasury shares | Capital redemption reserve | Fair value reserve | Translation reserve | Retained earnings | Total | Non- controlling interest | Total equity | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 195 | 2,614 | (24 | ) | 11 | 39 | 567 | 911 | 4,313 | 10 | 4,323 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the year | — | — | — | — | — | — | 310 | 310 | — | 310 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other comprehensive income/(expense) | — | — | — | — | 14 | (179 | ) | (40 | ) | (205 | ) | — | (205 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total comprehensive income/(expense) | — | — | — | — | 14 | (179 | ) | 270 | 105 | — | 105 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Equity-settled transactions | — | — | — | — | — | — | 29 | 29 | — | 29 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Issue of ordinary shares under share option schemes | — | 6 | — | — | — | — | — | 6 | — | 6 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Buyback of equity | (7 | ) | — | — | 7 | — | — | (176 | ) | (176 | ) | — | (176 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Purchase of treasury shares | — | — | (6 | ) | — | — | — | — | (6 | ) | — | (6 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Release of treasury shares | — | — | 23 | — | — | — | (23 | ) | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends | — | — | — | — | — | — | (146 | ) | (146 | ) | (1 | ) | (147 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 188 | 2,620 | (7 | ) | 18 | 53 | 388 | 865 | 4,125 | 9 | 4,134 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
F-
11
Consolidated statement of changes in equity
Year ended 31 December
Equity attributable to equity holders of the company | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures In £ millions | Share capital | Share premium | Treasury shares | Capital redemption reserve | Fair value reserve | Translation reserve | Retained earnings | Total | Non- controlling interest | Total equity | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2019 | 195 | 2,607 | (33 | ) | 11 | 19 | 678 | 1,039 | 4,516 | 9 | 4,525 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjustment on initial application of IFRS 16 net of tax (see note 1b) | — | — | — | — | — | — | (83 | ) | (83 | ) | — | (83 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjustment on initial application of IFRIC 23 net of tax (see note 1c) | — | — | — | — | — | — | 5 | 5 | — | 5 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2019 (restated) | 195 | 2,607 | (33 | ) | 11 | 19 | 678 | 961 | 4,438 | 9 | 4,447 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the year | — | — | — | — | — | — | 264 | 264 | 2 | 266 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other comprehensive income/(expense) | — | — | — | — | 20 | (111 | ) | (126 | ) | (217 | ) | — | (217 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total comprehensive income/ (expense) | — | — | — | — | 20 | (111 | ) | 138 | 47 | 2 | 49 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Equity-settled transactions | — | — | — | — | — | — | 25 | 25 | 0 | 25 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Tax on equity-settled transactions | — | — | — | — | — | — | (5 | ) | (5 | ) | — | (5 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Issue of ordinary shares under share option schemes | — | 7 | — | — | — | — | — | 7 | — | 7 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Buyback of equity | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Purchase of treasury shares | — | — | (52 | ) | — | — | — | — | (52 | ) | — | (52 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Release of treasury shares | — | — | 61 | — | — | — | (61 | ) | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Transfer of gain on disposal of FVOCI investment | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Dividends | — | — | — | — | — | — | (147 | ) | (147 | ) | (1 | ) | (148 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2019 | 195 | 2,614 | (24 | ) | 11 | �� | 39 | 567 | 911 | 4,313 | 10 | 4,323 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
The capital redemption reserve reflects the nominal value of shares cancelled in the Group’s share buyback programme. The fair value reserve arises on revaluation of other financial assets. The translation reserve includes exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign operations and of borrowings and other currency instruments designated as hedges of such investments
.
F-
12
Consolidated cash flow statement
Year ended 31 December
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Cash flows from operating activities | ||||||||||||||||
Net cash generated from operations | 33 | 570 | 450 | 480 | ||||||||||||
Interest paid | (67 | ) | (63 | ) | (81 | ) | ||||||||||
Tax (paid)/received | (177 | ) | 2 | (30 | ) | |||||||||||
Net cash generated from operating activities | 326 | 389 | 369 | |||||||||||||
Cash flows from investing activities | ||||||||||||||||
Acquisition of subsidiaries, net of cash acquired | 30 | (55 | ) | (6 | ) | (45 | ) | |||||||||
Acquisition of associates | 12 | (10 | ) | — | — | |||||||||||
Additional capital invested in associates | — | — | (40 | ) | ||||||||||||
Purchase of investments | (4 | ) | (6 | ) | (12 | ) | ||||||||||
Purchase of property, plant and equipment | (64 | ) | (53 | ) | (55 | ) | ||||||||||
Purchase of intangible assets | (112 | ) | (81 | ) | (138 | ) | ||||||||||
Disposal of subsidiaries, net of cash disposed | 31 | 83 | 100 | (101 | ) | |||||||||||
Proceeds from sale of joint ventures and associates | 31 | — | 531 | — | ||||||||||||
Proceeds from sale of investments | 48 | — | 5 | |||||||||||||
Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment | — | — | 1 | |||||||||||||
Lease receivables repaid including disposals | 21 | 41 | 26 | |||||||||||||
Loans repaid by/(advanced to) related parties | — | 48 | (49 | ) | ||||||||||||
Interest received | 13 | 13 | 17 | |||||||||||||
Investment income | — | — | 2 | |||||||||||||
Dividends from joint ventures and associates | — | 4 | 64 | |||||||||||||
Net cash (used in)/generated from investing activities | (80 | ) | 591 | (325 | ) | |||||||||||
Cash flows from financing activities | ||||||||||||||||
Proceeds from issue of ordinary shares | 27 | 6 | 6 | 7 | ||||||||||||
Buyback of equity | 27 | — | (176 | ) | — | |||||||||||
Purchase of treasury shares | 28 | (16 | ) | (6 | ) | (52 | ) | |||||||||
Proceeds from borrowings | — | 346 | 230 | |||||||||||||
Repayment of borrowings | (167 | ) | (230 | ) | (48 | ) | ||||||||||
Repayment of lease liabilities | (88 | ) | (92 | ) | (91 | ) | ||||||||||
Dividends paid to company’s shareholders | 9 | (149 | ) | (146 | ) | (147 | ) | |||||||||
Dividends paid to non-controlling interest | — | (1 | ) | (1 | ) | |||||||||||
Net cash used in financing activities | (414 | ) | (299 | ) | (102 | ) | ||||||||||
Effects of exchange rate changes on cash and cash equivalents | (8 | ) | (2 | ) | (33 | ) | ||||||||||
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents | (176 | ) | 679 | (91 | ) | |||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year | 1,113 | 434 | 525 | |||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year | 17 | 937 | 1,113 | 434 | ||||||||||||
F-
13
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
General information
Pearson plc (‘the company’), its subsidiaries and associates (together ‘the Group’) are international businesses covering educational courseware, assessments and services.
The company is a public limited company incorporated and domiciled in the United Kingdom. The address of its registered office is 80 Strand, London WC2R 0RL.
The company has its primary listing on the London Stock Exchange and is also listed on the New York Stock Exchange.
These consolidated financial statements were approved for issue by the Board of Directors on March 30, 2022.
1a. Accounting policies
The principal accounting policies applied in the preparation of these consolidated financial statements are set out below.
Basis of preparation
These consolidated financial statements have been prepared on the going concern basis (see note 1b) and in accordance with the Disclosure and Transparency Rules of the Financial Conduct Authority and in accordance with
UK-adopted
International Accounting Standards and with the requirements of the Companies Act 2006. On 31 December 2020, IFRS as adopted by the European Union at that date was brought into UK law and becameUK-adopted
International Accounting Standards (IASs), with future changes being subject to endorsement by the UK Endorsement Board. The Group transitioned toUK-adopted
IASs on 1 January 2021. This change constitutes a change in accounting framework. However, there is no impact on recognition, measurement or disclosure in the period reported as a result of the change in framework. The consolidated financial statements have also been prepared in accordance with IFRSs as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB). In respect of accounting standards applicable to the Group, there is no difference betweenUK-adopted
IASs and IFRSs as issued by the IASB.These consolidated financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention as modified by the revaluation of financial assets and liabilities (including derivative financial instruments) at fair value.
These accounting policies have been consistently applied to all years presented, unless otherwise stated.
1. Interpretations and amendments to published standards effective 2021
‘Interest Rate Benchmark Reform – Phase 2 (Amendments to IFRS 9, IAS 39, IFRS 7, IFRS 4 and IFRS 16)’ is effective from 1 January 2021 (see note 19) and in addition, the Group has early adopted the amendment to IFRS 16
‘COVID-19
related rent concessions beyond 30 June 2021’. The amendments do not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.The Group has also considered the IFRIC agenda decision on ‘Configuration and Customisation costs in a Cloud Computing Arrangement’, and concluded that it does not have a material impact on the consolidated financial statements.
F-
14
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Basis of preparation continued
2. Standards, interpretations and amendments to published standards that are not yet effective
• | IFRS 17 ‘Insurance contracts’; |
• | Amendments to IFRS 3 ’Reference to the conceptual framework’; |
• | Amendments to IAS 1 ‘Disclosure of accounting policies’; |
• | Amendments to IAS 1 ‘Classification of liabilities as current or non-current’; |
• | Amendments to IAS 8 ‘Definition of accounting estimates’; |
• | Amendments to IAS 12 ‘Deferred tax related to assets and liabilities arising from a single transaction’; |
• | Amendments to IAS 16 ‘Proceeds before intended use’; |
• | Amendments to IAS 37 ‘Onerous contracts - costs of fulfilling a contract’; and |
• | Annual improvements to IFRS 2018-2020. |
The Group is currently assessing the impact of the above changes, but they are not expected to have a material impact. The Group has not adopted any other standard, amendment or interpretation that has been issued but is not yet effective.
3. Critical accounting assumptions and judgements
All assumptions and estimates constitute management’s best judgement at the date of the financial statements, however, in the future, actual experience may deviate from these estimates and assumptions.
The areas requiring a higher degree of judgement or complexity, or areas where assumptions and estimates are significant to the consolidated financial statements are:
• | Intangible assets: Goodwill |
• | Taxation |
• | Revenue: Provisions for returns |
• | Employee benefits: Pensions |
• | Property, plant and equipment: Right-of-use |
The recoverability of product development assets and in particular, the assessment of the useful economic lives of the product development assets, is no longer considered to be a key area of estimation uncertainty as the impact of
COVID-19
on the business, and in particular, on future sales, has lessened and therefore it is no longer considered that there is a significant risk of a material adjustment to the carrying value of the product development assets within the next year.The key judgements and key areas of estimation are set out below, as well as in the relevant accounting policies and in the notes to the accounts where appropriate.
F-
15
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Basis of preparation continued
Key judgements
• | The application of tax legislation in relation to provisions for uncertain tax positions (see notes 7 and 34). |
• | The allocation of goodwill to the cash-generating units and groups of cash-generating units (see note 11). |
• | Whether the Group will be eligible to receive the surplus associated with the UK Group Pension Plan in recognising a pension asset (see note 25). |
Key areas of estimation
• | The recoverability of goodwill balances. Key assumptions used in goodwill impairment testing are discount rates, perpetuity growth rates, forecast sales growth rates and forecast operating profits. See note 11 for further details. |
• | The level of provisions required in relation to uncertain tax positions is complex and each matter is separately assessed. The estimation of future settlement amounts is based on a number of factors including the status of the unresolved matter, clarity of legislation, range of possible outcomes and the statute of limitations. See notes 7 and 34 for further details. |
• | The level of provisions required for anticipated returns is estimated based on historical experience, customer buying patterns and retailer behaviours including stock levels. See note 3 for further details. |
• | The determination of the pension cost and defined benefit obligation of the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes depends on the selection of certain assumptions, which include the discount rate, inflation rate, salary growth and longevity. See note 25 for further details. |
• | The recoverability of right-of-use |
The Group has assessed the impact of the uncertainty presented by the continued
COVID-19
pandemic on the financial statements, specifically considering the impact on key judgements and significant estimates along with other areas of increased risk as follows:• | Recoverable value of right-of-use |
• | Financial instruments in particular counterparty risk and hedge effectiveness; |
• | Working capital provisions including expected credit losses on trade and other debtors and inventory obsolescence; and |
• | The assessment of the useful economic lives of product development assets. |
No material accounting impacts relating to the areas assessed above were recognised in the year. The Group will continue to monitor these areas of increased judgement, estimation and risk.
F-
16
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Consolidation
1. Business combinations
The consideration transferred for the acquisition of a subsidiary is the fair value of the assets transferred, the liabilities incurred and the equity interest issued by the Group. The consideration transferred includes the fair value of any asset or liability resulting from a contingent consideration arrangement. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred in the operating expenses line of the income statement. Identifiable assets acquired and identifiable liabilities and contingent liabilities assumed in a business combination are measured initially at their fair values at the acquisition date. The determination of fair values often requires significant judgements and the use of estimates, and, for material acquisitions, the fair value of the acquired intangible assets is determined by an independent valuer. The excess of the consideration transferred, the amount of any
non-controlling
interest in the acquiree and the acquisition date fair value of any previous equity interest in the acquiree over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired is recorded as goodwill (see note 30).See the ‘Intangible assets’ policy for the accounting policy on goodwill. If this is less than the fair value of the net assets of the subsidiary acquired, in the case of a bargain purchase, the difference is recognized directly in the income statement.
On anbasis, the Group recognises any
acquisition-by-acquisition
non-controlling
interest in the acquiree either at fair value or at thenon-controlling
interest’s proportionate share of the acquiree’s net assets.IFRS 3 ‘Business Combinations’ has not been applied retrospectively
to business combinations before the date of transition to IFRS.
Management exercises judgement in determining the classification of its investments in its businesses, in line with the following:
2. Subsidiaries
3. Transactions with
non-controlling
interestsnon-controlling
interests that do not result in loss of control are accounted for as equity transactions, that is, as transactions with the owners in their capacity as owners. Any surplus or deficit arising from disposals to anon-controlling
interest is recorded in equity. For purchases from anon-controlling
interest, the difference between consideration paid and the relevant share acquired of the carrying value of the subsidiary is recorded in equity.4. Joint ventures and associates
The Group’s share of its joint ventures’ and associates’ post-acquisition profits or losses is recognized in the income statement and its share of post-acquisition movements in reserves is recognised in reserves.
F-
17
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Consolidation continued
The Group’s share of its joint ventures’ and associates’ results is recognized as a component of operating profit as these operations form part of the core publishing business of the Group and are an integral part of existing wholly-owned businesses. The cumulative post-acquisition movements are adjusted against the carrying amount of the investment. When the Group’s share of losses in a joint venture or associate equals or exceeds its interest in the joint venture or associate, the Group does not recognise further losses unless the Group has incurred obligations or made payments on behalf of the joint venture or associate.
Unrealised gains and losses on transactions between the Group and its joint ventures and associates are eliminated to the extent of the Group’s interest in these entities.
5. Contribution of a subsidiary to an associate or joint venture
Foreign currency translation
1. Functional and presentation currency
2. Transactions and balances
year-end
exchange rates of monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are recognised in the income statement, except when deferred in equity as qualifying net investment hedges.3. Group companies
as follows:
a. | Assets and liabilities are translated at the closing rate at the date of the balance sheet |
b. | Income and expenses are translated at average exchange rates |
c. | All resulting exchange differences are recognised as a separate component of equity. |
On consolidation, exchange differences arising from the translation of the net investment in foreign entities, and of borrowings and other currency instruments designated as hedges of such investments, are taken to shareholders’ equity. The Group treats specific inter-company loan balances, which are not intended to be repaid in the foreseeable future, as part of its net investment. When a foreign operation is sold, such exchange differences are recognised in the income statement as part of the gain or loss on sale.
The principal overseas currency for the Group is the US dollar. The average rate for the year against sterling was $1.38 (2020: $1.28) and the
year-end
rate was $1.35 (2020: $1.37).Property, plant and equipment
Property, plant and equipment are stated at historical cost less depreciation. Cost includes the original purchase price of the asset and the costs attributable to bringing the asset to its working condition for intended use. Land is
F-
18
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Property, plant and equipment continued
not depreciated. Depreciation on other assets is calculated using the straight-line method to allocate their cost less their residual values over their estimated useful lives as follows:
Buildings (freehold): | 20 – 50 years | |
Buildings (leasehold): | over the period of the lease | |
Plant and equipment: | 3 – 10 years |
The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed, and adjusted if appropriate, at each balance sheet date.
The carrying value of an asset is written down to its recoverable amount if the carrying value of the asset is greater than its estimated recoverable amount.
Intangible assets
1. Goodwill
non-controlling
interest in the acquiree and the acquisition date fair value of any previous equity interest in the acquiree over the fair value of the identifiable net assets acquired. For the acquisition of subsidiaries made from the date of transition to IFRS to 31 December 2009, goodwill represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the Group’s share of the net identifiable assets acquired. Goodwill on acquisitions of subsidiaries is included in intangible assets. Goodwill on acquisition of associates and joint ventures represents the excess of the cost of an acquisition over the fair value of the Group’s share of the net identifiable assets acquired.Goodwill on acquisitions of associates and joint ventures is included in investments in associates and joint ventures.
Goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment and carried at cost less accumulated impairment losses. An impairment loss is recognised to the extent that the carrying value of goodwill exceeds the recoverable amount. The recoverable amount is the higher of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. These calculations require the use of estimates in respect of forecast cash flows and discount rates and significant management judgement in respect of cash-generating unit (CGU) and cost allocation; impairment is a key source of estimat
ion
uncertainty and has a significant risk of resulting in a material adjustment to the carrying amount of relevant assets within the next financial year. A summary of these assets by CGU and a description of the key assumptions and sensitivities is included in note 11.Goodwill is allocated to aggregated CGUs for the purpose of impairment testing. The allocation is made to those aggregated CGUs that are expected to benefit from the business combination in which the goodwill arose. Where there are changes to CGUs, goodwill is reallocated to the new CGUs and aggregation of CGUs using a relative value method.
Gains and losses on the disposal of an entity include the carrying amount of goodwill relating to the entity sold.
2. Acquired software
3. Internally developed software
F-1
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Intangible assets continued
once the Group can reliably measure the expenditure attributable to the software development and has demonstrated its intention to complete and use the software. Internally developed software is amortised on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful life of between three and ten years.
4. Acquired intangible assets
5. Product development assets
Product development assets relating to content are amortised upon publication of the title over estimated economic lives of seven years or less, being an estimate of the expected operating lifecycle of the title, with a higher proportion of the amortisation taken in the earlier years. Product development assets relating to product platforms are amortised over 10 years or less, being an estimate of the expected useful life.
The assessment of the useful economic life and the recoverability of product development assets involves judgement and is based on historical trends and management estimation of future potential sales.
Product development assets are assessed for impairment triggers on an annual basis or when triggering events occur. The carrying amount of product development assets is set out in note 20.
The investment in product development assets has been disclosed as part of cash generated from operations in the cash flow statement (see note 33).
Other financial assets
Other financial assets are
non-derivative
financial assets classified and measured at estimated fair value.Marketable securities and cash deposits with maturities of greater than three months are classified and subsequently measured at fair value through profit and loss (FVTPL). They are remeasured at each balance sheet date by using market data and the use of established valuation techniques. Any movement in the fair value is immediately recognised in finance income or finance costs in the income statement.
Investments in the equity instruments of other entities are classified and subsequently measured at fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI). Changes in fair value are recorded in equity in the fair value reserve via other comprehensive income. On subsequent disposal of the asset, the net fair value gains or losses are reclassified from the fair value reserve to retained earnings. Any dividends received from equity investments classified as FVOCI are recognised in the income statement unless they represent a return of capital.
Inventories
Inventories are stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value. Cost is determined using the weighted average method or an approximation thereof, such as the first in first out (FIFO) method. The cost of finished goods and work in progress comprises raw materials, direct labour, other direct costs and related production overheads. Net realisable value is the estimated selling price in the ordinary course of business, less estimated costs necessary to make the sale. Provisions are made for slow-moving and obsolete stock.
F-
20
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Royalty advances
Advances of royalties to authors are included within trade and other receivables when the advance is paid less any provision required to adjust the advance to its net realisable value. The realisable value of royalty advances relies on a degree of management estimation in determining the profitability of individual author contracts. If the estimated realisable value of author contracts is overstated, this will have an adverse effect on operating profits as these excess amounts will be written off.
The recoverability of royalty advances is based upon an annual detailed management review of the age of the advance, the future sales projections for new authors and prior sales history of repeat authors.
The royalty advance is expensed at the contracted or effective royalty rate as the related revenues are earned. Royalty advances which will be consumed within one year are held in current assets. Royalty advances which will be consumed after one year are held in
non-current
assets.Cash and cash equivalents
Cash and cash equivalents in the cash flow statement include cash in hand, deposits held on call with banks, other short-term highly liquid investments with original maturities of three months or less, and bank overdrafts. Bank overdrafts are included in borrowings in current liabilities in the balance sheet.
Short-term deposits and marketable securities with maturities of greater than three months do not qualify as cash and cash equivalents and are reported as financial assets. Movements on these financial assets are classified as cash flows from financing activities in the cash flow statement where these amounts are used to offset the borrowings of the Group or as cash flows from investing activities where these amounts are held to generate an investment return.
Share capital
Ordinary shares are classified as equity.
Incremental costs directly attributable to the issue of new shares or options are shown in equity as a deduction, net of tax, from the proceeds.
Where any Group company purchases the company’s equity share capital (treasury shares), the consideration paid, including any directly attributable incremental costs, net of income taxes, is deducted from equity attributable to the company’s equity holders until the shares are cancelled, reissued or disposed of. Where such shares are subsequently sold or reissued, any consideration received, net of any directly attributable transaction costs and the related income tax effects, is included in equity attributable to the company’s equity holders.
Ordinary shares purchased under a buyback programme are cancelled and the nominal value of the shares is transferred to a capital redemption reserve.
Borrowings
Borrowings are recognised initially at fair value, which is proceeds received net of transaction costs incurred. Borrowings are subsequently stated at amortised cost with any difference between the proceeds (net of transaction costs) and the redemption value being recognised in the income statement over the period of the borrowings using the effective interest method. Accrued interest is included as part of borrowings.
Where a debt instrument is in a fair value hedging relationship, an adjustment is made to its carrying value in the income statement to reflect the hedged risk.
F-
21
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Borrowings continued
Where a debt instrument is in a net investment hedge relationship, gains and losses on the effective portion of the hedge are recognised in other comprehensive income.
Derivative financial instruments
Derivatives are recognised at fair value and remeasured at each balance sheet date. The fair value of derivatives is determined by using market data and the use of established estimation techniques such as discounted cash flow and option valuation models.
For derivatives in a hedge relationship, the currency basis spread is excluded from the designation as a hedging instrument.
Changes in the fair value of derivatives are recognised immediately in finance income or costs. However, derivatives relating to borrowings and certain foreign exchange contracts are designated as part of a hedging transaction.
The accounting treatment is summarised as follows:
Typical reason for designation | Reporting of gains and losses on effective portion of the hedge | Reporting of gains and losses on disposal | ||
Net investment hedge | ||||
The derivative creates a foreign currency liability which is used to hedge changes in the value of a subsidiary which transacts in that currency. | Recognised in other comprehensive income. | On the disposal of foreign operations or subsidiaries, the accumulated value of gains and losses reported in other comprehensive income is transferred to the income statement. | ||
Fair value hedges | ||||
The derivative transforms the interest profile on debt from fixed | Gains and losses on the derivative are reported in finance income or finance costs However, an equal and opposite change is made to the carrying value of the debt (a ‘fair value adjustment’) with the benefit/cost reported in finance income or finance costs. The net result should be a zero charge on a perfectly effective hedge. | If the debt and derivative are disposed of, the value of the derivative and the debt (including the fair value adjustment) are reset to zero. Any resultant gain or loss is recognised in finance income or finance costs. | ||
Non-hedge accounted contracts | ||||
These are not designated as hedging instruments. Typically, these are short-term contracts to convert debt back to fixed rates or foreign exchange contracts where a natural offset exists. | Recognised in the income statement. No hedge accounting applies. |
F-
22
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Taxation
Current tax is recognised at the amounts expected to be paid or recovered under the tax rates and laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted at the balance sheet date.
Deferred income tax is provided, using the balance sheet liability method, on temporary differences arising between the tax bases of assets and liabilities and their carrying amounts. Deferred income tax is determined using tax rates and laws that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date and are expected to apply when the related deferred tax asset is realised or the deferred income tax liability is settled.
Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that future taxable profit will be available against which the temporary differences can be utilised.
Deferred income tax is provided in respect of the undistributed earnings of subsidiaries, associates and joint ventures other than where it is intended that those undistributed earnings will not be remitted in the foreseeable future.
Current and deferred tax are recognised in the income statement, except when the tax relates to items charged or credited directly to equity or other comprehensive income, in which case the tax is also recognised in equity or other comprehensive income.
The Group is subject to income taxes in numerous jurisdictions. Significant judgement is required in determining the estimates in relation to the worldwide provision for income taxes. There are many transactions and calculations for which the ultimate tax determination is uncertain during the ordinary course of business. The Group recognises tax provisions when it is considered probable that there will be a future outflow of funds to a tax authority. The provisions are based on management’s best judgement of the application of tax legislation and best estimates of future settlement amounts (see note 7). Where the final tax outcome of these matters is different from the amounts that were initially recorded, such differences will impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which such determination is made.
Deferred tax assets and liabilities require management judgement and estimation in determining the amounts to be recognised. In particular, when assessing the extent to which deferred tax assets should be recognised, significant judgement is used when considering the timing of the recognition and estimation is used to determine the level of future taxable income together with any future tax planning strategies (see note 13).
Employee benefits
1. Pensions
When the calculation results in a potential asset, the recognition of that asset is limited to the asset ceiling – that is the present value of any economic benefits available in the form of refunds from the plan or a reduction in future contributions. Management uses judgement to determine the level of refunds available from the plan in recognising an asset.
F-
23
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Employee benefits continued
The determination of the pension cost and defined benefit obligation of the Group’s defined benefit pension schemes depends on the selection of certain assumptions, which include the discount rate, inflation rate, salary growth and longevity (see note 25).
Actuarial gains and losses arising from experience adjustments and changes in actuarial assumptions are charged or credited to equity in other comprehensive income in the period in which they arise. The service cost, representing benefits accruing over the year, is included in the income statement as an operating cost. Net interest is calculated by applying the discount rate to the net defined benefit obligation and is presented as finance costs or finance income.
Obligations for contributions to defined contribution pension plans are recognised as an operating expense in the income statement as incurred.
2. Other post-retirement obligations
3. Share-based payments
Provisions
Provisions are recognised if the Group has a present legal or constructive obligation as a result of past events; it is more likely than not that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation and the amount can be reliably estimated. Provisions are discount
ed
to present value where the effect is material.Revenue recognition
The Group’s revenue streams are courseware, assessments and services. Courseware includes curriculum materials provided in book form and/or via access to digital content. Assessments includes test development, processing and scoring services provided to governments, educational institutions, corporations and professional bodies. Services includes the operation of schools, colleges and universities, including sistemas in Brazil, as well as the provision of online learning services in partnership with universities and other academic institutions.
Revenue is recognised in order to depict the transfer of control of promised goods and services to customers in an amount that reflects the consideration to which we expect to be entitled in exchange for those goods and services. This process begins with the identification of our contract with a customer, which is generally through a master services agreement, customer purchase order, or a combination thereof. Within each contract, judgement is applied to determine the extent to which activities within the contract represent distinct performance obligations to be delivered and the total amount of transaction price to which we expect to be entitled.
The transaction price determined is net of sales taxes, rebates and discounts, and after eliminating sales within the Group. Where a contract contains multiple performance obligations such as the provision of supplementary
F-
24
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Revenue recognition continued
materials or online access with textbooks, revenue is allocated on the basis of relative standalone selling prices. Where a contract contains variable consideration, significant estimation is required to determine the amount to which the Group is expected to be entitled.
Revenue is recognised on contracts with customers when or as performance obligations are satisfied, which is the period or the point in time where control of goods or services transfers to the customer. Judgement is applied to determine first whether control passes over time and if not, then the point in time at which control passes. Where revenue is recognised over time, judgement is used to determine the method which best depicts the transfer of control. Where an input method is used, significant estimation is required to determine the progress towards delivering the performance obligation.
Revenue from the sale of books is recognised net of a provision for anticipated returns. This provision is based primarily on historical return rates, customer buying patterns and retailer behaviours including stock levels (see note 24). If these estimates do not reflect actual returns in future periods then revenues could be understated or overstated for a particular period. When the provision for returns is remeasured at each reporting date to reflect changes in estimates, a corresponding adjustment is also recorded to revenue.
The Group may enter into contracts with another party in addition to our customer. In making the determination as to whether revenue should be recognised on a gross or net basis, the contract with the customer is analysed to understand which party controls the relevant good or service prior to transferring to the customer. This judgement is informed by facts and circumstances of the contract in determining whether the Group has promised to provide the specified good or service or whether the Group is arranging for the transfer of the specified good or service, including which party is responsible for fulfilment, has discretion to set the price to the customer and is responsible for inventory risk. On certain contracts, where the Group acts as an agent, only commissions and fees receivable for services rendered are recognised as revenue. Any third-party costs incurred on behalf of the principal that are rechargeable under the contractual arrangement are not included in revenue.
Income from recharges of freight and other activities which are incidental to the normal revenue-generating activities is included in other income.
Additional details on the Group’s revenue streams are also included
in note 3.
Leases
The Group as a lessee
The Group assesses whether a contract is or contains a lease at the inception of the contract. A contract is, or contains a lease, if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration. The Group recognises aasset and a lease liability at the lease commencement date with respect to all lease arrangements except for short-term leases (leases with a lease term of 12 months or less) and leases of
right-of-use
low-value
assets. For these leases, the lease payments are recognised as an operating expense on a straight-line basis over the term of the lease.Theasset is initially measured at cost, comprising the initial amount of the lease liability plus any initial direct costs incurred and an estimate of costs to restore the underlying asset, less any lease incentives received. Theasset is subsequently depreciated using the straight-line method from the commencement date to the earlier of the end of the useful life of the asset or the end of the lease term. The Group applies IAS 36 to determine whether aasset is impaired. The lease liability is initially measured at
right-of-use
right-of-use
right-of-use
F-
25
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Leases continued
the present value of the lease payments that are not paid at the commencement date, discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease or, if that rate cannot be readily determined, the incremental borrowing rate. The lease liability is measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method. It is remeasured when there is a change in future lease payments arising from a change in an index or a rate or a change in the Group’s assessment of whether it will exercise an extension or termination option. When the lease liability is remeasured, a corresponding adjustment is made to theasset.
right-of-use
Management uses judgement to determine the lease term where extension and termination options are available within the lease.
The Group as a lessor
When the Group is an intermediate lessor, the head lease and sublease are accounted for as two separate contracts. The head lease is accounted for as per the lessee policy above. The sublease is classified as a finance lease or operating lease by reference to theasset arising from the head lease. Where the lease transfers substantially all the risks and rewards of ownership to the lessee, the contract is classified as a finance lease; all other leases are classified as operating leases. Rental income from operating leases is recognised on a straight-line basis over the term of the relevant lease. Amounts due from lessees under finance subleases are recognised as receivables at the amount of the Group’s net investment in the leases discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease or, if that rate cannot be readily determined, the discount rate used in the head lease.
right-of-use
Policy applicable from 1 January 2019: IFRS 16
The Group adopted IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ at 1 January 2019 and applied the modified retrospective approach. Comparatives for 2018 have not been restated and the cumulative impact of adoption has been recognised as a decrease of £83m to net assets with a corresponding decrease in retained earnings at 1 January 2019. The net impact on the balance sheet has been assessed after taking into account existing liabilities relating to onerous lease provisions, lease incentives, prepayments, adjustments to tax and the net impact on the associates. Adoption of IFRS 16 had a material impact on the Group. The lease liability brought onto the balance sheet at transition was £881m with the corresponding right-of-use asset valued at £424m. In addition, certain subleases have been reclassified as finance leases resulting in an additional lease receivable of £215m being brought on balance sheet. The impact on the income statement for 2019 was to reduce profit before tax by £9m. The weighted average incremental borrowing rate applied to the lease liabilities on 1 January 2019 was 5%.
Dividends
Final dividends are recorded in the Group’s financial statements in the period in which they are approved by the company’s shareholders. Interim dividends are recorded when paid.
Discontinued operations
A discontinued operation is a component of the Group’s business that represents a separate major line of business or geographical area of operations that has been disposed of or meets the criteria to be classified as held for sale.
When applicable, discontinued operations are presented in the income statement as a separate line and are shown net of tax.
Assets and liabilities held for sale
Assets and liabilities are classified as held for sale and stated at the lower of carrying amount and fair value less costs to sell if it is highly probable that the carrying amount will be recovered principally through a sale
F-26
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
Assets and liabilities held for sale continued
transaction rather than through continuing use. No depreciation is charged in respect of
non-current
assets classified as held for sale. Amounts relating tonon-current
assets and liabilities held for sale are classified as discontinued operations in the income statement where appropriate.Trade receivables
Trade receivables are stated at fair value after provision for bad and doubtful debts. Provisions for bad and doubtful debts are based on the expected credit loss model. The ‘simplified approach’ is used with the expected loss allowance measured at an amount equal to the lifetime expected credit losses. A provision for anticipated future sales returns is included within trade and other liabilities (also see Revenue recognition policy).
1b. Going concern
In assessing the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern for the period to 30 June 2023, the Board analysed a variety of downside scenarios including a severe but plausible scenario where the Group is impacted by a combination of all principal risks from 2022 as well as reverse stress testing to identify what would be required to either breach covenants or run out of liquidity. The severe but plausible scenario modelled a severe reduction in revenue, profit and operating cash flow from risks which in aggregate were significantly greater than seen in 2021 continuing throughout 2022 to 2023.
At 31 December 2021, the Group had available liquidity of c£1.6bn, comprising central cash balances and its undrawn $1.19bn Revolving Credit Facility (RCF). In February 2022, the Group renegotiated its revolving credit facility, extending the maturity of $1bn of the facility by one year to February 2026. Even under a severe downside case, the Group would maintain comfortable liquidity headroom and sufficient headroom against covenant requirements during the period under assessment even before modelling the mitigating effect of actions that management would take in the event that these downside risks were to crystallise.
The directors have confirmed that there are no material uncertainties that cast doubt on the Group’s going concern status and that they have a reasonable expectation that the Group has adequate resources to continue in operational existence for a minimum of the next 12 months.
1c. Climate change
The Group has assessed the impacts of climate change on the Group’s financial statements of our commitment to achieving net zero by 2030, and the actions the Group intends to take to achieve those targets. The assessment did not identify any material impact on the Group’s significant judgements or estimates at 31 December 2021, or the assessment of going concern for the period to June 2023 and the Group’s viability over the next five years, Specifically, we have considered the following areas:
• | The physical and transition risks associated with climate change; and |
• | The actions the Group is taking to meet its carbon reduction and net zero targets. |
As a result, the Group has assessed the impacts of climate change on the financial statements, and in particular, on the following areas:
• | The impact on the Group’s future cash flows, and the resulting impact that such adjustments to our future cash flows would have on the outcome of the annual impairment testing of our goodwill balances (see note 11 for further details), the recognition of deferred tax assets and our assessment of going concern; |
F-27
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
1a. Accounting policies continued
1c. Climate change continued
• | The carrying value of the Group’s assets, in particular the recoverable amounts of inventories, product development assets, intangible assets and property, plant and equipment; and |
• | Any changes to our estimates of the useful economic lives of product development assets, intangible assets and property, plant and equipment. |
2. Segment information
On 8 March 2021, the Group announced a new strategy, which included a new management structure and operating model. As a result, the primary operating segments reported to the Group’s chief operating decision-maker, the Pearson Executive Management team, have changed from 1 July 2021 to reflect the new Group structure. There are now five main global business divisions, which are each considered separate operating segments for management and reporting purposes. These five divisions are Assessment & Qualification, Virtual Learning, English Language Learning, Higher Education and Workforce Skills. In addition, the International Courseware local publishing businesses are under strategic review and during this time are being managed as a separate division, known as Strategic Review. For the comparative period, the Group has separately disclosed the results from the Penguin Random House associate to the point of disposal in April 2020. Comparative figures for 2020 and 2019 have been restated to reflect the new segments.
The following describes the principal activities of the five main operating segments:
• | Assessment & Qualification – Pearson VUE, US Student Assessment, Clinical Assessment, UK GCSE and A Levels and International academic qualifications. |
• | Virtual Learning – Virtual Schools and Online Program Management. |
• | English Language Learning – Pearson T est of English, Institut ional Courseware and English Online Solutions. |
• | Higher Education – US, Canadian and International Higher Education Courseware businesses. |
• | Workforce Skills – BTEC, GED, TalentLens, Faethm, Pearson College and Apprenticeships. |
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Notes | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Strategic Review | Penguin Random House | Group | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 3 | 1,204 | 713 | 238 | 172 | 849 | 252 | — | 3,428 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 216 | 32 | 15 | 27 | 73 | 22 | — | 385 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of major restructuring | (48 | ) | (48 | ) | (27 | ) | (28 | ) | (63 | ) | — | — | (214 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | (13 | ) | (25 | ) | (3 | ) | (7 | ) | (2 | ) | (1 | ) | — | (51 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | (2 | ) | — | 65 | — | 63 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit/(loss) | 155 | (41 | ) | (15 | ) | (10 | ) | 8 | 86 | — | 183 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Finance costs | 6 | (68 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Finance income | 6 | 42 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit before tax | 157 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Income tax | 7 | 3 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the year | 160 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other segment items | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share of results of joint ventures and associates | 12 | — | (1 | ) | 3 | (1 | ) | — | — | — | 1 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and impairment | 10 | 92 | 48 | 14 | 9 | 63 | 15 | — | 241 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment | 11, 20 | 129 | 67 | 34 | 25 | 165 | 26 | — | 446 |
F-2
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
2. Segment information continued
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Notes | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Strategic Review | Penguin Random House | Group | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 3 | 1,082 | 692 | 218 | 163 | 956 | 286 | — | 3,397 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 147 | 29 | 1 | 26 | 93 | 16 | 1 | 313 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Cost of major restructuring | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | (29 | ) | (30 | ) | (7 | ) | (8 | ) | (3 | ) | (3 | ) | — | (80 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | — | — | (2 | ) | 180 | 178 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit/(loss) | 118 | (1 | ) | (6 | ) | 18 | 90 | 11 | 181 | 411 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Finance costs | 6 | (107 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Finance income | 6 | 50 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit before tax | 354 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Income tax | 7 | (44 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the year | 310 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other segment items | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share of results of joint ventures and associates | 12 | — | — | 4 | — | — | — | 1 | 5 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and impairment | 10 | 53 | 21 | 7 | 5 | 28 | 11 | — | 125 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment | 11, 20 | 148 | 64 | 34 | 24 | 167 | 35 | — | 472 |
2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Notes | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Strategic Review | Penguin Random House | Group | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Sales | 3 | 1,280 | 584 | 320 | 185 | 1,102 | 398 | — | 3,869 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Adjusted operating profit | 252 | 13 | 59 | 31 | 134 | 27 | 65 | 581 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Costs of major restructuring | (38 | ) | (13 | ) | (10 | ) | (7 | ) | (68 | ) | (21 | ) | (2 | ) | (159 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||
Intangible charges | (23 | ) | (36 | ) | (80 | ) | (9 | ) | — | (3 | ) | (12 | ) | (163 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | — | — | — | — | — | 16 | — | 16 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Operating profit / (loss) | 191 | (36 | ) | (31 | ) | 15 | 66 | 19 | 51 | 275 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Finance costs | 6 | (84 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Finance income | 6 | 41 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit before tax | 232 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Income tax | 7 | 34 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Profit for the year | 266 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Share of results of joint ventures and associates | — | — | 3 | — | — | — | 51 | 54 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and impairment | 49 | 18 | 8 | 5 | 29 | 14 | — | 123 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment | 135 | 62 | 104 | 24 | 172 | 40 | — | 537 |
There were 0 material inter-segment sales in either 2021, 2020 or 2019.
F-2
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
2. Segment information continued
Corporate costs are allocated to business segments on an appropriate basis depending on the nature of the cost and therefore the total segment result is equal to the Group operating profit.
Adjusted operating profit is shown in the above tables as it is the key financial measure used by management to evaluate the performance of the Group. The measure also enables investors to more easily, and consistently, track the underlying operational performance of the Group and its business segments over time by separating out those items of income and expenditure relating to acquisition and disposal transactions, major restructuring programmes and certain other items that are also not representative of underlying performance, which are explained below and reconciled
with
inthis
note.Cost of major restructuring – In March 2021, the Group announced a restructuring programme, to run primarily in 2021. The programme includes the reorganisation of the Group into five global business divisions and the simplification of the Group’s property portfolio. The restructuring costs in 2021 of £214m
mainly relate to the impairment ofproperty assets, the write-down of product development assets and staff redundancies. In May 2017, the Group announced a major restructuring programme to run between 2017 and 2019 to drive further significant cost savings. The costs of these restructuring programmes are significant enough to exclude from the adjusted operating profit measure so as to better highlight the underlying performance (see note 4).
right-of-use
Intangible charges – These represent charges relating to intangibles acquired through business combinations and intangibles relating to associate
s
. These charges are excluded as they reflect past acquisition activity and do not necessarily reflect the current year performance of the Group. Intangible amortisation charges in 2021 were £51m, which included 0 impairment charges. In 2020, intangible charges were £80m including impairment charges of £12m. In 2019, intangible changes were £163m including impairment changes of £65m.Other net gains and losses – These represents profits and losses on the sale of subsidiaries, joint ventures, associates and other financial assets and are excluded from adjusted operating profit as they distort the performance of the Group as reported on a statutory basis. Other net gains and losses also includes costs related to business closures and acquisitions. Other net gains in 2021 largely relate to gains from the disposal of PIHE and the K12 Sistemas business in Brazil offset by costs related to the acquisition of Faethm and the wind-down of certain strategic review businesses. In 2020, they largely relate to the sale of the remaining interest in Penguin Random House (£180m gain). In 2019, other net gains largely relate to the sale of the US K-12 business
.
The Group operates in the following main geographic areas:
Sales | Non-current assets | |||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | 2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||
UK | 355 | 319 | 385 | 582 | 669 | |||||||||||||||
Other European countries | 249 | 216 | 244 | 123 | 129 | |||||||||||||||
US | 2,182 | 2,335 | 2,417 | 2,146 | 2,362 | |||||||||||||||
Canada | 111 | 91 | 105 | 225 | 147 | |||||||||||||||
Asia Pacific | 359 | 251 | 441 | 192 | 149 | |||||||||||||||
Other countries | 172 | 185 | 277 | 20 | 30 | |||||||||||||||
Total | 3,428 | 3,397 | 3,869 | 3,288 | 3,486 | |||||||||||||||
Sales are allocated based on the country in which the customer is located. This does not differ materially from the location where the order is received. The geographical split of
non-current
assets is based on the subsidiary’s country of domicile. This is not materially different to the location of the assets.Non-current
assets comprise property, plant and equipment, intangible assets, investments in joint ventures and associates and trade and other receivables.F-
30
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers
The following tables analyse the Group’s revenue streams. Courseware includes curriculum materials provided in book form and/or via access
to digital content. Assessments includes integrated test development, processing and scoring services provided to governments, educational institutions, corporations and professional bodies. Services includes the operation of schools, colleges and universities, including sistemas in Brazil, as well as the provision of online learning services in partnership with universities and other academic institutions. Comparative figures for 2020 and 2019 have been restated to reflect the new segments.
The Group derived revenue from the transfer of goods and services over time and at a point in time in the following major product lines:
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Strategic Review | Total | |||||||||||||||||||||
Courseware | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 44 | — | 109 | — | 283 | 198 | 634 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 14 | — | 26 | — | 558 | 33 | 631 | |||||||||||||||||||||
58 | — | 135 | — | 841 | 231 | 1,265 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Assessments | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 173 | — | 6 | 16 | — | — | 195 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 973 | — | 72 | 119 | — | — | 1,164 | |||||||||||||||||||||
1,146 | — | 78 | 135 | — | — | 1,359 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Services | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | — | — | 22 | — | — | 14 | 36 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | — | 713 | 3 | 37 | 8 | 7 | 768 | |||||||||||||||||||||
— | 713 | 25 | 37 | 8 | 21 | 804 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,204 | 713 | 238 | 172 | 849 | 252 | 3,428 | |||||||||||||||||||||
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Strategic Review | Total | |||||||||||||||||||||
Courseware | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 43 | — | 106 | — | 313 | 208 | 670 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 14 | — | 24 | — | 630 | 28 | 696 | |||||||||||||||||||||
57 | — | 130 | — | 943 | 236 | 1,366 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Assessments | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 138 | — | 3 | 7 | — | — | 148 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 887 | — | 61 | 123 | — | — | 1,071 | |||||||||||||||||||||
1,025 | — | 64 | 130 | — | — | 1,219 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Services | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | — | — | 22 | — | — | 22 | 44 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | — | 692 | 2 | 33 | 13 | 28 | 768 | |||||||||||||||||||||
— | 692 | 24 | 33 | 13 | 50 | 812 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,082 | 692 | 218 | 163 | 956 | 286 | 3,397 | |||||||||||||||||||||
F-
31
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers continued
2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Assessment & Qualifications | Virtual Learning | English Language Learning | Workforce Skills | Higher Education | Strategic Review | Total | |||||||||||||||||||||
Courseware | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 50 | — | 152 | — | 492 | 260 | 954 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 14 | — | 22 | — | 594 | 66 | 696 | |||||||||||||||||||||
64 | — | 174 | — | 1,086 | 326 | 1,650 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Assessments | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 162 | — | 4 | 8 | — | — | 174 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 1,054 | — | 91 | 145 | — | — | 1,290 | |||||||||||||||||||||
1,216 | — | 95 | 153 | — | — | 1,464 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Services | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | — | — | 48 | — | — | 38 | 86 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | — | 584 | 3 | 32 | 16 | 34 | 669 | |||||||||||||||||||||
— | 584 | 51 | 32 | 16 | 72 | 755 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,280 | 584 | 320 | 185 | 1,102 | 398 | 3,869 | |||||||||||||||||||||
a. Nature of goods and services
The following is a description of the nature of the Group’s performance obligations within contracts with customers broken down by revenue stream, along with significant judgements and estimates made within each of those revenue streams.
Courseware
Key areas of estimation
Revenue is generated from customers through the sales of print and digital courseware materials to schools, bookstores and direct to individual learners. Goods and services may be sold separately or purchased together in bundled packages. The goods and services included in bundled arrangements are considered distinct performance obligations, except for where Pearson provides both a licence of intellectual property and an ongoing hosting service. As the licence of intellectual property is only available with the concurrent hosting service, the licence is not treated as a distinct performance obligation separate from the hosting service.
The transaction price is allocated between distinct performance obligations on the basis of their relative standalone selling prices.
In determining the transaction price, variable consideration exists in the form of discounts and anticipated returns. Discounts reduce the transaction price on a given transaction. A provision for anticipated returns is made based primarily on historical return rates, customer buying patterns and retailer behaviours including stock levels (see note 24). If these estimates do not reflect actual returns in future periods then revenues could be understated or overstated for a particular period. Variable consideration as described above is determined using the expected value approach. The sales return liability at the end of 2021 was £83m (2020: £86m; 2019: £122m) (see note 24). This represents 13% of courseware sales transferred at a point in
While payment for these goods and services generally occurs at the start of these arrangements, the length of time between payment and delivery of the performance obligations is generally short-term in nature or the reason
F-
32
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers continued
Courseware continued
for early payment relates to reasons other than financing, including customers securing a vendor in a longer-term arrangement or the transfer of goods or services is at the discretion of the customer. For these reasons and the use of the practical expedient on short-term financing, significant financing components are not recognised within Courseware transactions.
Revenue from the sale of physical books is recognised at a point in time when control passes. This is generally at the point of shipment when title passes to the customer, when the Group has a present right to payment and the significant risks and rewards of ownership have passed to the customer. Revenue from physical books sold through the direct print rental method is recognised over the rental period, as the customer is simultaneously receiving and consuming the benefits of this rental service through the passage of time.
Revenue from the sale of digital courseware products is recognised on a straight-line basis over the subscription period, unless hosted by a third-party or representative of a downloadable product, in which case Pearson has no ongoing obligation and recognises revenue when control transfers as the customer is granted access to the digital product.
Revenue from the sale ofsoftware is recognised on delivery or on installation of the software where that is a condition of the contract. In certain circumstances, where installation is complex, revenue is recognised when the customer has completed their acceptance procedures.
‘off-the-shelf’
Assessments
Revenue is primarily generated from multi-year contractual arrangements related to large-scale assessment delivery, such as contracts to process qualifying tests for individual professions and government departments, and is recognised as performance occurs. Under these arrangements, while the agreement spans multiple years, the contract duration has been determined to be each testing cycle based on contract structure, including clauses regarding termination.
While in some cases the customer may have the ability to terminate during the term for convenience, significant financial or qualitative barriers exist limiting the potential for such terminations in the middle of a testing cycle.
Within each testing cycle, a variety of service activities are performed such as test administration, delivery, scoring, reporting, item development, operational services and programme management. These services are not treated as distinct in the context of the customer contract as Pearson provides an integrated managed service offering and these activities are accounted for together as one comprehensive performance obligation.
Within each testing cycle, the transaction price may contain both fixed and variable amounts. Variable consideration within these transactions primarily relates to expected testing volumes to be delivered in the cycle. The assumptions, risks and uncertainties inherent to long-term contract accounting can affect the amounts and timing of revenue and related expenses reported. Variable consideration is measured using the expected value method, except where amounts are contingent upon a future event’s occurrence, such as performance bonuses. Such event-driven contingency payments are measured using the most likely amount approach. In estimating and constraining variable consideration, historical experience, current trends and local market conditions are considered. To the extent that a higher degree of uncertainty exists regarding variable consideration, these amounts are excluded from the transaction price and recognised when the uncertainty is reasonably removed.
Customer payments are generally defined in the contract through a payment schedule, which may require customer acceptance for services rendered. Pearson has a history of providing satisfactory services which are
F-
33
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers continued
Assessments continued
accepted by the customer. While a delay between rendering of services and payment may exist, payment terms are within 12 months and the Group has elected to use the practical expedient available in IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ and not identify a significant financing component on these transactions.
Revenue is recognised for Assessment contracts over time as the customer is benefiting as performance takes place through a continuous transfer of control to the customer. This continuous transfer of control to the customer is supported by clauses in the contracts which may allow the customer to terminate for convenience, compensate us for work performed to date, and take possession of work in process.
As control transfers over time, revenue is recognised based on the extent of progress towards completion of the performance obligation. The selection of the method to measure progress towards completion requires judgement and is based on the nature of the services provided. Revenue is recognised on a percentage of costs basis, calculated using the proportion of the total estimated costs incurred to date. From 2021, the proportion of estimated costs incurred to date is primarily based on historical cost analysis for similar groups of contracts, with regular
true-ups
to contract costs throughout the contract period. Previously, the proportion of estimated costs incurred to date was based on individual contract analysis. The change in input methodology has not resulted in a material impact on revenue recognition. Percentage of completion is used to recognise the transfer of control of services provided as these services are not provided evenly throughout the testing cycle and involve varying degrees of effort during the contract term.Losses on contracts are recognised in the period in which the loss first becomes foreseeable. Contract losses are determined to be the amount by which estimated total costs of the contract exceed the estimated total revenues that will be generated.
In Assessments contracts driven primarily by transactions directly to end users, Pearson’s main obligation to the customer involves test delivery and scoring. Test delivery and scoring are defined as a single performance obligation delivered over time whether the test is subsequently manually scored or digitally scored on the day of the assessment. Customers may also purchase print and digital supplemental materials. Print products in this revenue stream are recognised at a point in time when control passes to the customer upon shipment. Recognition of digital revenue will occur based on the extent of Pearson’s ongoing hosting obligation.
Services
Revenue is primarily generated from multi-year contractual arrangements related to large-scale educational service delivery to academic institutions, such as schools and higher education universities. Under these arrangements, while an agreement may span multiple years, the contract duration has been determined to be each academic period based on the structure of contracts, including clauses regarding termination. While in some cases the customer may have the ability to terminate during the term for convenience, significant financial or qualitative barriers exist limiting the potential for such terminations in the middle of an academic period. The academic period for this customer base is normally an academic year for schools and a semester for higher education universities.
Within each academic period, a variety of services are provided such as programme development, student acquisition, education technology and student support services. These services are not distinct in the context of the customer contract as Pearson provides an integrated managed service offering and these activities are accounted for together as a comprehensive performance obligation.
Where Services are provided to university customers, volume and transaction price are fixed at the start of the semester. Where Services are provided to school customers, the transaction price may contain both fixed and
F-
34
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers continued
Services continued
variable amounts which require estimation during the academic period. Estimation is required where consideration is based upon average enrolments or other metrics which are not known at the start of the academic year. Variable consideration is measured using the expected value method. Historical experience, current trends, local circumstances and customer-specific funding formulas are considered in estimating and constraining variable consideration. To the extent that a higher degree of uncertainty exists regarding variable consideration, these amounts are excluded from the transaction price and recognised when the uncertainty is reasonably removed.
Customer payments are generally defined in the contract as occurring shortly after invoicing. Where there is a longer payment term offered to a customer through a payment schedule, payment terms are within 12 months and the Group has elected to use the practical expedient available in IFRS 15 and not identify a significant financing component on these transactions.
Revenue is recognised for Service contracts over time as the customer is benefiting as performance takes place through a continuous transfer of control to the customer. This continuous transfer of control to the customer is supported by clauses in the contracts which may allow the customer to terminate for convenience, compensate for work performed to date, and take possession of work in process.
As control transfers over time, revenue is recognised based on the extent of progress towards completion of the performance obligation. The selection of the method to measure progress towards completion requires judgement and is based on the nature of the products or services provided. Within the comprehensive service obligation, the timing of services occurs relatively evenly over each academic period and, as such, time elapsed is used to recognise the transfer of control to the customer on a straight-line basis.
Losses on contracts are recognised in the period in which the loss first becomes foreseeable. Contract losses are determined to be the amount by which estimated total costs of the contract exceed the estimated total revenues that will be generated.
In cases of optional or
add-on
purchases, institutions may purchase physical goods priced at their standalone value, which are accounted for separately and recognised at the point in time when control passes to the customer upon shipment.b. Disaggregation of revenue
The tables in notes 2 and 3 show revenue from contracts with customers disaggregated by operating segment, geography and revenue stream. These disaggregation categories are appropriate as they represent the key groupings used in managing and evaluating underlying performance of each of the businesses. The categories also reflect groups of similar types of transactional characteristics, among similar customers, with similar accounting conclusions.
c. Contract balances
Transactions within the Courseware revenue stream generally entail customer billings at or near the contract’s inception and accordingly Courseware deferred income balances are primarily related to subscription performance obligations to be delivered over time.
Transactions within the Assessments and Services revenue streams generally entail customer billings over time based on periodic intervals, progress towards milestones or enrolment census dates. As the performance
F-
35
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers continued
c. Contract balances continued
obligations within these arrangements are delivered over time, the extent of accrued income or deferred income will ultimately depend upon the difference between revenue recognised and billings to date.
Refer to note 22 for opening and closing balances of accrued income. Refer to note 24 for opening and closing balances of deferred income. Revenue recognised during the period from changes in deferred income was driven primarily by the release of revenue over time from digital subscriptions.
d. Contract costs
The Group capitalises incremental costs to obtain contracts with customers where it is expected these costs will be recoverable. Incremental costs to obtain contracts with customers are considered those which would not have been incurred if the contract had not been obtained. For the Group, these costs relate primarily to sales commissions. The Group has elected to use the practical expedient as allowable by IFRS 15 whereby such costs will be expensed as incurred where the expected amortisation period is one year or less. Where the amortisation period is greater than one year, these costs are amortised over the contract term on a systematic basis consistent with the transfer of the underlying goods and services within the contract to which these costs relate, which will generally be on a rateable basis.
The Group does not recognise any material costs to fulfil contracts with customers as these types of activities are governed by other accounting standards.
There were 0 deferred contract costs in 2021 or 2020.
e. Remaining transaction price
The below table depicts the remaining transaction price on unsatisfied or partially unsatisfied performance obligations from contracts with customers.
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Sales | Deferred income | Committed sales | Total remaining transaction price | 2022 | 2023 | 2024 and later | |||||||||||||||||||||
Courseware | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 634 | 1 | — | 1 | 1 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 631 | 93 | 0 | 93 | 60 | 11 | 22 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Assessments | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 195 | 0 | — | 0 | 0 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 1,164 | 255 | 442 | 697 | 503 | 191 | 3 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Services | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 36 | 0 | — | 0 | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time – subscriptions | 290 | 13 | 10 | 23 | 23 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time – other ongoing performance obligations | 478 | 24 | 220 | 244 | 244 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 3,428 | 386 | 672 | 1,058 | 831 | 202 | 25 | |||||||||||||||||||||
F-3
6
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
3. Revenue from contracts with customers continued
e. Remaining transaction price continued
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Sales | Deferred income | Committed sales | Total remaining transaction price | 2021 | 2022 | 2023 and later | |||||||||||||||||||||
Courseware | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 670 | 0 | — | 0 | 0 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 696 | 105 | 14 | 119 | 84 | 14 | 21 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Assessments | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 148 | 1 | — | 1 | 1 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 1,071 | 217 | 413 | 630 | 426 | 203 | 1 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Services | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 44 | 0 | — | 0 | 0 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time – subscriptions | 323 | 18 | 10 | 28 | 27 | 1 | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time – other ongoing performance obligations | 445 | 18 | 195 | 213 | 213 | 0 | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 3,397 | 359 | 632 | 991 | 751 | 218 | 22 | |||||||||||||||||||||
2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Sales | Deferred income | Committed sales | Total remaining transaction price | 2020 | 2021 | 2022 and later | |||||||||||||||||||||
Courseware | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 954 | 2 | — | 2 | 2 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 696 | 118 | — | 118 | 82 | 13 | 23 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Assessments | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 174 | — | — | — | — | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time | 1,290 | 206 | 375 | 581 | 433 | 146 | 2 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Services 1 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Products transferred at a point in time | 86 | 2 | — | 2 | 2 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time – subscriptions | 310 | 11 | — | 11 | 11 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Products and services transferred over time – other ongoing performance obligations | 359 | 21 | 106 | 127 | 126 | 1 | — | |||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 3,869 | 360 | 481 | 841 | 656 | 160 | 25 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Committed sales amounts are equal to the transaction price from contracts with customers, excluding those amounts previously recognised as revenue and amounts currently recognised in deferred income. The total of committed sales and deferred income is equal to the remaining transaction price. Time bands stated above represent the expected timing of when the remaining transaction price will be recognised as revenue
.
F-3
7
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
4. Operating expenses
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
By function: | ||||||||||||
Cost of goods sold | 1,747 | 1,767 | 1,858 | |||||||||
Operating expenses | ||||||||||||
Distribution costs | 62 | 59 | 73 | |||||||||
Selling, marketing and product development costs | 521 | 572 | 631 | |||||||||
Administrative and other expenses | 802 | 816 | 999 | |||||||||
Restructuring costs | 214 | — | 157 | |||||||||
Other income | (37 | ) | (45 | ) | (54 | ) | ||||||
Total net operating expenses | 1,562 | 1,402 | 1,806 | |||||||||
Other net gains and losses | (63 | ) | (178 | ) | (16 | ) | ||||||
Total | 3,246 | 2,991 | 3,648 | |||||||||
Other income includes fr
e
ight income and sublet income.
In 2019, other income included service fee income from the Group’s then associate Penguin Random House of £4m. Included in administrative and other expenses are research and efficacy costs of £12m (2020: £11m; 2019: £13m). Other net gains and losses in 2021 largely relate to the sale of interests in PIHE in South Africa and the school business in Brazil. In 2020, other net gains and losses largely relate to the sale of the remaining interest in Pearson Random House (£180m gain). In 2019, other net gains and losses largely relate to the sale of the US K-12 business.
In March 2021, the Group announced a major restructuring programme to run in 2021, principally comprising the reorganisation of the Group into five global business divisions and the simplification of the Group’s property portfolio. In May 2017, the Group announced a major restructuring programme to run between 2017 and 2019 to drive further significant cost savings. An analysis of major restructuring costs is as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
By nature: | ||||||||||||
Product costs | 19 | 0 | 16 | |||||||||
Employee costs | 32 | 0 | 90 | |||||||||
Impairment of non-current assets | 145 | — | 14 | |||||||||
Property and facilities | 11 | 0 | 12 | |||||||||
Technology and communications | 3 | 0 | 2 | |||||||||
Professional and outsourced services | 4 | 0 | 17 | |||||||||
General and administrative costs | — | — | 6 | |||||||||
Total restructuring – operating expenses | 214 | 0 | 157 | |||||||||
Share of associate restructuring | 0 | 0 | 2 | |||||||||
Total | 214 | 0 | 159 | |||||||||
F-3
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
4. Operating expenses continued
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
By nature: | ||||||||||||||||
Royalties expensed | 185 | 191 | 242 | |||||||||||||
Other product costs | 353 | 349 | 466 | |||||||||||||
Employee benefit expense | 5 | 1,365 | 1,337 | 1,452 | ||||||||||||
Contract labour | 69 | 67 | 139 | |||||||||||||
Employee-related expense | 21 | 30 | 94 | |||||||||||||
Promotional costs | 239 | 233 | 254 | |||||||||||||
Depreciation and impairment of property, plant and equipment | 10 | 241 | 125 | 123 | ||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets – product development | 20 | 279 | 280 | 271 | ||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets – software | 11 | 117 | 112 | 115 | ||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment of intangible assets – other | 11 | 50 | 80 | 151 | ||||||||||||
Property and facilities | 124 | 85 | 96 | |||||||||||||
Technology and communications | 215 | 216 | 196 | |||||||||||||
Professional and outsourced services | 477 | 498 | 480 | |||||||||||||
Other general and administrative costs | 58 | 71 | 104 | |||||||||||||
Costs capitalised | (447 | ) | (460 | ) | (465 | ) | ||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | (63 | ) | (178 | ) | (16 | ) | ||||||||||
Other income | (37 | ) | (45 | ) | (54 | ) | ||||||||||
Total | 3,246 | 2,991 | 3,648 | |||||||||||||
During the year the Group obtained the following services from the Group’s auditors, PwC:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
The audit of parent company and consolidated financial statements | 5 | 5 | 5 | |||||||||
The audit of the company’s subsidiaries | 2 | 2 | 2 | |||||||||
Total audit fees | 7 | 7 | 7 | |||||||||
Audit-related and other assurance services | 0 | — | — | |||||||||
Other non-audit services | 0 | — | — | |||||||||
Total other services | 0 | — | — | |||||||||
Total non-audit services | 0 | — | — | |||||||||
Total | 7 | 7 | 7 | |||||||||
Reconciliation between audit and
non-audit
service fees is shown below: All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Group audit fees including fees for attestation under section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act | 7 | 7 | 7 | |||||||||
Non-audit fees | 0 | — | — | |||||||||
Total | 7 | 7 | 7 | |||||||||
F-3
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
4. Operating expenses continued
Fees for attestation under section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act are allocated between fees payable for the audits of consolidated and subsidiary accounts. Included in Group audit fees for 2020 are additional fees in relation to prior year audit work.
5. Employee information
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Employee benefit expense | ||||||||||||||||
Wages and salaries (including termination costs) | 1,180 | 1,152 | 1,258 | |||||||||||||
Social security costs | 95 | 96 | 100 | |||||||||||||
Share-based payment costs | 26 | 28 | 29 | 25 | ||||||||||||
Retirement benefits – defined contribution plans | 25 | 37 | 47 | 57 | ||||||||||||
Retirement benefits – defined benefit plans | 25 | 25 | 13 | 13 | ||||||||||||
Other post-retirement medical benefits | 25 | — | — | (1 | ) | |||||||||||
Total | 1,365 | 1,337 | 1,452 | |||||||||||||
The details of the emoluments of the Directors of Pearson plc are shown in the report on Directors’ remuneration.
Average number employed | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||||||
Employee numbers | ||||||||||||||||
UK | 3,395 | 3,304 | 3,309 | |||||||||||||
Other European countries | 878 | 886 | 927 | |||||||||||||
US | 11,757 | 11,432 | 12,286 | |||||||||||||
Canada | 593 | 648 | 694 | |||||||||||||
Asia Pacific | 2,738 | 2,812 | 2,800 | |||||||||||||
Other countries | 1,383 | 2,109 | 2,227 | |||||||||||||
Total | 20,744 | 21,191 | 22,243 | |||||||||||||
2020 and 2019 employee numbers have been restated to be on a comparable basis to the current year.
F-4
0
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
6. Net finance costs
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Interest payable on financial liabilities at amortised cost and associated derivatives | (41 | ) | (38 | ) | (22 | ) | ||||||||||
Interest on lease liabilities | (27 | ) | (41 | ) | (45 | ) | ||||||||||
Net foreign exchange losses | 0 | (6 | ) | (5 | ) | |||||||||||
Derivatives not in a hedge relationship | 0 | (22 | ) | (12 | ) | |||||||||||
Finance costs | (68 | ) | (107 | ) | (84 | ) | ||||||||||
Interest receivable on financial assets at amortised cost | 5 | 9 | 15 | |||||||||||||
Interest on lease receivables | 6 | 9 | 11 | |||||||||||||
Net finance income in respect of retirement benefits | 25 | 4 | 6 | 13 | ||||||||||||
Fair value remeasurement of disposal proceeds | 6 | 26 | — | |||||||||||||
Net foreign exchange gains | 1 | — | — | |||||||||||||
Derivatives not in a hedge relationship | 20 | 0 | 2 | |||||||||||||
Finance income | 42 | 50 | 41 | |||||||||||||
Net finance costs | (26 | ) | (57 | ) | (43 | ) | ||||||||||
Net movement in the fair value of hedges is further explained in note 16. Derivatives not in a hedge relationship include fair value movements in the interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swaps.
7. Income tax
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Current tax | ||||||||||||||||
Charge in respect of current year | (96 | ) | (18 | ) | (51 | ) | ||||||||||
Adjustments in respect of prior years | (12 | ) | 4 | 21 | ||||||||||||
Total current tax charge | (108 | ) | (14 | ) | (30 | ) | ||||||||||
Deferred tax | ||||||||||||||||
In respect of temporary differences | 98 | (28 | ) | 59 | ||||||||||||
Other adjustments in respect of prior years | 13 | (2 | ) | 5 | ||||||||||||
Total deferred tax credit/(charge) | 13 | 111 | (30 | ) | 64 | |||||||||||
Total tax credit/(charge) | 3 | (44 | ) | 34 | ||||||||||||
F-
41
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
7. Income tax continued
The adjustments in respect of prior years in 2021 2020 and 2019 primarily arise from revising the previous year’s reported tax provision to reflect the tax returns subsequently filed. This results in a change between deferred and current tax as well as an absolute benefit to the total tax charge
.
The tax on the Group’s profit before tax differs from the theoretical amount that would arise using the UK tax rate as follows:All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Profit before tax | 157 | 354 | 232 | |||||||||
Tax calculated at UK rate (2021: 19%, 2020: 19%: 2019: 19%) | (30 | ) | (67 | ) | (44 | ) | ||||||
Effect of overseas tax rates | (23 | ) | (6 | ) | (2 | ) | ||||||
Effect of UK rate change | 25 | (5 | ) | — | ||||||||
Joint venture and associate income reported net of tax | 0 | 1 | 10 | |||||||||
Intra-group financing benefit | 7 | 14 | 11 | |||||||||
Movement in provisions for tax uncertainties | 0 | 24 | 3 | |||||||||
Net expense not subject to tax | (9 | ) | (7 | ) | (10 | ) | ||||||
Gains and losses on sale of businesses not subject to tax | 4 | 21 | 57 | |||||||||
Unrecognised tax losses | 6 | (21 | ) | (17 | ) | |||||||
Benefit from changes in local tax law | 11 | — | — | |||||||||
Benefit from US accounting method changes | 11 | — | — | |||||||||
Adjustments in respect of prior years | 1 | 2 | 26 | |||||||||
Total tax credit/(charge) | 3 | (44 | ) | 34 | ||||||||
UK | 27 | 23 | (12 | ) | ||||||||
Overseas | (24 | ) | (67 | ) | 46 | |||||||
Total tax credit/(charge) | 3 | (44 | ) | 34 | ||||||||
Tax rate reflected in earnings | (1.8 | )% | 12.5 | % | (14.7 | )% | ||||||
Key judgements
Key areas of estimation
Included in net expense not subject to tax are foreign taxes not creditable, the tax impact of share-based payments and other expenses not deductible.
Factors which may affect future tax charges in tax legislation, transfer pricing regulations, the level and mix of profitability in different countries, and settlements with tax authorities.
The movement in provisions for tax uncertainties primarily reflects releases due to the expiry of relevant statutes of limitation, settlement of certain audits and the establishment of provisions for new uncertain tax positions. The current tax liability of £125m (2020: £84m; 2019: £55m) includes £104m (2020: £104m; 2019: £152m) of provisions for tax uncertainties principally in respect of several matters in the US, the UK and China. The matters provided for include the allocation between territories of proceeds of historical business disposals and the potential disallowance of
intra-group
recharges.The Group is currently under audit in several countries, and the timing of any resolution of these audits is uncertain. Of the balance of £104m, £80m relates to 2017 and earlier. In most countries, tax years up to and
F-
42
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
7. Income tax continued
including
are now statute barred from examination by tax authorities. Of the remaining balance, £
3m relates to
2018, £
13m to
2019, £
6m to
2020and £
2m to
2021. If relevant enquiry windows pass with no audit, management believes it is reasonably possible that provision levels will reduce by an estimated £
70m within the next
12months. However, the tax authorities any take a different view from management and the final liability may be greater than provided.
Contingent liabilities relating to tax are disclosed in note 34.
The tax benefit/(charge) recognised in other comprehensive income is as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations | 10 | (13 | ) | 5 | ||||||||
Fair value gain on other financial assets | (3 | ) | (6 | ) | (4 | ) | ||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations | (61 | ) | 2 | 22 | ||||||||
(54 | ) | (17 | ) | 23 | ||||||||
8. Earnings per share
Basic
Basic earnings per share is calculated by dividing the profit or loss attributable to equity shareholders of the company (earnings) by the weighted average number of ordinary shares in issue during the year, excluding ordinary shares purchased by the company and held as treasury shares.
Diluted
Diluted earnings per share is calculated by adjusting the weighted average number of ordinary shares to take account of all dilutive potential ordinary shares and adjusting the profit attributable, if applicable, to account for any tax consequences that might arise from conversion of those shares. A dilution is not calculated for a loss.
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Earnings for the year | 160 | 310 | 266 | |||||||||
Non-controlling interest | (1 | ) | 0 | (2 | ) | |||||||
Earnings attributable to equity shareholders | 159 | 310 | 264 | |||||||||
Weighted average number of shares (millions) | 754.1 | 755.4 | 777.0 | |||||||||
Effect of dilutive shares options (millions) | 5.0 | 0 | 0.5 | |||||||||
Weighted average number of shares (millions) for diluted earnings | 759.1 | 755.4 | 777.5 | |||||||||
Earnings per share (in pence per share) | ||||||||||||
Basic | 21.1p | 41.0p | 34.0p | |||||||||
Diluted | 20.9p | 41.0p | 34.0p | |||||||||
F-
43
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
9. Dividends
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Final paid in respect of prior year 13.5p (2020: 13.5p; 2019: 13.5p) | 102 | 101 | 101 | |||||||||
Interim paid in respect of current year 6.3p (2020: 6.0p; 2019: 6.0p) | 47 | 45 | 46 | |||||||||
149 | 146 | 147 | ||||||||||
The Directors are proposing a final dividend in respect of the financial year ended 31 December 2021 of 14.2p per equity shares which will absorb an estimated £107m of shareholders’ funds. It will be paid on 6 May 2022 to shareholders who are on the register of members on 25 March 2022. These financial statements do not reflect this divide
n
d.10. Property, plant and equipment
Right-of-use assets | Owned assets | |||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Land and buildings | Plant and equipment | Land and buildings | Plant and equipment | Assets in the course of construction | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
Cost | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 460 | 23 | 300 | 325 | 36 | 1,144 | ||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | (11 | ) | (2 | ) | (7 | ) | (11 | ) | (1 | ) | (32 | ) | ||||||||||||
Additions | 62 | 0 | 7 | 5 | 37 | 111 | ||||||||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | (13 | ) | (9 | ) | (23 | ) | (29 | ) | (1 | ) | (75 | ) | ||||||||||||
Reclassifications and transfers | 0 | 0 | 20 | 21 | (50 | ) | (9 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Transfer to assets classified as held for sale | (59 | ) | 0 | (1 | ) | (3 | ) | 0 | (63 | ) | ||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 439 | 12 | 296 | 308 | 21 | 1,076 | ||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | 0 | 0 | 2 | (3 | ) | 0 | (1 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Additions | 32 | 0 | 8 | 17 | 39 | 96 | ||||||||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | (6 | ) | (7 | ) | (100 | ) | (72 | ) | 0 | (185 | ) | |||||||||||||
Reclassifications and transfers | 0 | 0 | 35 | �� | 0 | (31 | ) | 4 | ||||||||||||||||
Transfer to assets classified as held for sale | 0 | 0 | (15 | ) | 0 | 0 | (15 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 465 | 5 | 226 | 250 | 29 | 975 | ||||||||||||||||||
F-
44
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
10. Property, plant and equipment continued
Right-of-use | Owned assets | |||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Land and buildings | Plant and equipment | Land and buildings | Plant and equipment | Assets in the course of construction | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
Depreciation and impairment | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | (58 | ) | (16 | ) | (200 | ) | (252 | ) | 0 | (526 | ) | |||||||||||||
Exchange differences | 2 | 1 | 6 | 9 | 0 | 18 | ||||||||||||||||||
Charge for the year | (65 | ) | (3 | ) | (25 | ) | (32 | ) | 0 | (125 | ) | |||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | 1 | 9 | 22 | 29 | 0 | 61 | ||||||||||||||||||
Reclassifications and transfers | 0 | 0 | (2 | ) | 2 | 0 | 0 | |||||||||||||||||
Impairment of assets to be classified as held for sale | (4 | ) | 0 | 0 | 0 | 0 | (4 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Transfer to assets classified as held for sale | 14 | 0 | 0 | 1 | 0 | 15 | ||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | (110 | ) | (9 | ) | (199 | ) | (243 | ) | 0 | (561 | ) | |||||||||||||
Exchange differences | (1 | ) | 1 | (1 | ) | 1 | 0 | 0 | ||||||||||||||||
Charge for the year | (46 | ) | (3 | ) | (16 | ) | (30 | ) | 0 | (95 | ) | |||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | 7 | 6 | 99 | 71 | 0 | 183 | ||||||||||||||||||
Reclassifications and transfers | 0 | 0 | (5 | ) | 7 | 0 | 2 | |||||||||||||||||
Impairment | (119 | ) | 0 | (22 | ) | (5 | ) | 0 | (146 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Transfer to assets classified as held for sale | 0 | 0 | 8 | 0 | 0 | 8 | ||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | (269 | ) | (5 | ) | (136 | ) | (199 | ) | 0 | (609 | ) | |||||||||||||
Carrying amounts | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 402 | 7 | 100 | 73 | 36 | 618 | ||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 329 | 3 | 97 | 65 | 21 | 515 | ||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 196 | 0 | 90 | 51 | 29 | 366 | ||||||||||||||||||
Key areas of estimation
right-of-use
Depreciation expense of £40m (2020: £44m) has been included in the income statement in cost of goods sold and £55m (2020: £81m) in operating expenses. The impairment charge of £146m (2020: £NaN) has been included within operating expenses within the income statement.
Property, plant and equipment assets are assessed for impairment triggers annually or when triggering events occur. In 2021, as part of a major restructuring programme, the Group simplified its property portfolio, reducing the overall office space required. All property related assets were assessed for impairment as a result of this triggering event and impairment charges of £141m have been recognised within costs of major restructuring (see note 4 for details). The recoverability of certain of the Group’sassets is now based on the Group’s ability to sublease vacant space
right-of-use
.
This involves the use of assumptions related to future subleases including the achievable rent, lease start dates, lease incentives such as rent free periods and the discount rate applied. Should the future sublease outcomes be more or less favourable than the assumptions used by management this could result in additional impairment charges or reversals of impairment charges.
F-
45
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
10. Property, plant and equipment continued
Where there is vacant space in thethe Group estimates that a 1% increase/decrease in the discount rate used would reduce/increase the recoverable value of theassets by £10m. In addition, the Group estimates that a three month reduction/increase in the net sublet income (which could arise from changes to the achievable rent, lease incentives or sublet start dates) would reduce/increase the recoverable value of theassets by £6m.
right-of-use-assets,
right-of-use
right-of-use
11. Intangible assets
All figures in £ millions | Goodwill | Software | Acquired customer lists, contracts and relationships | Acquired trademarks and brands | Acquired publishing rights | Other intangibles acquired | Total | |||||||||||||||||||||
Cost | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 2,139 | 1,039 | 793 | 238 | 179 | 413 | 4,801 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | (45 | ) | (24 | ) | (25 | ) | (19 | ) | (2 | ) | (48 | ) | (163 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Additions – internal development | — | 80 | — | — | — | — | 80 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Additions – purchased | — | 1 | — | — | — | — | 1 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | — | (6 | ) | (17 | ) | (21 | ) | (80 | ) | (16 | ) | (140 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Transfers | — | 14 | — | — | — | — | 14 | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 2,094 | 1,104 | 751 | 198 | 97 | 349 | 4,593 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | 8 | 5 | 4 | (2 | ) | 0 | (2 | ) | 13 | |||||||||||||||||||
Additions – internal development | — | 110 | — | — | — | — | 110 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Additions – purchased | — | 2 | — | — | — | — | 2 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | — | (135 | ) | 0 | (25 | ) | 0 | (43 | ) | (203 | ) | |||||||||||||||||
Acquisition of subsidiary | 43 | — | — | — | — | 27 | 70 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Disposal of subsidiary | — | — | (14 | ) | (3 | ) | — | (10 | ) | (27 | ) | |||||||||||||||||
Transfers | — | 1 | — | — | — | — | 1 | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 2,145 | 1,087 | 741 | 168 | 97 | 321 | 4,559 | |||||||||||||||||||||
F-4
6
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
11. Intangible assets continued
All figures in £ millions | Goodwill | Software | Acquired customer lists, contracts and relationships | Acquired trademarks and brands | Acquired publishing rights | Other intangibles acquired | Total | |||||||||||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | — | (588 | ) | (588 | ) | (178 | ) | (176 | ) | (371 | ) | (1,901 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | — | 18 | 23 | 13 | 2 | 46 | 102 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Charge for the year | — | (112 | ) | (44 | ) | (14 | ) | (2 | ) | (8 | ) | (180 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Impairment charge | — | — | (2 | ) | — | — | (10 | ) | (12 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||
Disposals | — | 6 | 17 | 21 | 81 | 15 | 140 | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | — | (676 | ) | (594 | ) | (158 | ) | (95 | ) | (328 | ) | (1,851 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | — | (5 | ) | (4 | ) | 1 | (1 | ) | 4 | (5 | ) | |||||||||||||||||
Charge for the year | — | (113 | ) | (34 | ) | (8 | ) | 0 | (8 | ) | (163 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Impairment charge | — | (4 | ) | 0 | — | — | 0 | (4 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||
Disposals and retirements | — | 135 | — | 25 | — | 43 | 203 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Disposal of subsidiary | — | — | 12 | 2 | — | 10 | 24 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Transfers | — | 6 | — | — | — | — | 6 | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | — | (657 | ) | (620 | ) | (138 | ) | (96 | ) | (279 | ) | (1,790 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Carrying amounts | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 2,139 | 451 | 205 | 60 | 3 | 42 | 2,900 | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 2,094 | 428 | 157 | 40 | 2 | 21 | 2,742 | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 2,145 | 430 | 121 | 30 | 1 | 42 | 2,769 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Goodwill
The goodwill carrying value of £2,145m (2020: £2,094m) relates to acquisitions completed after 1 January 1998. Prior to 1 January 1998, all goodwill was written off to reserves on the date of acquisition. For acquisitions completed between 1 January 1998 and 31 December 2002, no value was ascribed to intangibles other than goodwill which was amortised over a period of up to 20 years. On adoption of IFRS on 1 January 2003, the Group chose not to restate the goodwill balance and at that date the balance was frozen (i.e. amortisation ceased). If goodwill had been restated, then a significant value would have been ascribed to other intangible assets, which would be subject to amortisation, and the carrying value of goodwill would be significantly lower. For acquisitions completed after 1 January 2003, value has been ascribed to other intangible assets which are amortised.
Software and acquired intangible assets
Acquired intangible assets are valued separately for each acquisition and the primary method of valuation used is the discounted cash flow method. The majority of acquired intangibles are amortised using an amortisation profile based on the projected cash flows underlying the acquisition date valuation of the intangible asset, which generally results in a larger proportion of amortisation being recognised in the early years of the asset’s life. The Group keeps the expected pattern of consumption under review. Other intangibles acquired includes technology.
Amortisation of £25m (2020: £22m) is included in the income statement in cost of goods sold and £138m (2020: £158m) in operating expenses. Impairment charges of £4m (2020: £12m) are included in operating expenses within the income statement, of which £4m (2020: £NaN) relates to software, £0nil (2020: £2m) relates to customer lists, contracts and relationships, and £0nil (2020: £10m) to other intangibles acquired.
F-4
7
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
11. Intangible assets continued
Software and acquired intangible assets continued
The range of useful economic lives for each major class of intangible asset (excluding goodwill and software) is shown below:
2021 | ||||
Useful economic life | ||||
Class of intangible asset | ||||
Acquired customer lists, contracts and relationships | 3-20 years | |||
Acquired trademarks and brands | 2-20 years | |||
Acquired publishing rights | 5-20 years | |||
Other intangibles acquired | 2-20 years |
The expected amortisation profile of acquired intangible assets i
s
shown below:2021 | ||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | One to five years | Six to ten years | Total | |||||||||
Class of intangible asset | ||||||||||||
Acquired customer lists, contracts and relationships | 92 | 29 | 121 | |||||||||
Acquired trademarks and brands | 24 | 6 | 30 | |||||||||
Acquired publishing rights | 1 | — | 1 | |||||||||
Other intangibles acquired | 27 | 15 | 42 |
Impairment tests for cash-generating units (CGUs) containing goodwill
Impairment tests have been carried out where appropriate as described below. Goodwill was allocated to CGUs, or an aggregation of CGUs, where goodwill could not be reasonably allocated to individual business units. CGUs have been revised in 2021. Impairment reviews were conducted on these revised CGUs as summarised below:
2021 CGUs
2021 | ||||
All figures in £ millions | Goodwill | |||
Assessment & Qualifications | 1,198 | |||
Virtual Learning | 395 | |||
English Language Learning | 153 | |||
Workforce Skills | 223 | |||
Higher Education | 68 | |||
Strategic Review (includes the separate CGUs of China, India, South Africa, Canada and Other Strategic Review) | 108 | |||
Total | 2,145 | |||
F-4
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
11. Intangible assets continued
2020 CGUs
2020 | ||||
All figures in £ millions | Goodwill | |||
North American Courseware | — | |||
OPM | 18 | |||
Virtual Schools | 374 | |||
Assessments | 1,002 | |||
International (includes the separate CGUs of Brazil, China, India and South Africa) | 700 | |||
Total | 2,094 | |||
Goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment. The recoverable amount of each aggregated CGU is based on the higher of value in use and fair value less costs of disposal. The value in use was higher than the fair value less costs of disposal in each of the CGUs. Other than goodwill there are no intangible assets with indefinite lives. No impairments of goodwill were recorded in 2021 or 2020. In 2020, impairment charges of £12m were recognised in relation to acquired intangibles.
Key judgements
Key areas of estimation
Determination of CGUs and reallocation of goodwill
Pearson identifies its CGUs based on its operating model and how data is collected and reviewed for management reporting and strategic planning purposes in accordance with IAS 36 ‘Impairment of Assets’. In 2021, the CGUs and aggregations of CGUs were revised to take into account the announcement and implementation of a new strategy including five new business divisions and a strategic review division. The newly created CGUs and CGU aggregations reflect the level at which goodwill is monitored by management.
Goodwill has been reallocated to the new CGUs and aggregations of CGUs. The majority of the goodwill balances have been directly mapped from one previous CGU (or CGU aggregation) to one newly created CGU (or CGU aggregation). Where it was not possible to directly map the goodwill it has been reallocated using a relative value method. The key area where the relative value method has been used is for the goodwill related to the previous International CGU aggregation which has been reallocated across the newly created CGU aggregations where applicable.
Key assumptions
For the purpose of estimating the value in use of the CGUs, management has used an income approach based on present value techniques. The calculations use cash flow projections based on financial budgets approved by management covering a five-year period.
F-4
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
11. Intangible assets continued
Key assumptions continued
The key assumptions used by management in the value in use calculations were:
Discount rates
pre-tax
discount rates range from 8.9% to 17.1% (2020:pre-tax
9.3% to 17.2%). Discount rates are generally lower for those businesses which operate in more mature markets with low inflation and generally higher for those operating in emerging markets with higher inflation.Perpetuity growth rates
The key assumptions used by management in setting the financial budgets were as follows:
Forecast sales growth rates
COVID-19
recovery in Assessment & Qualifications and English Language Learning, growth driven by recent acquisitions in Workforce Skills, and ongoing pressures in Higher Education partially offset by recapture of the secondary market. The sales forecasts use average nominal growth rates oflow-mid
single digits for mature businesses in mature markets,mid-high
single digits for emerging businesses in mature markets,low-high
single digits for mature businesses in emerging markets, and low double digits for Workforce Skills where there is significant organic investment and inorganic investment related to the acquisition of Faethm.Operating profits
COVID-19
pandemic. Management have considered the impact of climate change risks (including physical and transition risks and the costs associated with achieving the Group’s net zero commitment) and are satisfied that any related costs will not materially impact the Group’s profit forecasts or impairment judgements at 31 December 2021.The table below shows the key assumptions used by management in the value in use calculations.
Discount rate | Perpetuity growth rate | |||||||
Assessment & Qualifications | 11.2 | % | 2.0 | % | ||||
Virtual Learning | 10.9 | % | 2.0 | % | ||||
English Language Learning | 9.1 | % | 3.0 | % | ||||
Workforce Skills | 8.9 | % | 2.0 | % | ||||
Higher Education | 11.1 | % | 2.0 | % | ||||
Strategic Review | 8.9 - 17.1 | % | 2.0 - 5.0 | % |
F-
50
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
11. Intangible assets continued
Sensitivities
Impairment testing for the year ended 31 December 2021 has shown none of the CGUs, or groups of CGUs, as being sensitive to reasonably possible changes in key assumptions, including those related to climate change.
The assets held in the Strategic Review CGUs are subject to a possible disposal process. Given the stage of the process the related assets have not been classified as held for sale at 31 December 2021. Valuation estimates obtained as part of this process were used by management to determine a fair value less costs to dispose valuation. This fair value less costs to dispose valuation results in a lower headroom position than the value in use method, however, it does not indicate impairment in any of the Strategic Review CGUs.
12. Investments in joint ventures and associates
The amounts recognised in the balance sheet are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Associates | 24 | 6 | ||||||
Total | 24 | 6 | ||||||
The amounts recognised in the income statement are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Associates | 1 | 5 | ||||||
Total | 1 | 5 | ||||||
The Group has no material associates or joint ventures.
In 2021, the Group acquired two associates. The largest of these is a 40% interest in the Academy of Pop (AOP) that was entered into on 31 August 2021, and had a year end carrying amount of £10m, of which £7m was still to be paid as at 31 December 2021 (see note 36). AOP is incorporated in Delaware and is a Limited Liability Company. It was set up with XIX Entertainment to create a new entertainment driven performing arts learning platform, which will offer coaching from renowned instructors, with a combination of physical locations and online learning.
The Group’s 25% interest in Penguin Random House was disposed of in April 2020 (see note 31). Funds loaned to Penguin Random House were repaid at the point of disposal. Prior to the completion of the sale of Penguin Random House, the Group received dividends of £1m from Penguin Random House.
There were no other material transactions with associates or joint ventures during 2021 or 2020.
13. Deferred income tax
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Deferred income tax assets | 57 | 32 | ||||||
Deferred income tax liabilities | (40 | ) | (62 | ) | ||||
Net deferred income tax asset/(liability) | 17 | (30 | ) | |||||
Substantially all of the deferred income tax assets are expected to be recovered after more than one year.
F-
51
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
13. Deferred income tax continued
Deferred income tax assets and liabilities shall be offset when there is a legally enforceable right to offset current income tax assets with current income tax liabilities and where the deferred income taxes relate to the same fiscal authority. At 31 December 2021, the Group has gross tax losses for which no deferred tax asset is recognised of £166m (2020: £166m) in respect of UK losses, £391m (2020: £369m) in respect of US losses and approximately £164m (2020: £300m) in respect of losses in other territories. The UK losses are capital losses which can be carried forward indefinitely. The US losses relate to federal and state taxes. Federal tax losses can be carried forward indefinitely; certain state tax losses may have expiry periods between one and 20 years.
In the UK March Budget 2021, the Government announced that from 1 April 2023 the UK corporation tax rate will increase to 25%, and this was substantively enacted on 24 May 2021. UK deferred tax balances have been remeasured at the enacted rate. The UK corporation tax rate increase has resulted in an increase of £27m in the UK deferred tax liability associated with the UK Group pension plan asset position, which has been recognised in other comprehensive income. The UK corporation tax rate change is beneficial to the Group’s statutory tax rate as it increases the value of certain UK tax attributes of the Group, such as tax losses.
Other gross deductible temporary for which no deferred tax asset is recognised total £22m (2020: £56m). The amount of temporary differences associated with subsidiaries for which no deferred tax has been provided is not material.
Deferred income tax assets of £19m (2020: £20m) have been recognised in countries that reported a tax loss in either the current or preceding year. This primarily arises in Brazil in respect of tax deductible goodwill and tax losses. It is considered more likely than not that there will be sufficient future taxable profits to realise these assets.
The recognition of the deferred income tax assets is supported by management’s forecasts of the future profitability of the relevant countries. In some cases deferred income tax assets are forecast to be recovered through taxable profits over a period that exceeds five years. Management consider these forecasts are sufficiently reliable to support the recovery of the assets. Where there are insufficient forecasts of future profits, deferred income tax assets have not been recognised.
The movement in deferred income tax assets and liabilities during the year is as follows:
All figures in £ millions | Trading losses | Accruals and other provisions | Retirement benefit obligations | Deferred revenue | Goodwill and intangibles | Interest limitations | Other | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Deferred income tax assets/ (liabilities) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 89 | 34 | (38 | ) | 41 | (199 | ) | 57 | 27 | 11 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | 2 | (3 | ) | (1 | ) | (2 | ) | 2 | (4 | ) | (2 | ) | (8 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||
Income statement (charge)/benefit | (44 | ) | 4 | (12 | ) | 6 | (12 | ) | 23 | 5 | (30 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||
Tax benefit/(charge) in other comprehensive income | — | — | 2 | — | — | — | (5 | ) | (3 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 47 | 35 | (49 | ) | 45 | (209 | ) | 76 | 25 | (30 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | — | (1 | ) | — | — | (2 | ) | — | 2 | (1 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
Acquisition of subsidiaries | 1 | — | — | — | 4 | — | — | 5 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Income statement benefit/(charge) | 34 | 30 | 2 | 7 | 29 | (21 | ) | 30 | 111 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Tax charge in other comprehensive income | — | — | (61 | ) | — | — | — | (7 | ) | (68 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 82 | 64 | (108 | ) | 52 | (178 | ) | 55 | 50 | 17 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
F-
52
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
13. Deferred income tax continued
Other deferred income tax items include temporary differences in respect of share-based payments, depreciation and royalty advance
s
.As at 31 December 2021, 0 deferred income tax assets or liabilities were classified as held for sale (2020: £NaN).
14. Classification of financial instruments
The accounting classification of each class of the Group’s financial assets, and their carrying values, is as
follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fair value | Amortised cost | Fair value | Amortised cost | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Notes | Fair value through other comprehensive income | Fair value through profit and loss | Fair value – hedging instrument | Financial assets | Total carrying value | Fair value through other comprehensive income | Fair value through profit and loss | Fair value – hedging instrument | Financial assets | Total carrying value | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Investments in unlisted securities | 15 | 113 | — | — | — | 113 | 138 | — | — | — | 138 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents | 17 | — | 84 | — | 853 | 937 | — | 93 | — | 1,004 | 1,097 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments | 16 | — | 0 | 32 | — | 32 | — | 2 | 61 | — | 63 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Trade receivables | 22 | — | — | — | 854 | 854 | — | — | — | 803 | 803 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Investment in finance lease receivable | 22 | — | 0 | — | 115 | �� | 115 | — | 0 | — | 130 | 130 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other receivable | — | 87 | — | 0 | 87 | — | 96 | — | — | 96 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total financial assets | 113 | 171 | 32 | 1,822 | 2,138 | 138 | 191 | 61 | 1,937 | 2,327 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
The carrying value of the Group’s financial assets is equal to, or approximately equal to, the market value. The other receivable relates to the receivable which arose on the disposal of the US
K-12
business and is included in current other receivables in note 22.The accounting classification of each class of the Group’s financial liabilities, together with their carrying values and market values, is as follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fair value | Amortised cost | Fair value | Amortised cost | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Notes | Fair value through profit and loss | Fair value – hedging instrument | Other financial liabilities | Total carrying value | Total market value | Fair value through profit and loss | Fair value – hedging instrument | Other financial liabilities | Total carrying value | Total market value | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments | 16 | (12 | ) | (22 | ) | — | (34 | ) | (34 | ) | (30 | ) | (22 | ) | — | (52 | ) | (52 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||
Trade payables | 24 | — | — | (351 | ) | (351 | ) | (351 | ) | — | — | (340 | ) | (340 | ) | (340 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Bank loans and overdrafts | 18 | — | — | 0 | 0 | 0 | — | — | (3 | ) | (3 | ) | (3 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other borrowings due within one year | 18 | — | — | (155 | ) | (155 | ) | (155 | ) | — | — | (251 | ) | (251 | ) | (249 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Borrowings due after more than one year | 18 | — | — | (1,245 | ) | (1,245 | ) | (1,276 | ) | — | — | (1,397 | ) | (1,397 | ) | (1,451 | ) | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total financial liabilities | (12 | ) | (22 | ) | (1,751 | ) | (1,785 | ) | (1,816 | ) | (30 | ) | (22 | ) | (1,991 | ) | (2,043 | ) | (2,095 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
The market value of leases has been stated at book value.
F-
53
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
14. Classification of financial instruments continued
Fair value measurement
As shown above, the Group’s derivative assets and liabilities, unlisted securities and marketable securities are held at fair value. Financial instruments that are measured subsequently to initial recognition at fair value are grouped into levels 1 to 3, based on the degree to which the fair value is observable, as follows:
Level 1 fair value measurements are those derived from unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities.
Level 2 fair value measurements are those derived from inputs, other than quoted prices included within level 1, that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly (as prices) or indirectly (derived from prices).
Level 3 fair value measurements are those derived from valuation techniques that include inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (unobservable inputs).
The Group’s bonds valued at £767m (2020: £965m) and money market funds of £84m (2020: £93m) included within cash and cash equivalents are classified as level 1. The Group’s derivative assets valued at £32m (2020: £63m) and derivative liabilities valued at £34m (2020: £52m) are classified as level 2. The Group’s investments in unlisted securities are valued at £113m (2020: £138m) and the other receivable is valued at £87m (2020: £96m); both are classified as level 3.
The following table analyses the movements in level 3 fair value remeasurements:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Other receivable | Investments in unlisted securities | Total | Total | ||||||||||||
At beginning of year | 96 | 138 | 234 | 304 | ||||||||||||
Exchange differences | 1 | 1 | 2 | (11 | ) | |||||||||||
Acquisition of investments and other receivable | — | 4 | 4 | 6 | ||||||||||||
Disposal of investments and other payables | (16 | ) | (54 | ) | (70 | ) | (105 | ) | ||||||||
Fair value movements | 6 | 24 | 30 | 40 | ||||||||||||
At end of year | 87 | 113 | 200 | 234 | ||||||||||||
The fair value of the investments in unlisted securities is determined by reference to the financial performance of the underlying asset, recent funding rounds and amounts realised on the sale of similar assets.
On initial recognition, the fair value of the other receivable, which arose on the disposal of the US
K-12
business, was determined using present value techniques whereby the expected value of future cash flows was discounted using a rate which is representative of the creditworthiness of the USK-12
business. During the year, the Group received £16m as a partial repayment, with the remaining amounts reclassified as a current asset. The receivable was repaid in January 2022 (see note 37).15. Other financial assets
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
At beginning of year | 138 | 122 | ||||||
Exchange differences | 1 | (4 | ) | |||||
Acquisition of investments | 4 | 6 | ||||||
Disposal of investments | (54 | ) | — | |||||
Fair value movements | 24 | 14 | ||||||
At end of year | 113 | 138 | ||||||
F-
54
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
15. Other financial assets continued
Other financial assets are unlisted securities of £113m (2020: £138m)
that are classified at fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI). The assets, which are not held for trading, relate to the Group’s interests in new and innovative educational ventures across the world. These are strategic investments and the Group considers the classification as FVOCI to be more relevant. None of the investments are individually significant to the financial statements and therefore sensitivities have not been provided.
16. Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting
The Group’s approach to the management of financial risks is set out in note 19. The Group’s outstanding derivative financial instruments are as follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Gross notional amounts | Assets | Liabilities | Gross notional amounts | Assets | Liabilities | ||||||||||||||||||
Interest rate derivatives – in a fair value hedge relationship | 168 | 5 | — | 354 | 12 | — | ||||||||||||||||||
Interest rate derivatives – not in a hedge relationship | 217 | — | (9 | ) | 550 | — | (27 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Cross-currency rate derivatives – in a hedge relationship | 331 | 24 | (21 | ) | 516 | 44 | (20 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
FX derivatives – in a hedge relationship | 237 | 3 | (1 | ) | 193 | 5 | (2 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
FX derivatives – not in a hedge relationship | 193 | — | (3 | ) | 361 | 2 | (3 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,146 | 32 | (34 | ) | 1,974 | 63 | (52 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Analysed as expiring: | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
In less than one year | 393 | 2 | (4 | ) | 1,238 | 18 | (12 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Later than one year and not later than five years | 679 | 30 | (26 | ) | 663 | 45 | (32 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Later than five years | 74 | — | (4 | ) | 73 | — | (8 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,146 | 32 | (34 | ) | 1,974 | 63 | (52 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
The Group’s treasury policies only allow derivatives to be traded where the objective is risk mitigation. These are then designated for hedge accounting using the following criteria:
• | Where interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swaps are used to convert fixed rate debt to floating and we expect to receive inflows equal to the fixed rate debt interest, these are classified as fair value hedges |
• | Where derivatives are used to create a future foreign currency liability to provide protection against currency movements affecting the valuation of an overseas investment, these are designated as a net investment hedge |
• | If the derivative and the underlying hedged exposure would normally be revalued through the income statement and valuation changes are expected to be perfectly or near perfectly equal and opposite, these will not be classified in a hedge relationship. |
The Group’s fixed rate USD debt is held as fixed rate instruments at amortised cost.
At 31 December 2021, £173m of the Group’s fixed rate euro debt is converted to a floating rate exposure using interest rate and cross-currency swaps. The Group receives interest under its euro debt related swap contracts to match the interest of 1.375% on its euro 2025 notes and, in turn, pays a floating USD LIBOR+ a spread of 1.36%.
F-
55
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
16. Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting continued
USD interest rate swaps are subsequently used to fix an element of the interest charge. The
all-in
rates (including the spread above LIBOR) that the Group pays is circa 3.6%. In addition to this, the Group has executed additional interest rate swaps to offset the floating rate borrowings paying circa 2%. At 31 December 2021, the Group had interest rate swap contracts to fix £217m of debt and a further £590m of outstanding fixed rate bonds, bringing the total fixed rate debt to £807m. These fixed interest rate derivatives are not designated in hedging relationships. Additionally, the Group uses FX derivatives including forwards, collars and cross-currency swaps to create synthetic USD debt as a hedge of its USD assets and to achieve certainty of USD currency conversion rates, in line with the Group’s FX hedging policy. Outstanding contracts as at 31 December 2021 were held at an average GBP:USD rate of 1.46. The Group also uses FX derivatives to create synthetic BRL debt as a hedge of BRL assets; these are held at an average GBP:BRL rate of 7.71. These derivatives are in designated net investment hedging relationships. The weighted average rate achieved for the bonds in a net investment hedge relationship was GBP:USD 1.59 for the USD bonds and EUR:GBP 0.86 for the euro bonds. Outstanding contracts on the cross-currency swaps at 31 December 2021 were held at an average EUR:GBP rate of 0.72. These derivatives are in designated fair value hedging relationships.The Group’s portfolio of rate derivatives is diversified by maturity, counterparty and type. Natural offsets between transaction within the portfolio and the designation of certain derivatives as hedge significantly reduce the risk of income statement volatility. The sensitivity of the portfolio to changes in market rates is set out in note 19.
Fair value hedges
The Group uses interest rate swaps and cross-currency swaps as fair value hedges of the Group’s euro issued debt.
Interest rate exposure arises from movements in the fair value of the Group’s euro debt attributable to movements in euro interest rates. The hedged risk is the change in the euro bonds fair value attributable to interest rate movements. The hedged items are the Group’s euro bonds which are issued at a fixed rate. The hedging instruments are fixed to floating euro interest rate swaps where the Group receives fixed interest payments and pays three-month Euribor.
As the critical terms of the interest rate swaps match the bonds, there is an expectation that the value of the hedging instrument and the value of the hedged item will move in the opposite direction as a result of movements in the zero coupon Euribor curve. The hedge ratio is therefore expected to be 100%. Potential sources of hedge ineffectiveness are a reduction or modification in the hedged item or a material change in the credit risk of swap counterparties.
A foreign currency exposure arises from foreign exchange fluctuations on translation of the Group’s euro debt into GBP. The hedged risk is the risk of changes in the GBPEUR spot rate that will result in changes in the value of the euro debt when translated into GBP. The hedged items are a portion of the Group’s euro bonds. The hedging instruments are floating cross currency swaps which mitigates an exposure to the effect of euro strengthening against GBP within the hedge item.
As the critical terms of the cross-currency swap match the bonds, there is an expectation that the value of the hedging instrument and the value of the hedged item move in the opposite direction as a result of movements in the EUR:GBP exchange rate. The hedge ratio is 100%. Potential source of hedge ineffectiveness are a reduction or modification in the hedge item or a material change in the credit risk of swap counterparties.
F-5
6
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
16. Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting continued
Fair value hedges continued
The Group held the following instruments to hedge exposures to changes in interest rates and foreign currency risk associated with borrowings:
2021 | ||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying amount of hedging instruments | Change in fair value of hedging instrument used to determine hedge ineffectiveness | Nominal amounts of hedging instruments | |||||||||
Derivative financial instruments for interest rate risk | 5 | (5 | ) | 168 | ||||||||
Derivative financial instruments for currency risk | 24 | (20 | ) | 168 | ||||||||
2020 | ||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying amount of hedging instruments | Change in fair value of hedging instrument used to determine hedge ineffectiveness | Nominal amounts of hedging instruments | |||||||||
Derivative financial instruments for interest rate risk | 12 | — | 354 | |||||||||
Derivative financial instruments for currency risk | 44 | 19 | 354 |
The amounts at the reporting date relating to items designated as hedge items were as follows:
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying amount of hedged items | Accumulated amount of fair value hedge adjustments on the hedged item included in the carrying amount | Change in fair value of hedged item used to determine hedge ineffectiveness | Hedge ineffectiveness | Line item in profit or loss that includes hedge ineffectiveness | |||||||||||||||
Interest rate risk | ||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | (173 | ) | (4 | ) | 5 | 0 | 0n/a | |||||||||||||
Currency risk | ||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | (173 | ) | n/a | 20 | 0 | 0n/a | ||||||||||||||
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying amount of hedged items | Accumulated amount of fair value hedge adjustments on the hedged item included in the carrying amount | Change in fair value of hedged item used to determine hedge ineffectiveness | Hedge ineffectiveness | Line item in profit or loss that includes hedge ineffectiveness | |||||||||||||||
Interest rate risk | ||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | (367 | ) | (9 | ) | 0 | 0 | 0n/a | |||||||||||||
Currency risk | ||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | (367 | ) | n/a | (19 | ) | 0 | 0n/a |
F-5
7
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
16. Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting continued
Hedge of net investment in a foreign operation
A foreign currency exposure arises from the translation of the Group’s net investments in its subsidiaries which have USD, EUR and BRL functional currencies. The hedged risk is the risk of changes in the GBPUSD, GBPEUR and GBPBRL spot rates that will result in changes in the value of the Group’s net investment in its USD, EUR and BRL assets when translated into GBP. The hedged items are a portion of the Group’s assets which are denominated in USD, EUR and BRL. The hedging instruments are debt and derivative financial instruments, including cross-currency swaps, FX forwards (including
non-deliverable
forwards) and FX collars, which mitigates an exposure to the effect of a weakening USD, EUR or BRL on the hedged item against GBP.It is expected that the change in value of each of these items will mirror each other as there is a clear and direct economic relationship between the hedging instrument and the hedged item in the hedge relationship.
Hedge ineffectiveness would arise if the value of the hedged items fell below the value of the hedging instruments; however, this is unlikely as the value of the Group’s assets denominated in USD, EUR and BRL is significantly greater than the proposed net investment programme.
The amounts related to items designated as hedging instruments were as follows:
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying amount of hedging instruments | Change in value of hedging instrument used to determine hedge ineffectiveness | Nominal amounts of hedging instruments | Hedging gains/(losses) recognised in OCI | Hedge ineffectiveness recognised in profit or loss | |||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments | (19 | ) | (2 | ) | (400 | ) | (2 | ) | 0 | |||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | (240 | ) | 4 | (240 | ) | 4 | 0 |
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying amount of hedging instruments | Change in value of hedging instrument used to determine hedge ineffectiveness | Nominal amounts of hedging instruments | Hedging gains/(losses) recognised in OCI | Hedge ineffectiveness recognised in profit or loss | |||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments | (17 | ) | 3 | (355 | ) | 3 | 0 | |||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | (246 | ) | 1 | (246 | ) | 1 | 0 |
In addition to the above, £9m (2020: £15m) of hedging gains were recognised in OCI in relation to derivative financial instruments that matured during the year. In 2020, £14m of losses accumulated in the translation reserve are reclassified to the income statement as a result of the disposal of Penguin Random House. Included in the translation reserve is a cost of hedging reserve relating to the time value of FX collars which is not separately disclosed due to materiality. The value of that reserve will decrease over the life of the hedge transaction. The balance as at 1 January and 31 December 2021 was £1m.
F-5
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
16. Derivative financial instruments and hedge accounting continued
Offsetting arrangements with derivative counterparties
All of the Group’s derivative financial instruments are subject to enforceable netting arrangements with individual counterparties, allowing net settlement in the event of default of either party. Derivative financial assets and liabilities subject to offsetting arrangements are as follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Gross derivative assets | Gross derivative liabilities | Net derivative assets/ liabilities | Gross derivative assets | Gross derivative liabilities | Net derivative assets/ liabilities | ||||||||||||||||||
Counterparties in an asset position | 17 | (12 | ) | 5 | 35 | (10 | ) | 25 | ||||||||||||||||
Counterparties in a liability position | 15 | (22 | ) | (7 | ) | 28 | (42 | ) | (14 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Total as presented in the balance sheet | 32 | (34 | ) | (2 | ) | 63 | (52 | ) | 11 | |||||||||||||||
All of the Group’s derivative financial instruments are subject to enforceable netting arrangements with individual counterparties, allowing net settlement in the event of default of either party. Offset arrangements in respect of cas
h
balances are described in note 17.Counterparty exposure from all derivatives is managed, together with that from deposits and bank account balances, within credit limits that reflect published credit ratings and by reference to other market measures (e.g. market prices for credit default swaps) to ensure that there is no significant exposure to any one counterparty’s credit risk.
The Group has no material embedded derivatives that are required to be separately accounted for in accordance with IFRS 9 ‘Financial Instruments’.
17. Cash and cash equivalents (excluding overdrafts)
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Cash at bank and in hand | 660 | 599 | ||||||
Short-term bank deposits | 277 | 498 | ||||||
937 | 1,097 | |||||||
Short-term bank deposits are invested with banks and earn interest at the prevailing short-term deposit rates.
At the end of 2021, the currency split of cash and cash equivalents was US dollar 37% (2020: 14%), sterling 24% (2020: 64%), and other 39% (2020: 22%).
Cash and cash equivalents have fair values that approximate to their carrying value due to their short-term nature.
Cash and cash equivalents include the following for the purpose of the cash flow statement:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Cash and cash equivalents | 937 | 1,116 | ||||||
Bank overdrafts | — | (3 | ) | |||||
937 | 1,113 | |||||||
F-5
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
17. Cash and cash equivalents (excluding overdrafts) continued
There is 0 cash and cash equivalents balance classified as held for sale (2020: £19m). The Group has certain cash pooling arrangements in US dollars, sterling and Canadian dollars where both the company and the bank have a legal right of offset. Offsetting amounts are presented gross in the balance sheet. Offset arrangements in respect of derivatives are shown in note 16.
18. Financial liabilities – borrowings
The Group’s current and
non-current
borrowings are as follows:All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Non-current | ||||||||
3.75% US dollar notes 2022 117 | — | 86 | ||||||
3.25% US dollar notes 2023 (nominal amount $94m) | 70 | 69 | ||||||
1.375% euro notes 2025 (nominal amount €300m) | 257 | 279 | ||||||
3.75% GBP notes 2030 (nominal amount £350m) | 353 | 353 | ||||||
Lease liabilities (see note 35) | 565 | 610 | ||||||
1,245 | 1,397 | |||||||
Current (due within one year or on demand) | ||||||||
Bank loans and overdrafts | — | 3 | ||||||
1.875% euro notes 2021 (nominal amount €195m) | — | 178 | ||||||
3.75% US dollar notes 2022 (nominal amount $117m) | 87 | — | ||||||
Lease liabilities (see note 35) | 68 | 73 | ||||||
155 | 254 | |||||||
Total borrowings | 1,400 | 1,651 | ||||||
Included in the
non-current
borrowings above is £10m of accrued interest (2020: £11m). Included in the current borrowings above is £0.5m of accrued interest (2020: £2m). In addition to the above, there areno
non-current
borrowings (2020: £66
m) or current borrowings (2020: £3
m) classified as held for sale. The maturities of the Group’snon-current
borrowings are as follows:All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Between one and two years | 140 | 160 | ||||||
Between two and five years | 435 | 531 | ||||||
Over five years | 670 | 706 | ||||||
1,245 | 1,397 | |||||||
F-
60
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
18. Financial liabilities – borrowings continued
The carrying amounts and market values of borrowings are as follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Effective interest rate | Carrying value | Market value | Effective interest rate | Carrying value | Market value | ||||||||||||||||||
Bank loans and overdrafts | n/a | — | — | n/a | 3 | 3 | ||||||||||||||||||
1.875% euro notes 2021 | n/a | — | — | 2.04 | % | 178 | 176 | |||||||||||||||||
3.75% US dollar notes 2022 | 3.94 | % | 87 | 87 | 3.94 | % | 86 | 88 | ||||||||||||||||
3.25% US dollar notes 2023 | 3.36 | % | 70 | 71 | 3.36 | % | 69 | 71 | ||||||||||||||||
1.375% euro notes 2025 | 1.44 | % | 257 | 260 | 1.44 | % | 279 | 278 | ||||||||||||||||
3.75% GBP notes 2030 | 3.93 | % | 353 | 380 | 3.93 | % | 353 | 404 | ||||||||||||||||
767 | 798 | 968 | 1,020 | |||||||||||||||||||||
The market values stated above are based on clean market prices at the year end or, where these are not available, on the quoted market prices of comparable debt issued by other companies. The effective interest rates above relate to the underlying debt instruments.
The carrying amounts of the Group’s borrowings before the effect of derivatives (see notes 16 and 19 for further information on the impact of derivatives) are denominated in the following currencies:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
US dollar | 434 | 458 | ||||||
Sterling | 674 | 686 | ||||||
Euro | 268 | 472 | ||||||
Other | 24 | 35 | ||||||
1,400 | 1,651 | |||||||
The Group has $1.19bn (£0.9bn) of undrawn capacity on its committed borrowing facilities as at 31 December 2021 (2020: $1.19bn (£0.9bn) undrawn). In addition, there are a number of short-term facilities that are utilised in the normal course of business. All of the Group’s borrowings are unsecured. In respect of lease obligations, the rights to the leased asset revert to the lessor in the event of default.
19. Financial risk management
The Group’s approach to the management of financial risks together with sensitivity analyses of its financial instruments is set out below.
Treasury policy
Pearson’s treasury policies set out the Group’s principles for addressing key financial risks including capital risk, liquidity risk, foreign exchange risk and interest rate risk, and sets out measurable targets for each. The Audit Committee receives quarterly reports incorporating compliance with measurable targets and reviews and approves any changes to treasury policies annually.
The treasury function is permitted to use derivatives where their use reduces a risk or allows a transaction to be undertaken more cost effectively. Derivatives permitted include swaps, forwards and collars to manage foreign exchange and interest rate risk, with foreign exchange swap and forward contracts the most commonly executed. Speculative transactions are not permitted.
F-
61
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
19. Financial risk management continued
Capital risk
The Group’s objectives when managing capital are:
• | To maintain a strong balance sheet and a solid investment grade rating; |
• | To continue to invest in the business organically and through acquisitions; and |
• | To have a sustainable and progressive dividend policy. |
In September 2021, Standard & Poor’s Financial Services LLC withdrew its ratings at the request of the Group. Fitch Ratings Limited assigned a first-time Long-Term Issuer Default Rating (“IDR”) of
‘BBB-’
(stable outlook) to the Group. The Group’s bonds are rated Baa3 (stable outlook) andBBB-
(stable outlook) by Moody’s Investors Service and Fitch Ratings Limited respectively.Net debt
The Group’s net debt position is set out below:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Cash and cash equivalents | 937 | 1,116 | ||||||
Derivative financial instruments | (2 | ) | 11 | |||||
Bank loans and overdrafts | — | (3 | ) | |||||
Bonds | (767 | ) | (965 | ) | ||||
Investment in finance lease receivable | 115 | 130 | ||||||
Lease liabilities | (633 | ) | (752 | ) | ||||
Net debt | (350 | ) | (463 | ) | ||||
At 31 December 2020, net debt presented above includes borrowings of £69m and cash and cash equivalents of £19m which are included in assets and liabilities held for sale. There are no balances held for sale as at 31 December 2021.
Interest and foreign exchange rate management
The Group’s principal currency exposure is to the US dollar which represents more than 60% of the Group’s sales.
The Group’s long-term debt is primarily held in US dollars to provide a natural hedge of this exposure, which is achieved through issued US dollar debt or converting euro debt to US dollars using cross-currency swaps, forwards and collars. As at 31 December 2021 and 2020, the Group’s debt of £1,400m (2020: £1,651m) is all held at fixed rates.
See note 16 for details of the Group’s hedging programme which addresses interest rate risk and foreign currency risk.
Overseas profits are converted to sterling to satisfy sterling cash outflows such as dividends at the prevailing spot rate at the time of the transaction. To the extent the Group has sufficient sterling, US dollars may be held as dollar cash to provide a natural offset to the Group’s debt or to satisfy future US dollar cash outflows.
The Group does not have significant cross-border foreign exchange transactional exposures.
F-
62
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
19. Financial risk management continued
Interest and foreign exchange rate management continued
As at 31 December 2021, the sensitivity of the carrying value of the Group’s financial instruments to fluctuations in interest rates and exchange rates is as follows:
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying value | Impact of 1% increase in interest rates | Impact of 1% decrease in interest rates | Impact of 10% strengthening in sterling | Impact of 10% weakening in sterling | |||||||||||||||
Investments in unlisted securities | 113 | — | — | (9 | ) | 11 | ||||||||||||||
Other receivable | 87 | — | — | (8 | ) | 10 | ||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents | 937 | — | — | (43 | ) | 53 | ||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments | (2 | ) | 6 | (6 | ) | (1 | ) | 1 | ||||||||||||
Bonds | (767 | ) | 5 | (5 | ) | 37 | (45 | ) | ||||||||||||
Other borrowings | (633 | ) | — | — | 57 | (70 | ) | |||||||||||||
Investment in finance lease receivable | 115 | — | — | (11 | ) | 13 | ||||||||||||||
Other net financial assets | 503 | — | — | (42 | ) | 51 | ||||||||||||||
Total | 353 | 11 | (11 | ) | (20 | ) | 24 | |||||||||||||
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Carrying value | Impact of 1% increase in interest rates | Impact of 1% decrease in interest rates | Impact of 10% strengthening in sterling | Impact of 10% weakening in sterling | |||||||||||||||
Investments in unlisted securities | 138 | — | — | (11 | ) | 13 | ||||||||||||||
Other receivable | 96 | — | — | (9 | ) | 11 | ||||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents | 1,097 | — | — | (55 | ) | 25 | ||||||||||||||
Derivative financial instruments | 11 | 17 | (19 | ) | 3 | 1 | ||||||||||||||
Bonds | (965 | ) | 9 | (9 | ) | 54 | (67 | ) | ||||||||||||
Other borrowings | (686 | ) | — | — | 62 | (76 | ) | |||||||||||||
Investment in finance lease receivable | 130 | — | — | (12 | ) | 14 | ||||||||||||||
Other net financial assets | 463 | — | — | (44 | ) | 40 | ||||||||||||||
Total | 284 | 26 | (28 | ) | (12 | ) | (39 | ) | ||||||||||||
The table above shows the sensitivities of the fair values of each class of financial instrument to an isolated change in either interest rates or foreign exchange rates. Other net financial assets comprises trade receivables less trade payables. A significant proportion of the movements shown above would impact equity rather than the income statement due to the location and functional currency of the entities in which they arise and the availability of net investment hedging.
The Group’s income statement is reported at average rates for the year while the balance sheet is translated at the
year-end
closing rate. Differences between these rates can distort ratio calculations such as debt to EBITDA and interest cover. Adjusted operating profit translated atyear-end
closing rates would be £6m higher (2020: £25m lower) than the reported figure of £385m (2020: £313m) at £391m (2020: £288m). Adjusted EBITDA translated atyear-end
closing rates would be £8m higher (2020: £38m lower) than the reported figure of £598m (2020: £550m) at £606m (2020: £512m).Liquidity and refinancing risk management
The Group regularly reviews the level of cash and debt facilities required to fund its activities. This involves preparing a prudent cash flow forecast for the next three to five years, determining the level of debt facilities
F-
63
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
19. Financial risk management continued
Liquidity and refinancing risk management continued
required to fund the business, planning for shareholder returns and repayments of maturing debt, and identifying an appropriate amount of headroom to provide a reserve against unexpected outflows.
At 31 December 2021, the Group had cash of £0.9bn (2020: £1.1bn) and 0 outstanding drawings (2020: £NaN) on the US dollar denominated revolving credit facility due 2025 of $1.19bn (2020: $1.19bn).
The $1.19bn facility contains interest cover and leverage covenants which the Group has complied with for the year ended 31 December 2021. The maturity of the carrying values of the Group’s borrowings and trade payables are set out in notes 18 and 24 respectively.
At the end of 2021, the currency split of the Group’s trade payables was US dollar £199m (2020: £195m), sterling £76m (2020: £76m) and other currencies £76m (2020: £69m). Trade payables are all due within one year (2020: all due within one year).
The table below analyses the Group’s bonds and derivative assets and liabilities into relevant maturity groupings based on the remaining period at the balance sheet date to the contractual maturity date. Short dated derivative instruments have not been included in this table. The amounts disclosed in the table are the contractual undiscounted cash flows (including interest) and as such may differ from the amounts disclosed on the balance sheet.
Financial counterparty and credit risk management
Financial counterparty and credit risk arises from cash and cash equivalents, favourable derivative financial instruments and deposits with banks and financial institutions, as well as credit exposures to customers, including outstanding receivables. Counterparty credit limits, which take published credit rating and other factors into account, are set to cover the Group’s total aggregate exposure to a single financial institution. The limits applicable to published credit rating bands are approved by the Chief Financial Officer within guidelines approved by the Board. Exposures and limits applicable to each financial institution are reviewed on a regular basis.
Analysed by maturity | Analysed by currency | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Greater than one month and less than one year | Later than one year but less than five years | Five years or more | Total | USD | GBP | Other | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Bonds | 107 | 386 | 403 | 896 | 162 | 468 | 266 | 896 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Rate derivatives – inflows | (7 | ) | (331 | ) | — | (338 | ) | (9 | ) | (150 | ) | (179 | ) | (338 | ) | |||||||||||||||||
Rate derivatives – outflows | 12 | 339 | 4 | 355 | 203 | 150 | 2 | 355 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
FX forwards – inflows | (148 | ) | — | — | (148 | ) | — | (148 | ) | — | (148 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||
FX forwards – outflows | 148 | — | — | �� | 148 | 90 | — | 58 | 148 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 112 | 394 | 407 | 913 | 446 | 320 | 147 | 913 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
At 31 December 2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Bonds | 200 | 497 | 416 | 1,113 | 166 | 481 | 466 | 1,113 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Rate derivatives – inflows | (186 | ) | (350 | ) | (1 | ) | (537 | ) | (12 | ) | (152 | ) | (373 | ) | (537 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Rate derivatives – outflows | 180 | 350 | 12 | 542 | 209 | 330 | 3 | 542 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
FX forwards – inflows | (68 | ) | — | — | (68 | ) | — | (68 | ) | — | (68 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||
FX forwards – outflows | 68 | — | — | 68 | 36 | — | 32 | 68 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 194 | 497 | 427 | 1,118 | 399 | 591 | 128 | 1,118 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
F-
64
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
19. Financial risk management continued
Financial counterparty and credit risk management continued
Cash deposits and derivative transactions are made with approved counterparties up to pre-agreed limits. To manage counterparty risk associated with cash and cash equivalents, the Group uses a mixture of money market funds as well as bank deposits. As at 31 December 2021, 81% (2020: 88%) of cash and cash equivalents was held with investment grade bank counterparties, 9% (2020: 9%) with AAA money market funds and 10% (2020: 3%) with non-investment grade bank counterparties.
For trade receivables and contract assets, the Group’s exposure to credit risk is influenced mainly by the individual characteristics of each customer. However, risk associated with the industry and country in which customers operate may also influence the credit risk. The credit quality of customers is assessed by taking into account financial position, past experience and other relevant factors. Individual credit limits are set for each customer based on internal ratings. The compliance with credit limits is regularly monitored by the Group. A default on a trade receivable is when the counterparty fails to make contractual payments within the stated payment terms. Trade receivables and contract assets are written off when there is no reasonable expectation of recovery. The carrying amounts of financial assets, trade receivables and contract assets represent the maximum credit exposure.
Trade receivables and contract assets are subject to impairment using the expected credit loss model. The Group applies the IFRS 9 simplified approach to measuring expected credit losses which uses a lifetime expected credit loss allowance for all trade receivables and contract assets. To measure the expected credit losses, trade receivables and contract assets have been grouped based on shared credit risk characteristics and the days past due. See note 22 for further details about trade receivables and contract assets including movements in provisions for bad and doubtful debts.
Amendments to IFRS 9 and IFRS 7 Interest Rate Benchmark Reform
In August 2020, the IASB published ‘Interest Rate Benchmark Reform – Phase 2 (Amendments to IFRS 9, IAS 39, IFRS 7, IFRS 4 and IFRS 16)’ with amendments that address financial reporting after the reform of an interest rate benchmark, including its replacement with alternative benchmark rates. The amendments were effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2021, with earlier application permitted.
The Group has limited exposure to changes in the IBOR benchmark. At 31 December 2021, the Group holds interest rate and cross-currency interest rate swaps (£29m assets in fair value hedge relationships and £29m liabilities of which £21m are in net investment hedge relationships). In addition, the Group has a revolving credit facility which was not drawn on 31 December 2021, for which the terms were updated in the period in accordance with industry standards. The Group has signed up to the ISDA protocol. For GBP exposures the Group transitioned GBP LIBOR to SONIA. The Group’s risk management strategy has not changed as a result of IBOR reform and the Group considers the impact of IBOR reform to be immaterial to the financial statements.
F-
65
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
20. Intangible assets – product development
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Cost | ||||||||
At 1 January | 2,514 | 2,275 | ||||||
Exchange differences | — | (48 | ) | |||||
Additions | 287 | 323 | ||||||
Disposals and retirements | (92 | ) | (31 | ) | ||||
Disposal of subsidiary | (9 | ) | 0 | |||||
Transfers | (2 | ) | (5 | ) | ||||
At 31 December | 2,698 | 2,514 | ||||||
Amortisation | ||||||||
At 1 January | (1,609 | ) | (1,405 | ) | ||||
Exchange differences | (3 | ) | 45 | |||||
Charge for the year | (260 | ) | (280 | ) | ||||
Impairment | (19 | ) | — | |||||
Disposals and retirements | 92 | 31 | ||||||
Disposal of subsidiary | 3 | — | ||||||
Transfers | (8 | ) | — | |||||
At 31 December | (1,804 | ) | (1,609 | ) | ||||
Carrying amounts at 31 December 2021 | 894 | 905 | ||||||
Included in the above are product development assets amounting to £601m (2020: £607m) which will be realised in more than one year. Amortisation is included in the income statement in cost of goods sold.
Product development assets are assessed for impairment triggers on an annual basis or when triggering events occur. In 2021, of the £19m impairment charges, £14m have been recognised as a result of asset write-offs related to the major restructuring programme. The full annual impairment test showed that there is adequate headroom across all product development assets and accordingly 0 further impairment charges were recognised in 2021 (2020: £NaN
; 2019: £NaN).
21. Inventories
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Raw materials | 7 | 5 | ||||||
Work in progress | 2 | 2 | ||||||
Finished goods | 84 | 116 | ||||||
Returns asset | 5 | 6 | ||||||
98 | 129 | |||||||
The cost of inventories recognised as an expense and included in the income statement in cost of goods sold amounted to £171m (2020: £219m) including £22m (2020: £41m) of inventory provisions. NaN of the inventory is pledged as security. Included within the inventory balance is the estimation of the right to receive goods from contracts with customers via returns. The value of the returns asset is measured at the carrying amount of the assets at the time of sale aligned to the Group’s normal inventory valuation methodology less any expected costs to recover the asset and any expected reduction in value. Impairment charges against the inventory returns asset are £NaN in 2021 (2020: £NaN). The returns asset all relates to finished goods. The obsolescence provision takes account of the Group’s digital first strategy and the increasing shift towards print on demand. The
year-on-year
F-6
6
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
21. Inventories continued
reduction in inventories is due to increased provisions for obsolescence and a reduction in the production of inventory due to the Group’s digital first strategy and the increasing shift towards print on demand.
22. Trade and other receivables
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Current | ||||||||
Trade receivables | 853 | 795 | ||||||
Royalty advances | 2 | 2 | ||||||
Prepayments | 198 | 189 | ||||||
Investment in finance lease receivable | 15 | 18 | ||||||
Accrued income | 14 | 12 | ||||||
Other receivables | 175 | 102 | ||||||
1,257 | 1,118 | |||||||
Non-current | ||||||||
Trade receivables | 1 | 8 | ||||||
Royalty advances | 5 | 3 | ||||||
Prepayments | 10 | 13 | ||||||
Investment in finance lease receivable | 100 | 112 | ||||||
Accrued income | 1 | 1 | ||||||
Interest receivable | 8 | — | ||||||
Other receivables | 4 | 86 | ||||||
129 | 223 | |||||||
Accrued income represents contract assets which are unbilled amounts generally resulting from assessments and services revenue streams where revenue to be recognised over time has been recognised in excess of customer billings to date. Impairment charges on accrued income assets are £NaN (2020: £NaN). The carrying value of the Group’s trade and other receivables approximates its fair value. Trade receivables are stated net of provisions for bad and doubtful debts. In addition to the above, there are trade receivables of £NaN (2020: £6m) classified as held for sale (see note 32).
The movements in the provision for bad and doubtful debts are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
At beginning of year | (74 | ) | (92 | ) | ||||
Exchange differences | — | 6 | ||||||
Income statement movements | (15 | ) | (26 | ) | ||||
Utilised | 26 | 32 | ||||||
Disposal of subsidiary | — | 6 | ||||||
At end of year | (63 | ) | (74 | ) | ||||
Concentrations of credit risk with respect to trade receivables are limited due to the Group’s large number of customers, who are internationally dispersed.
F-6
7
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
22. Trade and other receivables continued
The ageing of the Group’s gross trade receivables is as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Within due date | 766 | 687 | ||||||
Up to three months past due date | 58 | 73 | ||||||
Three to six months past due date | 20 | 12 | ||||||
Six to nine months past due date | 13 | 30 | ||||||
Nine to 12 months past due date | 5 | 18 | ||||||
More than 12 months past due date | 55 | 57 | ||||||
Gross trade receivables | 917 | 877 | ||||||
The Group reviews its bad debt provision at least twice a year following a detailed review of receivable balances and historical payment profiles, and assessment of forward-looking risk factors including, where relevant, factors specifically related to
COVID-19.
Management believes all the remaining receivable balances are fully recoverable.The increase in trade receivables held by the Group is driven by revenue growth which has increased debtors despite strong collections and an overall reduction in the bad debt provision. Other
non-current
receivables have decreased due to the receipt of deferred proceeds in relation to the USK-12
disposal; this receivable is now classified as current. Prepayments have increased due to timing differences on certain significant payments and lease receivables have decreased primarily due to payments received during the year.23. Provisions for other liabilities and charges
All figures in £ millions | Property | Disposals and closures | Legal and other | Total | ||||||||||||
At 1 January 2021 | 8 | 4 | 21 | 33 | ||||||||||||
Exchange differences | — | — | 2 | 2 | ||||||||||||
Provisions made during the year | 9 | 1 | 36 | 46 | ||||||||||||
Provisions reversed during the year | (2 | ) | — | (2 | ) | (4 | ) | |||||||||
Provisions used during the year | — | — | (27 | ) | (27 | ) | ||||||||||
Disposal of subsidiary | — | (3 | ) | — | (3 | ) | ||||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 15 | 2 | 30 | 47 | ||||||||||||
F-6
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
23. Provisions for other liabilities and charges continued
Analysis of provisions: | ||||||||||||||||
2021 | ||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Property | Disposals and closures | Legal and other | Total | ||||||||||||
Current | 11 | 2 | 27 | 40 | ||||||||||||
Non-current | 4 | — | 3 | 7 | ||||||||||||
15 | 2 | 30 | 47 | |||||||||||||
2020 | ||||||||||||||||
Current | 2 | 4 | 19 | 25 | ||||||||||||
Non-current | 6 | — | 2 | 8 | ||||||||||||
8 | 4 | 21 | 33 | |||||||||||||
Property provisions in 2021 relate to the simplification of the Group’s property portfolio (see note 4) and in 2020 relate primarily to dilapidations. Disposals and closures relate to the disposal of the Pearson Institute of Higher Education.
Legal and other includes legal claims, contract disputes and potential contract losses with the provisions utilised as the cases are settled. Also included in legal and other are other restructuring provisions that are generally utilised within one year.
The year on year increase in provisions is mainly due to the new property provisions (see note 10) and the 2021 major restructuring programme (see note 4).
24. Trade and other liabilities
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Trade payables | 351 | 340 | ||||||
Sales return liability | 83 | 86 | ||||||
Social security and other taxes | 13 | 17 | ||||||
Accruals | 317 | 290 | ||||||
Deferred income | 386 | 356 | ||||||
Interest payable | 42 | 30 | ||||||
Other liabilities | 159 | 157 | ||||||
1,351 | 1,276 | |||||||
Less: non-current portion | ||||||||
Accruals | 1 | — | ||||||
Deferred income | 56 | 52 | ||||||
Other liabilities | 38 | 28 | ||||||
95 | 80 | |||||||
Current portion | 1,256 | 1,196 | ||||||
F-6
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
24. Trade and other liabilities continued
The carrying value of the Group’s trade and other liabilities approximates its fair value. The deferred income balance comprises contract liabilities in respect of advance payments in assessment, testing and training businesses; subscription income in school and college businesses; and obligations to deliver digital content in future periods. In addition to the above, there are accruals of £nil (2020: £2m) and deferred income of £nil (2020:£3m) classified as held for sale (see note 32). The increase in trade and other liabilities held by the Group is driven by timing differences which have increased deferred income, an increase in accruals related to severance and the recognition of deferred consideration in relation to acquisitions made in 2021.
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations
Background
The Group operates a number of defined benefit and defined contribution retirement plans throughout the world.
The largest plan is the Pearson Pension Plan (UK Group plan) in the UK, which is sectionalised to provide both defined benefit and defined contribution pension benefits. The defined benefit section was largely closed to new members from 1 November 2006. The defined contribution section, opened in 2003, is open to new and existing employees. Finally, there is a separate section within the UK Group plan set up for auto-enrolment.
The defined benefit section of the UK Group plan is a final salary pension plan which provides benefits to members in the form of a guaranteed level of pension payable for life. The level of benefits depends on the length of service and final pensionable pay.
The defined contribution section of the UK Group plan operates a Reference Scheme Test (RST) pension underpin for its members. Where a member’s fund value is insufficient to purchase the RST pension upon retirement, the UK Group plan is liable for the shortfall to cover the member’s RST pension. In addition, in recent years, the scheme rules were amended to enable members who have sufficient funds to purchase an RST pension the ability to convert their fund value into a pension in the UK Group plan as an alternative to purchasing an annuity with an insurer. The Group recognises any assets and liabilities relating to these features of the defined contribution section as part of the overall UK Group plan obligation. From 1 January 2021, the Group also recognized the assets and liabilities for all members of the defined contribution section of the UK Group plan, accounting for the whole defined contribution section as a defined benefit scheme under IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’ as there is a risk the underpin will require the Group to pay further contributions to the scheme. The net impact of this on the balance sheet is £0nil.
The UK Group plan is funded with benefit payments from trustee-administered funds. The UK Group plan is administered in accordance with the Trust Deed and Rules in the interests of its beneficiaries by Pearson Group Pension Trustee Limited.
At 31 December 2021, the UK Group plan had approximately 26,500 members, analysed in the following table:
All figures in% | Active | Deferred | Pensioners | Total | ||||||||||||
Defined benefit | — | 18 | 33 | 51 | ||||||||||||
Defined contribution | 11 | 38 | 0 | 49 | ||||||||||||
Total | 11 | 56 | 33 | 100 | ||||||||||||
The other major defined benefit plans are based in the US. These are also final salary pension plans which provide benefits to members in the form of a guaranteed pension payable for life, with the level of benefits dependent on length of service and final pensionable pay. The majority of the US plans are fully funded.
F-
70
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Background continued
The Group also has several post-retirement medical benefit plans (PRMBs), principally in the US. PRMBs are unfunded but are accounted for and valued similarly to defined benefit pension plans.
The defined benefit schemes expose the Group to actuarial risks, such as life expectancy, inflation risks and investment risk including asset volatility and changes in bond yields. The Group is not exposed to any unusual, entity-specific or plan-specific risks.
Key judgements
Key areas of estimation
Assumptions
The principal assumptions used for the UK Group plan and the US PRMB are shown below. Weighted average assumptions have been shown for the other plans, which primarily relate to US pension plans.
2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in % | UK Group plan | Other plans | PRMB | UK Group plan | Other plans | PRMB | UK Group plan | Other plans | PRMB | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Inflation | 3.3 | 1.4 | 0 | 2.9 | 0.6 | 0 | 3.0 | 1.7 | 1.5 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Rate used to discount plan liabilities | 1.9 | 2.8 | 2.6 | 1.4 | 2.2 | 2.1 | 2.0 | 3.0 | 3.1 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Expected rate of increase in salaries | 3.8 | 2.7 | 0 | 3.4 | 2.2 | 0 | 3.5 | 2.9 | 3.0 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Expected rate of increase for pensions in payment and deferred pensions | 2.35 to 5.10 | — | — | 2.05 to 5.05 | — | — | 1.85 to 5.05 | — | — | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Initial rate of increase in healthcare rate | — | — | 6.3 | — | — | 6.5 | — | — | 6.8 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Ultimate rate of increase in healthcare rate | — | — | 5.0 | — | — | 5.0 | — | — | 5.0 |
The UK discount rate is based on corporate bond yields adjusted to reflect the duration of liabilities.
The inflation rate for the UK Group plan of 3.3% (2020: 2.9%; 2019: 3.0%) reflects the RPI rate. In line with changes to legislation in 2010, certain benefits have been calculated with reference to CPI as the inflationary measure and in these instances a rate of 2.6% (2020: 2.2%; 2019: 2.0%) has been used. The CPI rate is determined as a weighted average deduction from the RPI rate, and allows for the expected change to the formula for calculating RPI to be in line with CPIH from 2030 onwards.
The expected rate of increase in salaries has been set at 3.8% for 2021 (2020: 3.4%; 2019: 3.5%).
F-
71
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Assumptions continued
For the UK Group plan, the mortality base table assumptions have been updated and are derived from the SAPS S3 for males and females, adjusted to reflect the observed experience of the plan, with CMI model improvement factors. A 1.5% long-term rate improvement on the CMI 2020 model is applied for both males and females. The analysis of experience, and standard tables, do not reflect the impact of the ongoing
COVID-19
pandemic, the ultimate impact of which remains uncertain.For the US plans, the mortality table (Pri – 2012) and 2021 improvement scale (MP – 2021) with generational projection for male and female annuitants has been adopted.
Using the above tables, the remaining average life expectancy in years of a pensioner retiring at age 65 on the balance sheet date for the UK Group plan and US plans is as follows:
UK | US | |||||||||||||||
All figures in years | 2021 | 2020 | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||||||||
Male | 22.6 | 24.0 | 20.5 | 20.4 | ||||||||||||
Female | 24.8 | 24.3 | 22.5 | 22.4 |
The remaining average life expectancy in years of a pensioner retiring at age 65, 20 years after the balance sheet date, for the UK and US Group plans is as follows:
UK | US | |||||||||||||||
All figures in years | 2021 | 2020 | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||||||||
Male | 24.2 | 25.6 | 22.0 | 21.9 | ||||||||||||
Female | 26.5 | 26.1 | 23.9 | 23.8 |
Although the Group anticipates that plan surpluses will be utilised during the life of the plan to address member benefits, the Group recognises its pension surplus in full in respect of the UK Group plan on the basis that it is management’s judgement that there are no substantive restrictions on the return of residual plan assets in the event of a winding up of the plan after all member obligations have been met.
Financial statement information
The amounts recognised in the income statement are as follows:
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | UK Group plan | Defined benefit other | Sub-total | Defined contribution | PRMB | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
Current service cost | 17 | 2 | 19 | 37 | — | 56 | ||||||||||||||||||
Past service cost | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||
Curtailments | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||
Administration expenses | 6 | — | 6 | — | — | 6 | ||||||||||||||||||
Total operating expense | 23 | 2 | 25 | 37 | — | 62 | ||||||||||||||||||
Interest on plan assets | (55 | ) | (2 | ) | (57 | ) | — | — | (57 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Interest on plan liabilities | 49 | 3 | 52 | — | 1 | 53 | ||||||||||||||||||
Net finance (income)/expense | (6 | ) | 1 | (5 | ) | — | 1 | (4 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Net income statement charge | 17 | 3 | 20 | 37 | 1 | 58 | ||||||||||||||||||
F-
72
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Financial statement information continued
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | UK Group plan | Defined benefit other | Sub-total | Defined contribution | PRMB | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
Current service cost | 6 | 2 | 8 | 47 | — | 55 | ||||||||||||||||||
Past service cost | 1 | — | 1 | — | — | 1 | ||||||||||||||||||
Curtailments | — | (1 | ) | (1 | ) | — | — | (1 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Administration expenses | 5 | — | 5 | — | — | 5 | ||||||||||||||||||
Total operating expense | 12 | 1 | 13 | 47 | — | 60 | ||||||||||||||||||
Interest on plan assets | (66 | ) | (3 | ) | (69 | ) | — | — | (69 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Interest on plan liabilities | 57 | 5 | 62 | — | 1 | 63 | ||||||||||||||||||
Net finance (income)/expense | (9 | ) | 2 | (7 | ) | — | 1 | (6 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Net income statement charge | 3 | 3 | 6 | 47 | 1 | 54 | ||||||||||||||||||
2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | UK Group plan | Defined benefit other | Sub-total | Defined contribution | PRMB | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
Current service cost | 6 | 3 | 9 | 57 | — | 66 | ||||||||||||||||||
Past service cost | — | — | — | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||
Curtailments | (2 | ) | — | (2 | ) | — | (1 | ) | (3 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Administration expenses | 6 | — | 6 | — | — | 6 | ||||||||||||||||||
Total operating expense | 10 | 3 | 13 | 57 | (1 | ) | 69 | |||||||||||||||||
Interest on plan assets | (89 | ) | (5 | ) | (94 | ) | — | — | (94 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Interest on plan liabilities | 73 | 6 | 79 | — | 2 | 81 | ||||||||||||||||||
Net finance (income)/expense | (16 | ) | 1 | (15 | ) | — | 2 | (13 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Net income statement charge | (6 | ) | 4 | (2 | ) | 57 | 1 | 56 | ||||||||||||||||
The amounts recognised in the balance sheet are as follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | UK Group plan | Other funded plans | Other unfunded plans | Total | UK Group plan | Other funded plans | Other unfunded plans | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fair value of plan assets | 4,125 | 120 | — | 4,245 | 3,588 | 119 | — | 3,707 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Present value of defined benefit obligation | (3,588 | ) | (123 | ) | (20 | ) | (3,731 | ) | (3,178 | ) | (135 | ) | (21 | ) | (3,334 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Net pension asset/(liability) | 537 | (3 | ) | (20 | ) | 514 | 410 | (16 | ) | (21 | ) | 373 | ||||||||||||||||||||
Other post-retirement medical benefit obligation | (34 | ) | (39 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Other pension accruals | (9 | ) | (9 | ) | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net retirement benefit asset | 471 | 325 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Analysed as: | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Retirement benefit assets | 537 | 410 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Retirement benefit obligations | (66 | ) | (85 | ) |
F-7
3
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Financial statement information continued
The following gains/(losses) have been recognised in other comprehensive income:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Amounts recognised for defined benefit plans | 145 | (24 | ) | (148 | ) | |||||||
Amounts recognised for post-retirement medical benefit plans | 4 | 1 | 3 | |||||||||
Total recognised in year | 149 | (23 | ) | (145 | ) | |||||||
The fair value of plan assets comprises the following:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in % | UK Group plan | Other funded plans | Total | UK Group plan | Other funded plans | Total | ||||||||||||||||||
Insurance | 35 | — | 35 | 42 | — | 42 | ||||||||||||||||||
Equities | 11 | 1 | 12 | 1 | 1 | 2 | ||||||||||||||||||
Fixed interest securities | 7 | 2 | 9 | 5 | 1 | 6 | ||||||||||||||||||
Property | 5 | — | 5 | 5 | — | 5 | ||||||||||||||||||
Pooled asset investment funds | 30 | — | 30 | 34 | — | 34 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other | 9 | — | 9 | 11 | — | 11 |
The plan assets do not include any of the Group’s own financial instruments, or any property occupied by the Group. The table below further disaggregates the plan assets into those assets which have a quoted market price in an active market and those that do not:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||
All figures in % | Quoted market price | No quoted market price | Quoted market price | No quoted market price | ||||||||||||
Insurance | 35 | 0 | 42 | 0 | ||||||||||||
Equities | 11 | 1 | 0 | 2 | ||||||||||||
Fixed-interest securities | 9 | 0 | 6 | 0 | ||||||||||||
Property | 0 | 5 | 0 | 5 | ||||||||||||
Pooled asset investment funds | 30 | 0 | 34 | 0 | ||||||||||||
Other | 0 | 9 | 0 | 11 | ||||||||||||
Total | 85 | 15 | 82 | 18 | ||||||||||||
The liquidity profile of the UK Group plan assets is as follows:
All figures in % | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Liquid – call <1 month | 51 | 39 | ||||||
Less liquid – call 1–3 months | — | — | ||||||
Illiquid – call >3 months | 49 | 61 |
F-
74
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Financial statement information continued
Changes in the values of plan assets and liabilities of the retirement benefit plans are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
UK Group plan | Other plans | Total | UK Group plan | Other plans | Total | |||||||||||||||||||
Fair value of plan assets | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Opening fair value of plan assets | 3,588 | 119 | 3,707 | 3,341 | 120 | 3,461 | ||||||||||||||||||
Recognition of Money Purchase assets | 513 | — | 513 | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | — | 2 | 2 | — | (3 | ) | (3 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Interest on plan assets | 55 | 2 | 57 | 66 | 3 | 69 | ||||||||||||||||||
Return on plan assets excluding interest | 71 | 6 | 77 | 297 | 8 | 305 | ||||||||||||||||||
Contributions by employer | 14 | 1 | 15 | 3 | 5 | 8 | ||||||||||||||||||
Benefits paid | (123 | ) | (10 | ) | (133 | ) | (119 | ) | (14 | ) | (133 | ) | ||||||||||||
Contributions by employees | 7 | 0 | 7 | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||||
Closing fair value of plan assets | 4,125 | 120 | 4,245 | 3,588 | 119 | 3,707 | ||||||||||||||||||
Present value of defined benefit obligation | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Opening defined benefit obligation | (3,178 | ) | (156 | ) | (3,334 | ) | (2,912 | ) | (157 | ) | (3,069 | ) | ||||||||||||
Recognition of Money Purchase liabilities | (513 | ) | — | (513 | ) | — | — | — | ||||||||||||||||
Exchange differences | 0 | (1 | ) | (1 | ) | — | 3 | 3 | ||||||||||||||||
Current service cost | (17 | ) | (2 | ) | (19 | ) | (6 | ) | (2 | ) | (8 | ) | ||||||||||||
Past service cost | — | — | — | (1 | ) | 0 | (1 | ) | ||||||||||||||||
Curtailments | — | — | — | — | 1 | 1 | ||||||||||||||||||
Administration expenses | (6 | ) | 0 | (6 | ) | (5 | ) | 0 | (5 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Interest on plan liabilities | (49 | ) | (3 | ) | (52 | ) | (57 | ) | (5 | ) | (62 | ) | ||||||||||||
Actuarial (losses)/gains – experience | (100 | ) | 3 | (97 | ) | (18 | ) | (2 | ) | (20 | ) | |||||||||||||
Actuarial (losses)/gains – demographic | (1 | ) | 0 | (1 | ) | 1 | 1 | 2 | ||||||||||||||||
Actuarial gains/(losses) – financial | 160 | 6 | 166 | (299 | ) | (11 | ) | (310 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Contributions by employee | (7 | ) | 0 | (7 | ) | 0 | 2 | 2 | ||||||||||||||||
Benefits paid | 123 | 10 | 133 | 119 | 14 | 133 | ||||||||||||||||||
Closing defined benefit obligation | (3,588 | ) | (143 | ) | (3,731 | ) | (3,178 | ) | (156 | ) | (3,334 | ) | ||||||||||||
From 1 January 2021, the Group has recognised the assets and liabilities for all members of the defined contribution section of the UK Group plan, accounting for the whole defined contribution section as a defined benefit scheme under IAS 19 ‘Employee Benefits’. The net impact on the balance sheet is £0nil, however, the gross amounts of £513m can be seen in the table above. Subsequent movements to those assets and liabilities are included in the relevant lines in the table above.
The weighted average duration of the defined benefit obligation is 16 years for the UK and seven years for the US.
F-
75
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Financial statement information continued
Changes in the value of the US PRMB are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Opening defined benefit obligation | (39 | ) | (43 | ) | ||||
Exchange differences | (1 | ) | 1 | |||||
Interest on plan liabilities | (1 | ) | (1 | ) | ||||
Actuarial gains – experience | 2 | 3 | ||||||
Actuarial gains – demographic | 0 | 1 | ||||||
Actuarial gains/(losses) – financial | 2 | (3 | ) | |||||
Benefits paid | 3 | 3 | ||||||
Closing defined benefit obligation | (34 | ) | (39 | ) | ||||
Funding
The UK Group plan is self-administered with the plan’s assets being held independently of the Group in trust. The trustee of the UK Group plan is required to act in the best interest of the plan’s beneficiaries. The most recent triennial actuarial valuation for funding purposes was completed as at 1 January 2021 and this valuation revealed a technical provisions funding surplus of £160m. The UK Group plan expects to be able to provide benefits (in accordance with the plan rules) with a very low level of reliance on future funding from the Group.
Assets of the UK Group plan are divided into two elements: matching assets, which are assets that produce cash flows that can be expected to match the cash flows for a proportion of the membership, and include a liability-driven investment mandate (UK bonds, interest rate/inflation swaps and other derivative instruments), pensioner
buy-in
insurance policies, inflation-linked property and infrastructure, and return-seeking assets, which are assets invested with a longer-term horizon to generate the returns needed to provide the remaining expected cash flows for the beneficiaries, and include diversified growth funds, property and alternative asset classes. The UK Group plan’s long-term investment strategy allocates 95% to matching assets and 5% to return-seeking assets.Following the purchase of
buy-in
policies with Legal & General and Aviva in 2017 and 2019, 95% of the UK Group plan’s pensioner liabilities are now matched withbuy-in
policies. These transfer significant longevity risk to Aviva and Legal & General, reducing the pension risks being underwritten by the Group and providing additional security for members.Regular employer contributions to the UK Group plan in respect of the defined benefit sections are estimated to be £3m for 2022.
Sensitivities
The effect of a one percentage point increase and decrease in the discount rate on the defined benefit obligation and the total pension expense is as follows:
2021 | ||||||||
All figures in £ millions | 1% increase | 1% decrease | ||||||
Effect: | ||||||||
(Decrease)/increase in defined benefit obligation – UK Group plan | (450 | ) | 616 | |||||
(Decrease)/increase in defined benefit obligation – US plan | (9 | ) | 11 | |||||
F-7
6
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
25. Retirement benefit and other post-retirement obligations continued
Sensitivities continued
The effect of members living one year more or one year less on the defined benefit obligation is as follows:
2021 | ||||||||
All figures in £ millions | One year increase | One year decrease | ||||||
Effect: | ||||||||
Increase/(decrease) in defined benefit obligation – UK Group plan | 107 | (108 | ) | |||||
Increase/(decrease) in defined benefit obligation – US plan | 4 | (3 | ) | |||||
The effect of a half percentage point increase and decrease in the inflation rate is as follows:
2021 | ||||||||
All figures in £ millions | 0.5% increase | 0.5% decrease | ||||||
Effect: | ||||||||
Increase/(decrease) in defined benefit obligation – UK Group plan | 142 | (141 | ) | |||||
Increase/(decrease) in defined benefit obligation – US plan | — | — | ||||||
The above sensitivity analyses are based on a change in an assumption while holding all other assumptions constant, although in practice this is unlikely to occur and changes in some assumptions may be correlated. When calculating these sensitivities, the same method has been applied to calculate the defined benefit obligation as has been applied when calculating the liability recognised in the balance sheet. This methodology is the same as prior periods.
26. Share-based payments
The Group recognised the following charges in the income statement in respect of its equity-settled share-based payment plans:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||||||
Pearson plans | 28 | 29 | 25 |
The Group operates the following equity-settled employee option and share plans:
Worldwide Save for Shares Plan
Save-As-You-Earn
Employee Stock Purchase Plan
six-month
periods. At the end of the period, the employee has the option to purchase American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) with their accumulated funds at a purchase price equal to 85% of the lower of the market prices prevailing at the beginning or end of the period.F-7
7
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
26. Share-based payments continued
Long-Term Incentive Plan
non-market
performance criteria. Restricted shares awarded to Executive Directors in May 2021 and May 2020 and May 2019 vest dependent on relative total shareholder return, return on invested capital and adjusted earnings per share growth. These awards are in addition to the 2020one-off
co-investment
award for the Chief Executive, vesting in three equal tranches based on market andnon-market
performance criteria. The applicable market condition for the vesting of the final tranche is on total shareholder return. Other restricted shares awarded in 2021, 2020 and 2019 generally vest depending on continuing service over periods of up to three years.Management Incentive Plan
non-market
based performance criteria as determined by the Remuneration Committee. Restricted shares awarded as part of the 2020 Management Incentive Plan were granted in April 2021 and those awarded as part of the 2019 management Incentive Plan were granted in April 2020. In 2021 this scheme has been replaced by the Long-Term Incentive Plan for senior management.The following shares were granted under restricted share arrangements:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||||||||||
Number of shares 000s | Weighted average fair value £ | Number of shares 000s | Weighted average fair value £ | |||||||||||||
Long-Term Incentive Plan | 6,394 | 7.27 | 5,598 | 4.94 | ||||||||||||
Management Incentive Plan | 630 | 7.71 | 696 | 5.29 |
The fair value of shares granted under the Long-Term Incentive Plan and the Management Incentive Plan that vest unconditionally is determined using the share price at the date of grant. The number of shares expected to vest is adjusted, based on historical experience, to account for potential forfeitures. Participants under the plans are entitled to dividends during the vesting period and therefore the share price is not discounted.
Restricted shares with a market performance condition were valued by an independent actuary using a Monte Carlo model. Restricted shares with a
non-market
performance condition were fair valued based on the share price at the date of grant.Non-market
performance conditions are taken into consideration by adjusting the number of shares expected to vest based on the most likely outcome of the relevant performance criteria.F-7
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
27. Share capital and share premium
Number of shares 000s | Share capital £m | Share premium £m | ||||||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 782,099 | 195 | 2,614 | |||||||||
Issue of ordinary shares – share option schemes | 1,236 | — | 6 | |||||||||
Purchase of own shares | (30,077 | ) | (7 | ) | — | |||||||
At 31 December 2020 | 753,258 | 188 | 2,620 | |||||||||
Issue of ordinary shares – share option schemes | 3,544 | 1 | 6 | |||||||||
Purchase of own shares | — | — | — | |||||||||
At 31 December 2021 | 756,802 | 189 | 2,626 | |||||||||
The ordinary shares have a par value of 25p per share (2020: 25p per share). All issued shares are fully paid. All shareholders are entitled to receive dividends and vote at general meetings of the company. All shares have the same rights.
On 24 February 2022, the Board approved a £350m share buyback programme in order to return capital to shareholders. The programme will commence
in 2022
. The shares bought back will be cancelled and the nominal value of the shares will be transferred to the capital redemption reserve. In 2020, approximately 30m shares were bought back and cancelled at a cost of £176m. The nominal value of these shares, £7m was transferred to the capital redemption reserve.The Group manages its capital to ensure that entities in the Group will be able to continue as a going concern while maximising the return to shareholders through the optimisation of the debt and equity balance.
The capital structure of the Group consists of debt (see note 18), cash and cash equivalents (see note 17) and equity attributable to equity holders of the parent, comprising issued capital, reserves and retained earnings.
The Group reviews its capital structure on a regular basis and will balance its overall capital structure through payments of dividends, new share issues as well as the issue of new debt or the redemption of existing debt in line with the financial risk policies outlined in note 19.
28. Treasury shares
Number of shares 000s | £m | |||||||
At 1 January 2020 | 3,258 | 24 | ||||||
Purchase of treasury shares | 1,105 | 6 | ||||||
Release of treasury shares | (3,460 | ) | (23 | ) | ||||
At 31 December 2020 | 903 | 7 | ||||||
Purchase of treasury shares | 2,158 | 16 | ||||||
Newly issued treasury shares | 2,500 | 1 | ||||||
Release of treasury shares | (3,990 | ) | (12 | ) | ||||
At 31 December 2021 | 1,571 | 12 | ||||||
The Group holds Pearson plc shares in trust to satisfy its obligations under its restricted share plans (see note 26). These shares, representing 0.2% (2020: 0.1%) of
called-up
share capital, are treated as treasury shares for accounting purposes and have a par value of 25p per share.F-7
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
28. Treasury shares continued
The nominal value of Pearson plc treasury shares amounts to £0.4m (2020: £0.2m). Dividends on treasury shares are waived.
At 31 December 2021, the market value of Pearson plc treasury shares was £10m (2020: £6m).
29. Other comprehensive income
2021 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Attributable to equity holders of the company | Non- controlling interest | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Fair value reserve | Translation reserve | Retained earnings | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||
Items that may be reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations – Group | — | (6 | ) | — | (6 | ) | — | (6 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Currency translation adjustment disposed | — | 4 | — | 4 | — | 4 | ||||||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | 10 | 10 | — | 10 | ||||||||||||||||||
Items that are not reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fair value gain on other financial assets | 24 | — | — | 24 | — | 24 | ||||||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | (3 | ) | (3 | ) | — | (3 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations - Group | — | — | 149 | 149 | — | 149 | ||||||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | (61 | ) | (61 | ) | — | (61 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Other comprehensive income/(expense) for the year | 24 | (2 | ) | 95 | 117 | — | 117 | |||||||||||||||||
2020 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Attributable to equity holders of the company | Non- controlling interest | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Fair value reserve | Translation reserve | Retained earnings | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||
Items that may be reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations – Group | — | (109 | ) | — | (109 | ) | — | (109 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Currency translation adjustment disposed | — | (70 | ) | — | (70 | ) | — | (70 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | (13 | ) | (13 | ) | — | (13 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Items that are not reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fair value gain on other financial assets | 14 | — | — | 14 | — | 14 | ||||||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | (6 | ) | (6 | ) | — | (6 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations - Group | — | — | (23 | ) | (23 | ) | — | (23 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | 2 | 2 | — | 2 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other comprehensive income/(expense) for the year | 14 | (179 | ) | (40 | ) | (205 | ) | — | (205 | ) | ||||||||||||||
F-
80
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
29. Other comprehensive income continued
2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Attributable to equity holders of the company | Non- controlling interest | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | Fair value reserve | Translation reserve | Retained earnings | Total | ||||||||||||||||||||
Items that may be reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations – Group | — | (113 | ) | — | (113 | ) | — | (113 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Net exchange differences on translation of foreign operations – associates | — | (2 | ) | — | (2 | ) | — | (2 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Currency translation adjustment disposed | — | 4 | — | 4 | — | 4 | ||||||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | 5 | 5 | — | 5 | ||||||||||||||||||
Items that are not reclassified to the income statement | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Fair value gain on other financial assets | 20 | — | — | 20 | — | 20 | ||||||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | (4 | ) | (4 | ) | — | (4 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations – Group | — | — | (145 | ) | (145 | ) | — | (145 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Remeasurement of retirement benefit obligations – associates | — | — | (4 | ) | (4 | ) | — | (4 | ) | |||||||||||||||
Attributable tax | — | — | 22 | 22 | — | 22 | ||||||||||||||||||
Other comprehensive (expense)/income for the year | 20 | (111 | ) | (126 | ) | (217 | ) | — | (217 | ) | ||||||||||||||
30. Business combinations
In September 2021, Pearson completed the acquisition of 100% of the share capital of Faethm Holdings Pty Limited (Faethm), having already held 9% of the share capital previously. Faethm uses artificial intelligence and analytics services to help governments, companies and workers understand the dynamic forces shaping the labour market. Faethm will be part of the Workforce Skills division. The total consideration for the transaction was £65m, which included £10m of contingent consideration which is payable after two years, dependent upon meeting certain earnings targets. The contingent consideration has been valued at the net present value of the Group’s best estimate of the amount that will be payable.
In addition, the Group made 2 additional acquisitions of subsidiaries for total consideration of £11m. In both cases, the Group acquired 100% of the share capital of the respective entities. Opinion Interactive LLC (also known as Spotlight Education) was acquired in February 2021. MZ Development Inc. was acquired in July 2021. Both will be part of the Assessment & Qualifications division.
The Group also made additional investments in associates, which are detailed in note 12, and are not included below.
Details of the fair values of the assets and liabilities recognised at the acquisition date and the related consideration is shown in the table below. The fair values of Faethm’s net assets are provisional at this stage as management are finalising their review of the asset valuations. The provisional goodwill arising from the acquisition of Faethm represents assets and benefits that cannot be separately recognised. The goodwill is not deductible for tax purposes and at the acquisition date there were no material contingent liabilities.
F-
81
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
30. Business combinations continued
There were no significant acquisitions in 2020. In 2019, the Group made some small acquisitions, including Lumerit Education and Smart Sparrow, for total consideration of £40m.
All figures in £ millions | 2021 Faethm | 2021 Other | 2021 Total | 2020 Total | 2019 Total | |||||||||||||||
Intangible assets | 21 | 6 | 27 | 0 | — | 23 | ||||||||||||||
Deferred tax asset | 11 | — | 11 | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Trade and other receivables | 1 | 1 | 2 | — | 1 | |||||||||||||||
Cash | 4 | — | 4 | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Trade and other liabilities | (4 | ) | (1 | ) | (5 | ) | — | (2 | ) | |||||||||||
Deferred tax liabilities | (6 | ) | — | (6 | ) | — | — | |||||||||||||
Net assets acquired | 27 | 6 | 33 | — | 22 | |||||||||||||||
Goodwill | 38 | 5 | 43 | — | 18 | |||||||||||||||
Total | 65 | 11 | 76 | — | 40 | |||||||||||||||
Satisfied by: | ||||||||||||||||||||
Cash consideration | 49 | 5 | 54 | — | 40 | |||||||||||||||
Contingent consideration | 10 | 6 | 16 | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Fair value of existing investment | 6 | — | 6 | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Total consideration | 65 | 11 | 76 | — | 40 | |||||||||||||||
Faethm generated revenues of £1m and a loss before tax of £1m for the period from the acquisition date to 31 December 2021. If the acquisition had occurred on 1 January 2021, the Group’s revenue and profit before tax for the year ended 31 December 2021 would not have been materially different. Total acquisition-related costs relating to the three transactions of £2m were recognised within other net gains and losses, in the consolidated income statement, all of which was recognised in the year ended 31 December 2021, and are excluded from adjusted operating profit.
The net cash outflows related to the acquisitions are set out in the table below. In addition to the current year acquisitions, the other net cash outflows on acquisition of subsidiaries in 2021, 2020 and 2019 relate to deferred payments for prior year acquisitions.
All figures in £ millions | 2021 Faethm | 2021 Other | 2021 Total | 2020 Total | 2019 Total | |||||||||||||||
Cash flow on acquisitions | ||||||||||||||||||||
Cash – current year acquisitions | (49 | ) | (5 | ) | (54 | ) | — | (40 | ) | |||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents acquired | 4 | — | 4 | — | — | |||||||||||||||
Deferred payments for prior year acquisitions and other items | — | (4 | ) | (4 | ) | (6 | ) | (5 | ) | |||||||||||
Acquisition costs paid | (1 | ) | — | (1 | ) | — | — | |||||||||||||
Net cash outflow | (46 | ) | (9 | ) | (55 | ) | (6 | ) | (45 | ) | ||||||||||
F-
82
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
31. Disposals and business closures
The Group completed two significant disposals in 2021 and one in 2020. None of the disposals met the criteria to be considered a discontinued operation on the basis that they did not represent major lines of business or geographical areas of operations.
In February 2021, the Group completed the sale of its interests in the Pearson Institute of Higher Education (PIHE) in South Africa resulting in a
pre-tax
loss of £5m.In October 2021, the sale of the Group’s interests in K12 Sistemas in Brazil was also completed for consideration of £108 million, resulting in a gain on sale of £84m.
There were no other business disposals in 2021 and additional losses of £
14m relate to other disposal costs including costs related to the wind-down of certain businesses under strategic review.
In April 2020, the Group completed the sale of the remaining
25% interest in Penguin Random House resulting in a
pre-tax
profit of £
180m.
In 2019, the only material disposal was the sale of the US K-12 business.
The table below shows a summary of the assets and liabilities disposed of:
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Disposal of subsidiaries and associates | ||||||||||||||||
Intangible assets | (3 | ) | — | (101 | ) | |||||||||||
Property, plant and equipment | (48 | ) | — | — | ||||||||||||
Investments in joint ventures and associates | — | (418 | ) | — | ||||||||||||
Intangible assets – product development | (6 | ) | — | (238 | ) | |||||||||||
Inventories | (2 | ) | — | (64 | ) | |||||||||||
Trade and other receivables | (6 | ) | — | (70 | ) | |||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents (excluding overdrafts) | (24 | ) | — | (104 | ) | |||||||||||
Net deferred income tax assets | — | — | (100 | ) | ||||||||||||
Provisions for other liabilities and charges | 3 | — | — | |||||||||||||
Trade and other liabilities | 4 | — | 520 | |||||||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | 67 | — | — | |||||||||||||
Cumulative currency translation adjustment | 29 | (4 | ) | 70 | (4 | ) | ||||||||||
Net assets disposed | (19 | ) | (348 | ) | (161 | ) | ||||||||||
Cash proceeds | 108 | 531 | 20 | |||||||||||||
Deferred proceeds | — | — | 180 | |||||||||||||
Costs of disposal | (24 | ) | 1 | (23 | ) | |||||||||||
Gain on disposal | 65 | 184 | 16 | |||||||||||||
83
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
31. Disposals and business closures continued
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||||||
Cash flow from disposals | ||||||||||||||||
Proceeds – current year disposals | 108 | 531 | 20 | |||||||||||||
Proceeds – prior year disposals | 16 | 105 | — | |||||||||||||
Cash and cash equivalents disposed | (24 | ) | — | (104 | ) | |||||||||||
Costs and other disposal liabilities paid | (17 | ) | (5 | ) | (17 | ) | ||||||||||
Net cash inflow | 83 | 631 | (101 | ) | ||||||||||||
Analysed as: | ||||||||||||||||
Cash inflow from sale of subsidiaries | 83 | 100 | (101 | ) | ||||||||||||
Cash inflow from disposal of joint ventures and associates | — | 531 | — |
32. Held for sale
Following the announcement of the sale of the Group’s interests in K12 Sistemas (included within the Strategic Review segment) in March 2021, the business was classified as held for sale until the disposal completed in October 2021. At 31 December 2021, only one property, which is expected to be disposed of in 2022, was classified as held for sale. The businesses that are included in the Strategic Review segment did not meet the criteria for classification as held for sale as at 31 December 2021 on the basis that the Group was not sufficiently advanced in the sales process as at 31 December 2021 for the sale to be considered highly probable.
The held for sale assets and liabilities in 2020 are the Group’s interests in the Pearson Institute of Higher Education in South Africa, which was completed on 5 February 2021.
The held for sale balances are analysed as follows:
2021 | 2020 | |||||||
All figures in £ millions | Total | Total | ||||||
Non-current assets | ||||||||
Property, plant and equipment | 7 | 48 | ||||||
7 | 48 | |||||||
Current assets | ||||||||
Trade and other receivables | — | 6 | ||||||
Cash and cash equivalents | — | 19 | ||||||
— | 25 | |||||||
Assets classified as held for sale | 7 | 73 | ||||||
Non-current liabilities | ||||||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | — | (66 | ) | |||||
— | (66 | ) | ||||||
Current liabilities | ||||||||
Trade and other liabilities | — | (5 | ) | |||||
Financial liabilities – borrowings | — | (3 | ) | |||||
— | (8 | ) | ||||||
Liabilities classified as held for sale | — | (74 | ) | |||||
Net assets/(liabilities) classified as held for sale | 7 | (1 | ) | |||||
F-
84
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
33. Cash generated from operations
All figures in £ millions | Notes | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Profit | 160 | 310 | 266 | |||||||||||||
Adjustments for: | ||||||||||||||||
Income tax | (3 | ) | 44 | (34 | ) | |||||||||||
Depreciation and impairment of property, plant and equipment | 10 | 241 | 125 | 123 | ||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangibles and goodwill | 11 | 50 | 80 | 151 | ||||||||||||
Amortisation and impairment of software | 11 | 117 | 112 | 115 | ||||||||||||
Net finance costs | 6 | 26 | 57 | 43 | ||||||||||||
Share of results of joint ventures and associates | 12 | (1 | ) | (5 | ) | (54 | ) | |||||||||
Profit on disposal of subsidiaries, associates, investments and fixed assets | (61 | ) | (182 | ) | (9 | ) | ||||||||||
Other net gains and losses | 2 | 6 | — | |||||||||||||
Net profit on disposal of right-of-use | — | (6 | ) | (4 | ) | |||||||||||
Net foreign exchange adjustment from transactions | 9 | (34 | ) | (21 | ) | |||||||||||
Investment income | — | — | (2 | ) | ||||||||||||
Share-based payment costs | 26 | 28 | 29 | 25 | ||||||||||||
Product development assets | (6 | ) | (56 | ) | (55 | ) | ||||||||||
Inventories | 22 | 35 | (20 | ) | ||||||||||||
Trade and other receivables | (71 | ) | (1 | ) | 59 | |||||||||||
Trade and other liabilities | 37 | (26 | ) | (157 | ) | |||||||||||
Retirement benefit obligations | 6 | (1 | ) | 5 | ||||||||||||
Provisions for other liabilities and charges | 14 | (37 | ) | 49 | ||||||||||||
Net cash generated from operations | 570 | 450 | 480 | |||||||||||||
F-
85
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
33. Cash generated from operations continued
Net cash generated from operations is translated at an exchange rate approximating the rate at the date of cash flow. The difference between this rate and the average rate used to translate profit gives rise to a currency adjustment in the reconciliation between net profit and net cash generated from operations. This adjustment reflects the timing difference between recognition of profit and the related cash receipts or payments.
In the cash flow statement, proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment comprise:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Net book amount | 4 | 2 | 3 | |||||||||
Loss on sale of property, plant and equipment | (4 | ) | (2 | ) | (2 | ) | ||||||
Proceeds from sale of property, plant and equipment | 0 | 0 | 1 | |||||||||
The movements in the Group’s current and
non-current
borrowings are as follows:All figures in £ millions | 2020 | New leases/ disposal of leases | Transfer from non-current to current | Financing cash flows | Foreign exchange movements | Fair value and other movements | 2021 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Non-current borrowings | 1,458 | (36 | ) | (160 | ) | — | 3 | (20 | ) | 1,245 | ||||||||||||||||||
Current borrowings | 248 | (1 | ) | 160 | (255 | ) | (4 | ) | 9 | 157 | ||||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,706 | (37 | ) | 0 | (255 | ) | (1 | ) | (11 | ) | 1,402 | |||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | 2019 | New leases/ disposal of leases | Transfer from non-current to current | Financing cash flows | Foreign exchange movements | Fair value and other movements | 2020 | |||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Non-current borrowings | 1,567 | 30 | (260 | ) | 116 | (22 | ) | 27 | 1,458 | |||||||||||||||||||
Current borrowings | 79 | (6 | ) | 260 | (92 | ) | 5 | 2 | 248 | |||||||||||||||||||
Total | 1,646 | 24 | 0 | 24 | (17 | ) | 29 | 1,706 | ||||||||||||||||||||
All figures in £ millions | 2018 | IFRS 16 Transition | New leases/ disposal of leases | Transfer from non-current to current | Financing cash flows | Foreign exchange movements | Fair value and other movements | 2019 | ||||||||||||||||||||||||
Financial liabilities | ||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||||
Non-current borrowings | 643 | 792 | 61 | (88 | ) | 230 | (80 | ) | 9 | 1,567 | ||||||||||||||||||||||
Current borrowings | 25 | 89 | — | 88 | (139 | ) | 16 | — | 79 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Total | 668 | 881 | 61 | 0 | 91 | (64 | ) | 9 | 1,646 | |||||||||||||||||||||||
Non-current
borrowings include bonds, derivative financial instruments and leases. Current borrowings include loans repayable within one year, derivative financial instruments and leases, but exclude overdrafts classified within cash and cash equivalents.F-
8
6
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
34. Contingencies and commitments
Key judgements
Key areas of estimation
There are contingent Group liabilities that arise in the normal course of business in respect of indemnities, warranties and guarantees in relation to former subsidiaries and in respect of guarantees in relation to subsidiaries, joint ventures and associates. In addition, there are contingent liabilities of the Group in respect of unsettled or disputed tax liabilities, legal claims, contract disputes, royalties, copyright fees, permissions and other rights. None of these claims are expected to result in a material gain or loss to the Group.
On 25 April 2019, the European Commission published the full decision that the United Kingdom controlled foreign company group financing partial exemption (FCPE) partially constitutes State Aid. The Group has lodged an appeal. The Group has benefited from the FCPE in 2018 and prior years by approximately £116m (which does not include any additional interest that would be due if the appeal is lost). In February 2021, the Group received Charging Notices requiring a payment on account of materially all of the alleged State Aid to be made. Payments totalling £105m (comprising tax and interest) were made during 2021 and the Group expects to recover the funds in due course. The Group continues to be of the view that no provision is required in respect of this issue.
The Group is under assessment from the tax authorities in Brazil challenging the deduction for tax purposes of goodwill amortisation for the years 2012 to 2017. Similar assessments may be raised for other years. Potential total exposure (including possible interest and penalties) could be up to BRL 1,079m (£143m) up to 31 December 2021, with additional potential exposure of BRL 98m (£13m) in relation to deductions expected to be taken in future periods. Such assessments are common in Brazil. The Group believes that the likelihood that the tax authorities will ultimately prevail is low and that the Group’s position is strong. At present, the Group believes no provision is required.
At the balance sheet date there were no commitments for capital expenditure contracted for but not yet incurred. Commitments in respect of leases are shown in note 35.
35. Leases
The Group’s lease portfolio consists of approximately 730 property leases, mainly offices and test centres, together with a number of vehicle and equipment leases. The Group adopted IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ at 1 January 2019 and applied the modified retrospective approach. The Group has elected not to recogniseassets and lease liabilities for short-term leases that have a lease term of 12 months or less and leases of
right-of-use
low-value
assets. The Group recognises the lease payments associated with these leases as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term.F-8
7
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
35. Leases continued
As a lessee:
The amounts recognised in the income statement are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | Note | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | ||||||||||||
Interest on lease liabilities | (27 | ) | (41 | ) | (45 | ) | ||||||||||
Expenses relating to short-term leases | — | (1 | ) | (2 | ) | |||||||||||
Depreciation of right-of-use | 10 | (49 | ) | (68 | ) | (64 | ) | |||||||||
Impairment of right-of-use | 10 | (119 | ) | (4 | ) | — |
Lease liabilities are included within financial liabilities – borrowings in the balance sheet, see note 18. The maturities of the Group’s lease liabilities are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Less than one year | 92 | 100 | ||||||
One to five years | 318 | 333 | ||||||
More than five years | 394 | 441 | ||||||
Total undiscounted lease liabilities | 804 | 874 | ||||||
Lease liabilities included in the balance sheet | 633 | 683 | ||||||
Analysed as: | ||||||||
Current | 68 | 73 | ||||||
Non-current | 565 | 610 |
In addition to the above, there are current lease liabilities of £NaN (2020: £3m) and
non-current
lease liabilities of £NaN (2020: £66m) classified as held for sale (see note 32).The amounts recognised in the cash flow statement are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Total cash outflow for leases as a lessee | 115 | 133 | 136 |
At the balance sheet date commitments for capital leases contracted for but not yet incurred were £3m (2020: £3m). Extension and termination options and variable lease payments are not significant within the lease portfolio. Short-term leases to which the Group is committed at the balance sheet date are similar to the portfolio of short-term leases to which the short-term lease expense is disclosed above.
As a lessor:
In the event that the Group has excess capacity in its leased offices and warehouses, the Group subleases some of its properties under operating and finance leases.
The amounts recognised in the income statement are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Interest on lease receivables | 6 | 9 | 11 | |||||||||
Income from subleasing right-of-use | 2 | 7 | 17 |
The amounts recognised in the cash flow statement are as follows:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | 2019 | |||||||||
Total cash inflow for leases as a lessor | 27 | 50 | 37 |
F-8
8
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
35. Leases continued
The following table sets out the maturity analysis of lease payments receivable for subleases classified as operating leases, showing the undiscounted lease payments to be received after the reporting date, and subleases classified as finance leases showing the undiscounted lease payments to be received after the reporting date and the net investment in the finance lease receivable. During the year the investment in finance lease receivable decreased by £15m (2020: decreased £66m), primarily due to payments received.
All figures in £ millions | Operating leases | Finance leases | 2021 Total | 2020 Total | ||||||||||||
Less than one year | 1 | 20 | 21 | 24 | ||||||||||||
One to two years | — | 18 | 18 | 24 | ||||||||||||
Two to three years | 1 | 19 | 20 | 18 | ||||||||||||
Three to four years | 2 | 19 | 21 | 18 | ||||||||||||
Four to five years | 1 | 19 | 20 | 18 | ||||||||||||
More than five years | 2 | 39 | 41 | 56 | ||||||||||||
Total undiscounted lease payments receivable | 7 | 134 | 141 | 158 | ||||||||||||
Unearned finance income | (19 | ) | ||||||||||||||
Net investment in finance lease receivable | 115 | |||||||||||||||
36. Related party transactions
Joint ventures and associates
In 2021, the Group acquired a 40% interest in Academy of Pop and is accounting for the investment as an associate. At 31 December 2021, the Group had a current liability payable to Academy of Pop of £7m which relates to the Group’s initial capital contribution that has not yet been paid. This balance is expected to be paid in the first half of 2022.
In 2020, the Group disposed of its interests in Penguin Random House and therefore Penguin Random House is no longer a related party. Prior to the completion of the sale of Penguin Random House, the Group received dividends of £1m (2019: £64m) and repaid loans to Penguin Random House at the point of disposal.
Key management personnel
Key management personnel are deemed to be the members of the Pearson Executive Management team. It is this committee which had responsibility for planning, directing and controlling the activities of the Group in 2021. Key management personnel compensation is disclosed below:
All figures in £ millions | 2021 | 2020 | ||||||
Short-term employee benefits | 6 | 6 | ||||||
Retirement benefits | 1 | 1 | ||||||
Share-based payment costs | 8 | 6 | ||||||
Total | 15 | 13 | ||||||
There were no other material related party transactions. No guarantees have been provided to related parties.
F-8
9
Notes to the consolidated financial statements
37. Events after the balance sheet date
On 28 January 2022, the Group acquired 100% of the share capital in Credly Inc, having previously held a 19.9% interest in the company. Total consideration is c$200m comprising upfront cash consideration of c$142m, Pearson’s existing interest valued at c$42m and c$16m of deferred consideration. Net assets acquired will mainly comprise of acquired intangible assets. The full acquisition accounting disclosures have not been provided as the valuation of acquired intangibles has not yet been completed.
In January 2022, the Group received $117m in relation to full and final payment of the remaining receivable balance which arose on the disposal of the US
K-12
business in 2019.In February 2022, the Group renegotiated its revolving credit facility, extending the maturity of $1bn of the facility by one year to 2026.
On 24 February 2022, the Board approved a £350m
share buyback programme in order to return capital to shareholders. The programme will commence in 2022.
F-
90
SIGNATURES
The registrant hereby certifies that it meets the requirements for filing a
Form 20-F
and that it has caused and authorized the undersigned for sign this annual report on its behalf.Pearson plc |
/s/ Sally Johnson |
Sally Johnson |
Chief Financial Officer |
Date: March 30, 2022